625527
307
Zoom out
Zoom in
Vorherige Seite
1/318
Nächste Seite
© 2014 Dethleffs GmbH & Co. KG, Isny
Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Instruction manual
Instruction manual
Congratulations
We congratulate you on your new motorhome and would like to thank you for choosing a quality product from Deth-
leffs.
Whether you want to enjoy your holidays on good or bad roads, whether you want to have your "holiday home" out
in the country, at the seaside or in the mountains: Your Dethleffs motorhome will always make sure that you can enjoy
your holidays because the Dethleffs team has been building caravans for 80 years and knows what is important. This
experience shows itself in the well thought-out, cosy and yet highly functional equipment as well as in the out-
standing driving characteristics.
Each Dethleffs vehicle is manufactured with great care and the quality is closely checked. This ensures that our prod-
ucts have a long service life. In view of these strict requirements, we guarantee top quality of our products and grant
you a six year leakage guarantee of the body in accordance with our guarantee conditions (see section 1.1).
All Dethleffs vehicles fulfil the requirements of the Euro 5 emission standard.
This instruction manual deals primarily with the body of your motorhome. It will give you all important information
and tips so that you can enjoy all technical advantages of your Dethleffs motorhome to the full. We have also included
a chapter on maintenance – and thus on the conservation of value.
In addition, you will find the documents on the base vehicle and the various built-in appliances.
For maintenance work or whenever you need some help, please always get in touch with your authorised specialist
workshop. They know your motorhome best of all, and will meet all your requests fast and reliably.
In the event of chassis-related problems with Dethleff vehicles, authorised workshops of the base vehicle manufac-
turer are able to provide assistance. If you encounter problems on the Fiat chassis, please call the phone number
00800 34281111.
We wish you a lot of fun with your motorhome, a relaxing holiday and safe driving at all times.
Your Dethleffs team
Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Instruction manual
We reserve the right to alter the construction, equipment and the scope of delivery. Special equipment is also listed
that is not included in the standard scope of delivery. The descriptions and illustrations in this brochure do not relate
to a particular version. For all details, only the respective equipment list is valid.
Vehicle data
Model:
Car manufacturer/type of engine:
Serial number:
Initial registration:
Purchased from company:
Expiry of the guarantee period:
Key number:
Chassis number:
Family Card with long-term warranty yes/no
Customer Address
Surname, Christian name:
Street, No.:
Postal code, town:
Dealer's stamp and signature
3Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Contents
1 Guarantee. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7
1.1 Guarantee conditions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7
1.2 Water ingress test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8
1.2.1 Inspection plan . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8
1.2.2 Inspection records . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9
1.3 Further inspections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12
1.3.1 Inspection plan for annual inspection . . . . 12
1.3.2 Inspection plan for chassis . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13
1.3.3 Gas inspection plan. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13
1.3.4 Inspection records . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14
2 Introduction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17
2.1 General . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18
2.2 Environmental tips . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18
2.3 Licence categories / Registration . . . . . . . . . 19
3 Safety. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21
3.1 Rescue card . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21
3.2 Fire prevention . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21
3.2.1 Avoidance of fire risks. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21
3.2.2 Fire-fighting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21
3.2.3 Gas odour . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22
3.3 General . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22
3.4 Road safety. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23
3.5 Towing. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24
3.6 Gas system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25
3.6.1 General instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25
3.6.2 Gas bottles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26
3.7 Electrical system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26
3.8 Water system. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27
4 Before the journey. . . . . . . . . . . . . 29
4.1 Keys. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29
4.2 Registration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29
4.3 Payload . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30
4.3.1 Terms . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30
4.3.2 Calculating the payload. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .33
4.3.3 Loading the vehicle correctly. . . . . . . . . . . . . 34
4.3.4 Roof loads. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35
4.3.5 Fastening system in the rear area. . . . . . . . . 37
4.3.6 Double floor. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37
4.3.7 Bike rack . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38
4.4 Towing. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39
4.4.1 Tow coupling. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39
4.5 Entrance step. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40
4.5.1 Mechanically operated entrance step . . . .40
4.5.2 Electrically operated entrance step . . . . . . . 41
4.6 PVC-floor covering. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41
4.7 Television . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42
4.8 Sink cover . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43
4.9 Driver's cabin Roman shade. . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43
4.9.1 Roman shade for driver's window and
front passenger's window. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43
4.9.2 Roman shade for windscreen . . . . . . . . . . . . 44
4.10 Central locking system for kitchen unit . . . 45
4.11 Snow chains . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46
4.12 Road safety. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47
5 During the journey . . . . . . . . . . . . .49
5.1 Driving the motorhome . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49
5.2 Driving speed . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50
5.3 Brakes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50
5.4 Seat belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50
5.4.1 Fastening the seat belt correctly . . . . . . . . . 51
5.4.2 Adjusting the seat belt correctly . . . . . . . . . 51
5.5 Driver's seat and front passenger's seat . . 52
5.6 Headrests. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53
5.7 Seating arrangement. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53
5.8 Branch block (model I) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54
5.9 Electrical window winders (model I) . . . . . 54
5.10 Electrically adjustable external mirrors
(model I) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55
5.11 Roman shades for windscreen, driver's
window and front passenger's window . . 55
5.12 Writing and reading rest . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56
5.13 Bonnet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56
5.13.1 Model I . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57
5.14 Filling with washer fluid (model I). . . . . . . . 57
5.15 Refilling cooling water . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58
5.16 Checking the oil level (model I) . . . . . . . . . . 59
5.17 Filling up with diesel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59
6 Pitching the motorhome. . . . . . . .61
6.1 Handbrake. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61
6.2 Entrance step . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61
6.3 Wheel chocks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61
6.4 Supports. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61
6.4.1 General instructions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61
6.4.2 Steady legs (AL-KO) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62
6.5 240 V connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62
6.6 Refrigerator. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63
6.6.1 Absorption refrigerator. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63
6.6.2 Compressor refrigerator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63
6.7 Awning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63
6.8 Satellite unit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 64
6.9 Cable connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65
7 Living . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .67
7.1 Doors. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67
7.1.1 Conversion door, outside . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68
7.1.2 Conversion door, inside (with locking
lever) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68
7.1.3 Driver's door, outside . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69
7.1.4 Driver's door, inside (without lock). . . . . . . 69
7.1.5 Driver's door, inside (with lock) . . . . . . . . . . 70
7.1.6 Insect screen on the conversion door . . . . 70
7.1.7 Conversion door window (variant 1) . . . . . 71
7.1.8 Conversion door window (variant 2) . . . . . 71
7.2 External flaps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72
7.2.1 Flap lock with recessed handle . . . . . . . . . . 72
7.2.2 Holding the external flaps in position . . . . 72
7.3 Driver's cabin partition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74
7.4 Ventilation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74
7.5 Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75
7.5.1 Sliding window with lock (variant 1) . . . . . 76
4 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Contents
7.5.2 Sliding window with lock (variant 2) . . . . . .76
7.5.3 Sliding window with lock (variant 3) . . . . . .77
7.5.4 Sliding window without lock (variant 1) . .77
7.5.5 Sliding window without lock (variant 2) . .78
7.5.6 Hinged window with rotary hinges. . . . . . . 78
7.5.7 Hinged window with automatic hinges. . . 80
7.5.8 Blind and insect screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82
7.5.9 Roman shade for the windscreen. . . . . . . . . 83
7.5.10 Roman shade for driver's window and
front passenger's window. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 84
7.5.11 Gathered blinds . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 85
7.6 Skylights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 85
7.6.1 Skylight with snap latch. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86
7.6.2 Heki skylight (mini and midi) . . . . . . . . . . . . 87
7.6.3 Wind-up skylight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88
7.7 Rotating seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 89
7.8 Bench and individual seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90
7.9 Tables . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90
7.9.1 Suspension table with fold-out leg . . . . . . .90
7.9.2 Suspension table (bar seating group). . . . .92
7.9.3 Swivel table for the round seating group . 93
7.9.4 Fixed table (movable table-top) . . . . . . . . . .93
7.9.5 Single-column table (movable table-top) . 94
7.9.6 Fixed table . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 94
7.9.7 Lift-off table for the round seating group .96
7.10 Central locking system for kitchen unit . . . 96
7.11 Television . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97
7.12 Lamps. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98
7.12.1 Plug-in light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98
7.12.2 Light in the elevating roof. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99
7.13 Light switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99
7.14 Extending the seating group . . . . . . . . . . . .100
7.14.1 Extending the central seating group . . . .100
7.15 Beds . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .101
7.15.1 Overcab bed . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .101
7.15.2 Pull-down bed (model I) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .102
7.15.3 Pull-down bed (model T). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .110
7.15.4 Bunk bed. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .112
7.15.5 Bunk bed (side) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .113
7.15.6 Fixed bed (gas-pressure springs) . . . . . . . .114
7.15.7 Bed in sleeper roof. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .114
7.16 Converting seating groups for sleeping .116
7.16.1 Central seating group. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .116
7.16.2 Central seating group with extension . . .117
7.16.3 Facing seating unit with extension . . . . . .118
7.16.4 Facing seating unit with deflecting
wall mat. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .119
7.16.5 Central seating group with divan. . . . . . . .120
7.16.6 Round seating group (without slatted
frame). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .121
7.16.7 Round seating group . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .122
7.16.8 Front bench seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .123
7.16.9 Front bench seat with divan. . . . . . . . . . . . .124
7.16.10 Front bench seat with divan
(extendable). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .125
7.16.11 Front bench seat with lengthwise seat . .126
7.16.12 Front seating group . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .127
7.16.13 L-seating group . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 128
7.17 Bath area . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 129
7.18 Sleeping area partition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 129
7.18.1 Sliding door. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 129
7.18.2 Folding door. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 130
8 Gas system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .131
8.1 General . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131
8.2 Gas bottles. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 132
8.3 Gas consumption . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 133
8.4 Changing gas bottles. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 134
8.4.1 Changing a gas bottle in the vehicle
inside. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135
8.5 Gas isolator taps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135
8.6 External gas connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 136
8.7 DuoControl CS switching facility. . . . . . . . 137
9 Electrical system . . . . . . . . . . . . . .141
9.1 General safety instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141
9.2 Terms. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142
9.3 12 V power supply . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142
9.3.1 Living area battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 143
9.4 Charging the living area battery and
starter battery. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 145
9.4.1 Charging using a 240 V power supply. . . 145
9.4.2 Charging using the vehicle engine. . . . . . 145
9.4.3 Charging with an external charger . . . . . . 146
9.5 AC converter. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 147
9.6 Auxiliary charging unit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 148
9.7 Transformer/rectifier (EBL 99). . . . . . . . . . . 148
9.7.1 Battery cut-off switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 150
9.7.2 Battery selector switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 150
9.7.3 Battery monitor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 151
9.7.4 Charging the battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 151
9.8 Transformer/rectifier (EBL 101) . . . . . . . . . 152
9.8.1 Battery cut-off switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 153
9.8.2 Battery selector switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 153
9.8.3 Battery monitor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 154
9.8.4 Charging the battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 154
9.9 Transformer/rectifier (EBL 220) . . . . . . . . . 155
9.9.1 Battery cut-off switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 156
9.9.2 Battery selector switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 156
9.9.3 Battery monitor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157
9.9.4 Charging the battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157
9.10 Panel IT 992. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157
9.10.1 V/tank gauge for battery voltage and
water or waste water levels. . . . . . . . . . . . . 158
9.10.2 Battery alarm for the living area battery . 159
9.10.3 Current gauge for charging/
discharging the living area battery. . . . . . 160
9.10.4 12 V main switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 160
9.10.5 12 V indicator lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 161
9.10.6 240 V indicator lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 161
9.10.7 Switch for circulating pump . . . . . . . . . . . . 161
9.11 Panel MP 20-T. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 161
9.11.1 240 V indicator lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 162
9.11.2 12 V main switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 162
5Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Contents
9.11.3 Batteries gauge. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .162
9.11.4 Tank gauge. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .164
9.11.5 Alarms . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .164
9.11.6 Temperature display. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .165
9.11.7 Clock gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .165
9.11.8 Switch for tank heater . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .165
9.12 240 V power supply. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .166
9.12.1 240 V connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .166
9.12.2 Power cable for external
240 V connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .166
9.13 Fuses. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .168
9.13.1 12 V fuses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .168
9.13.2 240 V fuse . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .170
10 Appliances . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 171
10.1 General . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .171
10.2 Heater. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .172
10.2.1 Models with waste gas vent on the
right-hand side of the vehicle . . . . . . . . . . .172
10.2.2 To heat properly. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .173
10.2.3 Hot-air heater Truma Combi . . . . . . . . . . . .173
10.2.4 Alde hot-water heater . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .175
10.2.5 Diesel heater Webasto . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .179
10.2.6 Arizona auxiliary heat exchanger . . . . . . . .182
10.2.7 Independent vehicle heater . . . . . . . . . . . .183
10.2.8 Heater for waste water tank and waste
water pipes (winter comfort package) . . .184
10.2.9 Electrical floor warming unit . . . . . . . . . . . .185
10.3 Air conditioning unit. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .186
10.3.1 Air conditioning unit Truma. . . . . . . . . . . . .186
10.3.2 Air conditioning unit (Teleco) . . . . . . . . . . .188
10.4 Boiler. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .189
10.4.1 Models with waste gas vent on the
right-hand side of the vehicle . . . . . . . . . . .189
10.4.2 Truma Combi boiler . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .189
10.4.3 Trumatic C boiler . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .191
10.4.4 Alde boiler . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .194
10.4.5 Boiler Webasto . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .195
10.5 Cooker . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .198
10.5.1 Gas cooker . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .198
10.5.2 Gas oven (Spinflo) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .200
10.5.3 Gas oven (Dometic). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .201
10.5.4 Microwave oven . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .202
10.5.5 Extractor hood . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .203
10.6 Coffee machine. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .203
10.7 Refrigerator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .204
10.7.1 Refrigerator ventilation grill . . . . . . . . . . . . .204
10.7.2 Operation (Dometic 8 series) . . . . . . . . . . . .205
10.7.3 Operation (Dometic 8 series with
manual power selection MES) . . . . . . . . . . .207
10.7.4 Operation (Dometic 8 series with
automatic power selection) . . . . . . . . . . . . .209
10.7.5 Operation (Thetford). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .211
10.7.6 Operation (Webasto) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .213
10.7.7 Refrigerator door locking mechanism . . .214
11 Sanitary fittings. . . . . . . . . . . . . . .217
11.1 Water supply, general . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 217
11.2 Switch for water pump (winter comfort
package or special equipment) . . . . . . . . . 218
11.3 Water tank . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 219
11.3.1 Drinking water filler neck with cap. . . . . . 219
11.3.2 Filling with water . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 219
11.3.3 Draining water . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 220
11.4 Waste water tank . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 221
11.4.1 Waste water tank (models with
double floor). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 221
11.4.2 Waste water tank (models without
double floor) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 222
11.4.3 Siphon (odour seal) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 222
11.5 Filling the water system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 223
11.6 Emptying the water system . . . . . . . . . . . . 224
11.7 Toilet compartment. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 226
11.7.1 Pull-out toilet compartment . . . . . . . . . . . . 227
11.7.2 Vario toilet. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 227
11.7.3 Variable wash basin . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 229
11.8 Toilet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 229
11.8.1 Swivel toilet (Thetford) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 230
11.8.2 Toilet with fixed seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 232
11.8.3 Toilet (Dometic). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 232
11.8.4 Removing the cassette . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 234
11.8.5 Emptying the cassette. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 235
12 Care. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .237
12.1 External care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 237
12.1.1 Washing with a high-pressure cleaner . . 237
12.1.2 Washing the vehicle. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 237
12.1.3 Windows of acrylic glass. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 238
12.1.4 Underbody . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 238
12.1.5 Waste water tank . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 238
12.1.6 Entrance step . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 239
12.1.7 Driver's cabin insulation mat (model I) . . 239
12.2 Interior care. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 239
12.3 Water system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 240
12.3.1 Cleaning the water tank . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 240
12.3.2 Cleaning the water pipes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 240
12.3.3 Disinfecting the water system . . . . . . . . . . 241
12.4 Extractor hood . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 242
12.5 Sink . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 242
12.5.1 Stainless-steel sink . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 243
12.5.2 Plastic sink . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 243
12.6 Toilets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 244
12.6.1 Toilet with separate water tank . . . . . . . . . 244
12.7 Winter care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 244
12.7.1 Preparations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 245
12.7.2 Winter operation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 245
12.7.3 At the end of the winter season. . . . . . . . . 245
12.8 Lay-up . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 245
12.8.1 Temporary lay-up . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 245
12.8.2 Winter lay-up . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 247
12.8.3 Starting up the vehicle after a
temporary lay-up or after lay-up
over winter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 248
6 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Contents
13 Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 249
13.1 Inspection work . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .249
13.2 Maintenance work. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .249
13.3 Alde hot-water heater . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .250
13.3.1 Checking the fluid level . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .250
13.3.2 Topping up heating fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .250
13.3.3 Bleeding the heating system . . . . . . . . . . . .251
13.4 Diesel heater Webasto . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .251
13.4.1 Disinfection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .251
13.4.2 Decalcification. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .252
13.4.3 Fuses. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .252
13.5 Independent vehicle heater. . . . . . . . . . . . .253
13.6 Air conditioning unit. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .253
13.6.1 Air conditioning unit (Truma) . . . . . . . . . . .253
13.6.2 Air conditioning unit (Teleco) . . . . . . . . . . .254
13.7 Replacing bulbs and fluorescent tubes . .254
13.7.1 Halogen spotlight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .255
13.7.2 Room lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .255
13.7.3 Living area lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .256
13.7.4 Range hood light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .256
13.7.5 Wardrobe lights with LED . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .256
13.7.6 Garage light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .257
13.7.7 Refrigerator light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .257
13.7.8 Light in the elevating roof. . . . . . . . . . . . . . .258
13.8 AL-KO rear axle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .258
13.9 Vehicle identification plate. . . . . . . . . . . . . .259
13.10 Warning and information stickers . . . . . . .259
14 Spare parts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 261
14.1 Spare parts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .261
15 Wheels and tyres . . . . . . . . . . . . . 263
15.1 General . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .263
15.2 Tyre selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .264
15.3 Tyre specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .265
15.4 Handling of tyres . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .265
15.5 Changing wheels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .266
15.5.1 General instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .266
15.5.2 Tightening torque . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .266
15.6 Spare wheel support. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .267
15.7 Tyre pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .267
16 Troubleshooting. . . . . . . . . . . . . . 269
16.1 Braking system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .269
16.2 Electrical system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .269
16.3 Gas system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .272
16.4 Cooker . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .273
16.4.1 Gas cooker/gas oven. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .273
16.4.2 Microwave oven . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .273
16.5 Heater/boiler . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .273
16.5.1 Heater/boiler Truma . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .274
16.5.2 Alde heater/boiler . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .275
16.5.3 Heater/Boiler Webasto. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .276
16.6 Refrigerator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .278
16.6.1 Dometic refrigerator without AES . . . . . . .278
16.6.2 Thetford refrigerator without SES
(error diagnostics) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .279
16.6.3 Dometic 8 series with MES. . . . . . . . . . . . . . 280
16.6.4 Dometic 8 series with AES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 281
16.7 Air conditioning unit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 281
16.8 Water supply. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 282
16.9 Body. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 283
17 Special equipment . . . . . . . . . . . .285
17.1 Weight details for special equipment . . . 285
18 Helpful notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .289
18.1 Dethleffs travel tips on the iPhone . . . . . . 289
18.2 The most important information for
motorhomes. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 289
18.2.1 Traffic rules in Germany . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 289
18.2.2 Traffic rules in foreign countries . . . . . . . . 290
18.2.3 Parking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 290
18.2.4 Official inspections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 292
18.2.5 Emergency equipment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 292
18.3 Help on Europe's roads. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 292
18.4 Speed limits and permissible
dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 295
18.5 Driving with low beam in European
countries . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 298
18.6 Sleeping in the vehicle away from
camping areas . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 298
18.7 Gas supply in European countries. . . . . . . 300
18.8 Toll regulations in European countries . . 303
18.9 Tips on staying overnight safely
during travel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 304
18.10 Tips for winter campers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 304
18.11 Travel checklists. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 305
Guarantee
1
7Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
1Guarantee
1.1 Guarantee conditions
1. In addition to the legal guarantee and product warranty rights due to the cus-
tomer, Dethleffs GmbH & Co. KG may also grant a guarantee of six years that
the vehicles constructed by the company are sealed in such a manner that
moisture cannot penetrate from the outside into the interior of the vehicle.
The guarantee obligations do not apply if the leakage is a result of improper
handling of the windows, doors and skylights or damage that has not been
properly repaired. Damage that is caused by forces of nature (e.g. flooding) is
not covered by the guarantee. The guarantee extensions include only the cor-
rect repair work. Conversion or diminution as well as travelling expenses or
other indirect costs are not covered by the guarantee.
2. When dealing with a case of leakage covered under the conditions of this guar-
antee, Dethleffs GmbH & Co. KG is obliged to rectify the defective vehicle part
concerned by repairing it free of charge or replacing the part, depending on
what is necessary to immediately to repair the damage.
Defects are to be rectified by Dethleffs GmbH & Co. KG or by an authorised spe-
cialist workshop in accordance with the guidelines of Dethleffs GmbH & Co. KG.
3. The prerequisite for this guarantee is that the vehicle must be presented once a
year to an authorised specialist workshop for an inspection. The presentation
must take place 2 months at the latest after the anniversary of the initial regis-
tration (or delivery).
If the inspection is not carried out according to schedule, this will nullify your
warranty. It cannot be renewed by carrying out an inspection at a later time.
As proof that the inspection has been completed, there are designated cou-
pons in the Dethleffs GmbH & Co. KG guarantee booklet where inspection
stamps are to be glued and endorsed by a stamp, the date and the signature of
a respective Dethleffs dealer.
4. The guarantee begins on the day of the initial registration or delivery of the
vehicle to the customer, 1 year at the latest after delivery to the dealer, and is
valid while the vehicle is in use, for 6 years at the longest. If initial registration of
the vehicle precedes taking delivery, the warranty commences on the vehicle's
initial registration date (warranty qualifying date). A change of ownership of the
purchased object has no effect on the guarantee obligations. The guarantee
expires if the terms outlined in paragraph 3 are not complied with. The perform-
ance of guarantee work does not increase the guarantee period.
5. Parts installed to rectify faults are also guaranteed under the terms of the guar-
antee until the guarantee period expires.
6. If leakage occurs, the owner must notify Dethleffs GmbH & Co. KG or a Dethleffs
dealer of this in writing within 15 days of its detection. The guarantee certificate
and the corresponding guarantee stamps must be included with the notifica-
tion. If notification of leakage does not occur within the time limit stated, no
claims can be made under the terms of the guarantee.
Remedying of leakage will take place after approval has been given by
Dethleffs GmbH & Co. KG.
7. The costs of the inspection are to be paid by the party covered by the guar-
antee.
8. As far as legally permissible, the court responsible for Isny will be agreed upon
as the venue for jurisdiction.
Guarantee
1
8 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
1.2 Water ingress test
1.2.1 Inspection plan
We reserve the right to modify the inspection plan.
Pos. Component Activity
1.1 Wheel housing Visual check
1.2 Rear wall floor plateau connection Visual check
1.2.1 Side wall in the direction of travel left connection Visual check
1.2.2 Side wall in the direction of travel right connection Visual check
1.3 Front wall floor plateau connection Visual check
1.3.1 Side wall in the direction of travel left connection Visual check
1.3.2 Side wall in the direction of travel right connection Visual check
1.4 Side wall floor plateau right connection Visual check
1.5 Side wall floor plateau left connection Visual check
1.6 Connection to driver's cabin Visual check
1.7 Base frame with base frame cut-outs Visual check
1.8 Check the status of the outer metal sheets Visual check
1.9 Check the status of the window rubbers, expansion
joints, sealing joints
Visual check
1.10 Diverse accessories (bike rack, awning, ladder, etc.) Visual check
2.1 Measure the floor plateau at this connection point
with a moisture measuring device, write down the
corresponding values with the date of the assess-
ment. Prescribed maximum values – up to 20%
normal.
Measuring
If the values lie above
20%, check if it is due to
accumulated condensa-
tion.
2.2 Measure inside the vehicle (walls, window sections,
roof, etc.), note changes in the colour of the decor.
Prescribed maximum values – up to 20% normal.
Measuring
If the values lie above
20%, check if it is due to
accumulated condensa-
tion.
3.1 Rear wall floor plateau connection Spray with Dethleffs spe-
cial weatherproof solu-
tion
3.2 Front wall floor plateau connection Spray with Dethleffs spe-
cial weatherproof solu-
tion
3.3 Side wall floor plateau right connection Spray with Dethleffs spe-
cial weatherproof solu-
tion
3.4 Side wall floor plateau left connection Spray with Dethleffs spe-
cial weatherproof solu-
tion
3.5 Openings/ducts for cables, gas lines and air circula-
tion
Spray with Dethleffs spe-
cial weatherproof solu-
tion
3.6 Connection of floor to chassis Spray with Dethleffs spe-
cial weatherproof solu-
tion
Guarantee
1
9Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
1.2.2 Inspection records
Should it be determined during an inspection that additional work is necessary,
then the carrying out of this work is dependent on the customer commissioning
this to be done. Please also adhere to the service intervals stipulated by the manu-
facturers of the individual equipment. Information is included in the service docu-
ments enclosed.
Delivery
Signature, date and stamp of the
Dethleffs dealer:
1st year Water ingress test
Signature, date and stamp of the
Dethleffs dealer:
Paste inspection stamp
here (garage).
Water ingress test 1st year
No defects found
Found defects:
Guarantee
1
10 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Should it be determined during an inspection that additional work is necessary,
then the carrying out of this work is dependent on the customer commissioning
this to be done. Please also adhere to the service intervals stipulated by the manu-
facturers of the individual equipment. Information is included in the service docu-
ments enclosed.
2nd year Water ingress test
Signature, date and stamp of the
Dethleffs dealer:
Paste inspection stamp
here (garage).
Water ingress test 2nd year
No defects found
Found defects:
3rd year Water ingress test
Signature, date and stamp of the
Dethleffs dealer:
Paste inspection stamp
here (garage).
Water ingress test 3rd year
No defects found
Found defects:
Guarantee
1
11Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Should it be determined during an inspection that additional work is necessary,
then the carrying out of this work is dependent on the customer commissioning
this to be done. Please also adhere to the service intervals stipulated by the manu-
facturers of the individual equipment. Information is included in the service docu-
ments enclosed.
4th year Water ingress test
Signature, date and stamp of the
Dethleffs dealer:
Paste inspection stamp
here (garage).
Water ingress test 4th year
No defects found
Found defects:
5th year Water ingress test
Signature, date and stamp of the
Dethleffs dealer:
Paste inspection stamp
here (garage).
Water ingress test 5th year
No defects found
Found defects:
Guarantee
1
12 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
1.3 Further inspections
1.3.1 Inspection plan for annual inspection
We reserve the right to modify the inspection plan.
Z The annual inspection is not bound to the 6-year water ingress test, but should
nevertheless be carried out annually.
Pos. Component Activity Interval
1 Skylights Remove the inside frame
of the skylights and tight-
en the screw connections
of the securing clips
1st year
2 Refrigerator, heater, boiler,
cooker, lighting, storage flap
and door closures, toilet, seat
belts
Function check Annually
3 Windows, skylights Function check, applying
talc to the rubber seals
Annually
4 Screens and blinds Visual check Annually
5 Sealing strips, edges,
-rubber
Check for damage Annually
6 Water supply Water ingress test Annually
7 Hot-air system Function check,
clean fan wheel if appro-
priate
Annually
8 Alde hot-water heater Check fluid level Annually
Replace heating fluid Every 2 years
9 Attachment of the floor skirt Visual check Annually
10 Pull-down bed mounting Function check Annually
11 Electrical system, outside and in-
side
Function check Annually
12 Gas system Official gas inspection Every 2 years
13 Windcreen wipers at I models Function check Annually
14 Awning Function check Annually
15 Bike rack Function check Annually
16 Step Function check Annually
Guarantee
1
13Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
1.3.2 Inspection plan for chassis
We reserve the right to modify the inspection plan.
1.3.3 Gas inspection plan
Z The chassis inspection is not bound to the 6-year water ingress test, but should
nevertheless be carried out annually. Please also observe the respective
instructions of the manufacturer (AL-KO).
Pos. Component Activity Interval
1 Supplementary steady legs Cleaning Annually
2 Joints, hinges, flaps, doors Lubricate Annually
3 Connections between chassis
and body
Check Every 2 years
4 Attachment of the floor skirt Visual check Annually
5 Outside lighting Function check Annually
6 Wheel attachment Tighten the wheel nuts,
check tyre bearings
Annually
7 Slotted nut on the wheel Check position and fit
lock mechanism##
Annually
8 Tyres and wheel rims Air pressure check (see
section 15.7), visual
check for damage, tread
depth
Annually
9 Brakes, brake lining Check and adjust if nec-
essary; lining thickness
min. 1.6 mm
Annually
10 Brake drums Visual check for wear and
rust, check spring tension
Annually
Z The gas inspection is prescribed by law and must be carried out every two years.
Pos. Component Activity Interval
1 Gas system Official gas inspection Every 2 years
Guarantee
1
14 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
1.3.4 Inspection records
Should it be determined during an inspection that additional work is necessary,
then the carrying out of this work is dependent on the customer commissioning
this to be done. Please also adhere to the service intervals stipulated by the manu-
facturers of the individual equipment. Information is included in the service docu-
ments enclosed.
Delivery
Signature, date and stamp of the
Dethleffs dealer:
1st year
Signature, date and stamp of the
Dethleffs dealer:
Chassis inspection
Water ingress test 1st year
No defects found
Found defects:
Guarantee
1
15Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Should it be determined during an inspection that additional work is necessary,
then the carrying out of this work is dependent on the customer commissioning
this to be done. Please also adhere to the service intervals stipulated by the manu-
facturers of the individual equipment. Information is included in the service docu-
ments enclosed.
2nd year
Signature, date and stamp of the
Dethleffs dealer:
Gas inspection
Chassis inspection
Water ingress test 2nd year
No defects found
Found defects:
3rd year
Signature, date and stamp of the
Dethleffs dealer:
Chassis inspection
Water ingress test 3rd year
No defects found
Found defects:
Guarantee
1
16 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Should it be determined during an inspection that additional work is necessary,
then the carrying out of this work is dependent on the customer commissioning
this to be done. Please also adhere to the service intervals stipulated by the manu-
facturers of the individual equipment. Information is included in the service docu-
ments enclosed.
4th year
Signature, date and stamp of the
Dethleffs dealer:
Gas inspection
Chassis inspection
Water ingress test 4th year
No defects found
Found defects:
5th year
Signature, date and stamp of the
Dethleffs dealer:
Chassis inspection
Water ingress test 5th year
No defects found
Found defects:
Introduction
2
17Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
2Introduction
Please read this instruction manual completely before
using the vehicle for the first time!
Always keep this instruction manual in the vehicle. Also inform all other users of the
safety regulations.
With your Dethleffs motorhome you will receive a file with the following vehicle
manuals and documents:
Dethleffs documents
z Instruction manual and service book (housing body)
z List of Dethleffs dealers
Additional documents
z Operating and installation instructions of various appliances
z Complete set of documents from the chassis manufacturer
z Test certificate for the gas system in accordance with German regulations
This instruction manual contains sections which describe model-specific
equipment or special equipment. These sections are accordingly marked. It
may be that your vehicle has not been fitted with this special equipment. In
some cases, the actual equipment of your vehicle may therefore be different
from that shown in some illustrations and descriptions.
However, your vehicle may be fitted with other special equipment not described in
this instruction manual.
Special equipment is described when an explanation is required.
Adhere to the instruction manuals which are separately enclosed.
Should the vehicle be subjected to damage due to a failure to follow the instruc-
tions in this instruction manual, then the guarantee claim is deemed invalid.
Our vehicles are subjected to continuous development. Please understand that we
reserve the right to alter the form, equipment and technology. Therefore, no claims
can be made against the manufacturer as a result of the contents of this instruction
manual. The equipment which was known and included at the time of going to
press is described.
X The non-observance of this symbol can lead to personal injury.
Z The non-observance of this symbol can lead to damage being caused to, or
inside the vehicle.
Z This symbol indicates recommendations or special aspects.
Z This symbol indicates actions which lead to environmental awareness.
Z The details "right", "left", "front" and "rear" always refer to the vehicle in direc-
tion of travel.
Z All dimensions and weight details are "approximate".
Z The metric specifications are binding for physical dimensions.
Introduction
2
18 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
The reprinting, translation and copying, including extracts is not permitted without
prior written authorisation from the manufacturer.
2.1 General
The vehicle is constructed in accordance with the latest technology and the recog-
nised safety regulations. Nevertheless, personal injury may result and the vehicle
may be damaged if the safety instructions in this instruction manual are not fol-
lowed.
Only use the vehicle in a technically impeccable condition. Follow the instructions
in the instruction manual.
Malfunctions which impair the safety of persons or the vehicle should be immedi-
ately remedied by qualified personnel. To avoid further damages, observe the duty
to avert, minimize or mitigate loss for the user during faults.
Have the vehicle's braking and gas systems inspected and repaired by an author-
ised specialist workshop only.
Alterations to the body are only to be carried out with the authorisation of the man-
ufacturer.
The vehicle is designed for the exclusive transport of persons. Luggage and acces-
sories may only be transported up to the maximum permissible gross weight.
Observe the test and inspection periods stipulated by the manufacturer.
2.2 Environmental tips
Z Be considerate of the environment.
Z Remember that: All kinds of waste water and household waste are not to be dis-
posed of in drains or in the open countryside.
Z On board, collect waste water only in the waste water tank or if necessary – in
other containers designed for that purpose.
Z Only empty the waste water tank and toilet cassette or sewage tank at disposal
stations at the camping or caravan sites, which are especially provided for this
purpose. When stopping in towns and communities, observe the instructions at
caravan sites or ask where there are disposal stations.
Z Empty waste water tank as often as possible, even when it is not completely full
(hygiene).
If possible, flush out waste water tank and, if necessary, drainage pipe with fresh
water every time it is emptied.
Z Never allow the toilet cassette or sewage tank to become too full. Empty the
toilet cassette or sewage tank frequently, at the latest as soon as the level indi-
cator lights up.
Z Separate household waste according to glass, tin cans, plastic and wet waste
also when on a journey. Enquire at the town or community authority about dis-
posal points. Household waste is not to be disposed of in waste paper baskets
which are situated at car parks.
Z Empty waste bins as often as possible into the containers provided for this pur-
pose. This helps to avoid unpleasant smells and an accumulation of rubbish on
board.
Z When parked, do not allow the engine to run more than necessary. When run-
ning idle, a cold engine releases more contaminants than usual. The running
temperature of the engine is achieved more quickly whilst the vehicle is in
motion.
Introduction
2
19Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
2.3 Licence categories / Registration
Your motorhome's registration is not subject to the ban on Sunday driving in Ger-
many as specified in Section 30 StVO (German Road Traffic Act).
1. Categories for which the driving licence was issued
2. Date of issue of the driving licence (categories not issued are invalidated by a
solid line)
3. Date of validity of driving licence categories issued for a limited period
4. Restrictions and additional specifications (including constraints) in encoded
form
Z Use an environmentally-friendly WC chemical agent for the WC which can also
be biologically degraded and only use small doses.
Z When staying in towns and communities for long periods, search for parking
areas which are specially reserved for motorhomes. Enquire at the town or com-
munity authority about parking spaces.
Z Always leave the parking places in a clean condition.
Z Before embarking on your journey get information on the licence category
required to drive your vehicle.
Fig. 1 EU driving licence front Fig. 2 EU driving licence rear
1
2 3 4
Class Description
B Motor vehicles – with the exception of motorcycles and motor tricycles –
with a maximum authorised mass not exceeding 3,500 kilograms and having
not more than eight seats in addition to the driver's seat (also combined with
a trailer having a maximum authorised mass not exceeding 750 kg or a heavy
trailer, provided the maximum authorised mass of the combination does not
exceed 3,500 kilograms).
BE Combinations of a tractor vehicle in Category B and a trailer, where the maxi-
mum authorised mass of the combination does not exceed 3,500 kilograms.
C1 Motor vehicles with a maximum authorised mass exceeding 3,500 kilograms
but not exceeding 7,500 kilograms and having not more than eight seats in
addition to the driver's seat (also combined with a trailer having a maximum
authorised mass not exceeding 750 kilograms).
Source: ADAC: "Der neue EU-Führerschein 2013" ("The new EU driving licence 2013")
Introduction
2
20 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
C1E Combinations of a tractor vehicle in Category C1 and a trailer exceeding 750
kilograms or in Category B and a trailer exceeding 3,500 kilograms, where the
maximum authorised mass of the combination does not exceed
12,000 kilograms respectively.
C Motor vehicles with a maximum authorised mass exceeding 3,500 kilograms
and having not more than eight seats in addition to the driver's seat (also
combined with a trailer having a maximum authorised mass not exceeding
750 kilograms).
CE Combinations of a tractor vehicle in Category C and a trailer with a maximum
authorised mass exceeding 750 kilograms.
Class Description
Source: ADAC: "Der neue EU-Führerschein 2013" ("The new EU driving licence 2013")
Safety
3
21Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
3Safety
Chapter overview
This chapter contains important safety instructions. The safety instructions are for
the protection of persons and property.
The instructions address the following topics:
z rescue card
z fire prevention and what to do in case of fire
z general care of the vehicle
z road safety of the vehicle
z towing
z gas system of the vehicle
z electrical system of the vehicle
z water system of the vehicle
3.1 Rescue card
The rescue card contains vehicle-specific information and can reduce the time
required for rescuing in case of an accident. The rescue card shows, for example,
where the gas bottles, the fuel tank, the gas-pressure shock absorbers or the bat-
teries are located.
Place the rescue card clearly visible in the glove compartment and attach the label
"Rescue card in vehicle" at the top or bottom left of the windscreen. The label is
available in any ADAC branch.
You can download the respective rescue card for your vehicle from the Dethleffs
homepage under "Service / Rescue cards" and print it out.
3.2 Fire prevention
3.2.1 Avoidance of fire risks
3.2.2 Fire-fighting
X Never leave children in the vehicle unattended.
X Keep flammable materials clear of heating and cooking appliances.
X Lights can get very hot. When the light is switched on, there must always be
a safety distance of 30 cm between light and flammable objects. Fire hazard!
X Never use portable heating or cooking appliances.
X Only authorised qualified personnel may make changes to the electrical
system, gas system or appliances.
X Always carry a dry powder fire extinguisher in the vehicle. The fire extin-
guisher must be approved, tested and close at hand.
X The fire extinguisher is not included in the scope of delivery.
X Have the fire extinguisher tested at regular intervals by authorised qualified
personnel. Observe the date of testing.
X Always keep a fire blanket near the cooker.
Safety
3
22 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
3.2.3 Gas odour
All the windows and doors that fulfil the following criteria rate as emergency exists:
z Opening outwards or moving in the horizontal direction
z Opening angle at least 70°
z Diameter of the clear opening at least 450 mm
z Maximum distance to vehicle floor 950 mm
3.3 General
X Evacuate all passengers.
X Cut off the electrical power supply and disconnect from the mains.
X Make sure the area is sufficiently ventilated (open storage flaps).
X Close regulator tap on the gas bottle.
X Sound the alarm and call the fire brigade.
X Fight the fire if this is possible without risk.
X Close the gas valve. Inspection by specialised personnel.
Z Acquaint yourself with the position and operation of the emergency exits.
Z Keep escape routes clear.
Z Observe the fire extinguisher instructions for use.
Z Take the rescue card into account!
X The oxygen in the vehicle interior is used up by breathing and the use of gas
operated appliances. That is why the oxygen needs to be replaced on a con-
stant basis. For this purpose, forced ventilation options (e.g. skylights with
forced ventilation, mushroom-shaped vents or floor vents) are fitted to the
vehicle. Never cover or block forced ventilations from the inside or outside
with objects such as e.g. a winter mat. Keep forced ventilations clear of snow
and leaves. There is a danger of suffocation due to increased CO
2
levels.
X Observe the headroom of the doors.
Z As far as the fitted appliances (heater, cooker, refrigerator, etc.) and the base
vehicle (engine, brakes, etc.) are concerned, the instruction manuals are author-
itative. It is imperative that they be observed.
Z Fitting accessories or special equipment can alter the dimensions, weight and
road behaviour of the vehicle. Some of the parts must be entered in the vehicle
papers.
Z Only use wheel rims and tyres which are approved for the vehicle. Information
concerning the size of the approved wheel rims and tyres is included in the
vehicle documents or can be obtained from authorised dealers and service cen-
tres.
Z Firmly apply the handbrake when parking the vehicle.
Z If the maximum permissible gross weight of the vehicle exceeds 4 tonnes,
wheel chocks must be used when parking on gradients. The wheel chocks are
provided as standard for vehicles with a maximum permissible gross weight
exceeding 4 tonnes.
Safety
3
23Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
3.4 Road safety
Z When leaving the vehicle, it is imperative that all doors, external flaps and win-
dows are closed.
Z Carry a hazard warning triangle and a first-aid kit and/or flashing hazard
warning light when this is required by law.
Z The vehicle may only be driven by drivers who hold a driving licence which is
valid for the respective vehicle class.
Z When selling the vehicle, hand over all instruction manuals for the vehicle and
the fitted appliances.
X Before commencing the journey, carry out a functional check of indicating
and lighting equipment, the steering and the brakes.
X If the vehicle has been stationary for a long period (approx. 10 months) have
the braking and gas systems checked by an authorised specialist workshop.
X Before commencing the journey and after short interruptions of the journey,
ensure that the entrance step is completely retracted.
X Before commencing the journey, secure the hinged pull-down bed.
X Before commencing the journey, open, lock in position and secure the
shades on the windscreen and on the driver's and front passenger's win-
dows.
X Before commencing the journey, rotate all swivel seats in the direction of
travel and lock in position. During the journey, the swivel seats must remain
locked in place in the direction of travel.
X Before commencing the journey, remove the television from the support
and store it securely.
X Before commencing the journey, place the television console in the alcove to
secure it from turning.
X Before commencing the journey, place and secure the flat screen and screen
support in the initial position. If the screen holder is installed in a TV cabinet:
Close TV cabinet.
X Before starting the journey, take the loose covers of the sink and drain basin
off and store securely in the kitchen unit or wardrobe.
X During the journey, persons are only to sit on the permitted seats (see
chapter 5). The authorised number of seats is stipulated in the vehicle docu-
ments.
X Seat belts must be worn by all passengers.
X Fasten your seat belts before the beginning of the journey and keep them
fastened during the journey.
X It is not permitted to stay in the alcove during the journey.
X Always secure children with the children safety equipment prescribed for the
respective height and weight.
X Factory-set three-point safety belts must be used when attaching child
restraint systems.
X The base vehicle is a commercial vehicle (small truck). Adjust your driving
technique accordingly.
X In case of underpasses, tunnels or similar obstacles, note the total height of
the vehicle (including the roof load).
X In winter, the roof must be free of snow and ice before commencing the
journey.
Safety
3
24 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
3.5 Towing
X Check tyre pressure before a journey or every 2 weeks. Wrong tyre pressure
causes excessive wear and can lead to damage or even to tyre burst. You can
lose control of the vehicle.
X Do not operate the independent vehicle heater at petrol stations. Danger of
explosion!
X Do not operate the independent vehicle heater in closed spaces. Danger of
suffocation!
Z Before commencing the journey, distribute the payload evenly within the
vehicle (see chapter 4).
Z When loading the vehicle and when taking a rest from driving, in order to load
luggage or food, for example, observe the maximum permissible gross weight
and axle loads (refer to vehicle documents).
Z Before commencing the journey, ensure that all cupboard doors, the toilet com-
partment door and all drawers and flaps are secure. Engage the refrigerator
door securing device.
Z Before commencing the journey, lower the table and fix it to the holder on the
floor of the vehicle.
Z Before commencing the journey, close windows and skylights.
Z Before commencing the journey, close all external flaps and lock them.
Z Before commencing the journey, remove the external supports and retract the
corner steadies or steady legs, which are fitted to the vehicle.
Z Before commencing the journey, put the antenna in park position.
Z During the initial journey and each time after changing a wheel, re-tighten the
wheel bolts/wheel nuts after 50 km (30 miles). Subsequently inspect them at
regular intervals in order to ensure that they are firmly seated.
Z Tyres may not be older than 6 years as the material becomes brittle over time
(see chapter 15).
Z When using snow chains, the tyres, wheel suspension and steering are sub-
jected to an additional load. When using snow chains, drive slowly (maximum
speed 50 km/h) and only on streets which are completely covered with snow.
Otherwise the vehicle could be damaged.
X Care is to be taken when connecting and detaching a trailer. Risk of accident
and injury!
X No persons are to be between the towing vehicle and the trailer during posi-
tioning for connecting and detaching.
Safety
3
25Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
3.6 Gas system
3.6.1 General instructions
X Before commencing the journey, when leaving the vehicle or when gas
equipment is not in use, close all gas isolator taps and the main isolator tap
on the gas bottle.
X No appliance operated by a naked flame (e.g. heater or refrigerator) may be
in operation when filling the tank, on ferries or in the garage. Danger of
explosion!
X Do not use appliances operated with a naked flame in closed spaces (e.g.
garages). Danger of poisoning and suffocation!
X Only have the gas system maintained, repaired or altered by an authorised
specialist workshop.
X Have the gas system checked by an authorised specialist workshop
according to the national regulations before commissioning. This also
applies for not registered vehicles. For modifications to the gas system have
the gas system immediately checked by an authorised specialist workshop.
X The gas pressure regulator and exhaust gas pipes must also be inspected.
The gas pressure regulator has to be replaced after 10 years at the latest. The
vehicle owner is responsible for seeing that this is carried out.
X In case of a defect of the gas system (gas odour, high gas consumption) there
is danger of explosion! Close regulator tap on the gas bottle immediately.
Open doors and windows and ventilate well.
X If the gas system is defective: Do not smoke; do not ignite any open flames,
and do not operate electric switches (light switches etc.).
X Before using the cooker make sure that there is sufficient ventilation. Open
windows or the skylight.
X Do not use the gas cooker or gas oven for heating purposes.
X If there are several gas devices, each gas device must have its own gas iso-
lator tap. If individual gas devices are not in use, close the respective gas iso-
lator tap.
X Ignition safety valves must close within 1 minute after the gas flame has
extinguished. A clicking sound is audible. Check function from time to time.
X The built-in gas devices are exclusively meant for use with propane or butane
gas or a mixture of both. The gas pressure regulator as well as all built-in gas
devices are designed for a gas pressure of 30 mbar.
X Propane gas is capable of gasification up to -42 °C, whereas butane gas gas-
ifies at 0 °C. Below these temperatures no gas pressure is available. Butane
gas is unsuitable for use in winter.
X Regularly inspect the gas tube fitted to the gas bottle connection for tight-
ness. The gas tube must not have any tears and must not be porous. Have the
gas tube replaced by an authorised specialist workshop no later than
ten years after the manufacturing date. The operator of the gas system must
see to it that the parts are replaced.
X Due to its function and construction, the gas bottle compartment is a space
which is open to the exterior. Never cover or block up the standard forced
ventilations. Otherwise gas that is emitted can not be diverted to the outside.
X Do not use the gas bottle compartment as storage space as it is not moisture-
proof.
X Secure the gas bottle compartment against unauthorised access. To do this,
lock the compartment.
Safety
3
26 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
3.6.2 Gas bottles
3.7 Electrical system
X The regulator tap on the gas bottle must be accessible.
X Only connect gas-operated devices (e.g. gas grill) which have been designed
for a gas pressure of 30 mbar.
X The exhaust gas pipe must be fitted tightly to the heating system and to the
vent and must be sealed. The exhaust gas pipe must not show any evidence
of damage.
X Exhaust fumes must be able to escape into the atmosphere unhindered and
fresh air must be able to enter unhindered. For this reason, keep the exhaust
pipe and intake openings clean and unobstructed (e.g. free from snow and
ice). For this reason, no snow walls or aprons may lie against the vehicle.
X Gas bottles are only to be transported within the designated gas bottle com-
partment.
X Place the gas bottles in vertical position in the gas bottle compartment.
X Fasten the gas bottles so that they are unable to turn or tilt.
X If the gas bottles are not connected to the gas tube, always place the protec-
tive cap on top.
X Close the regulator tap on the gas bottle before the gas pressure regulator or
gas tube are removed from the gas bottle.
X The gas pressure regulator or the gas tube must only be secured with a suit-
able gas spanner (Do not overtighten).
X Only use special gas pressure regulators with a safety valve designed for
vehicle use. Other gas pressure regulators are not permitted and cannot
meet the demanding requirements.
X Use the gas pressure regulator defroster if the temperature falls below 5 °C.
X Use only 11 kg or 5 kg gas bottles. Camping gas bottles with built-in check
valve (blue bottle with max. 2.5 or 3 kg content) are can be used in excep-
tional cases with a safety valve.
X Use the shortest possible tube lengths (150 cm max.) for external gas bottles.
X Never block the floor ventilation openings below the gas bottles.
X Only allow qualified personnel to work on the electrical system.
X Prior to carrying out work on the electrical system, switch off all devices and
lights, disconnect the battery and disconnect the vehicle from the mains.
X Only use original fuses with the stipulated values.
X Only replace defective fuses when the cause of the defect is known and has
been remedied.
X Never bridge or repair fuses.
Safety
3
27Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
3.8 Water system
X Water left standing in the water tank or in the water pipes becomes undrink-
able after a short period. Therefore, before each use of the vehicle, thor-
oughly clean the water pipes and the water tank. After each use of the
vehicle completely empty the water tank and the water pipes.
X In the case of lay-ups lasting more than a week disinfect the water system
before using the vehicle.
Z If the vehicle is not used for several days or if it is not heated when there is a risk
of frost, empty the entire water system. Leave the water taps on in central posi-
tion. Leave the safety/drainage valve (if there is one) and all drain cocks open.
Frost damage to appliances, frost damage to the vehicle and deposits in water-
carrying components can be avoided in this way.
Safety
3
28 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Before the journey
4
29Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
4Before the journey
Chapter overview
This chapter contains important information which has to be noted before com-
mencing your journey or carrying out any tasks before the journey.
The instructions address the following topics:
z keys
z registration
z calculating the payload
z correct loading of the vehicle
z towing
z retracting and extending the entrance step
z PVC-floor covering
z storing the television
z using snow chains
At the end of the chapter there is a checklist which once again summarises the
most important points.
4.1 Keys
Your vehicle comes complete with all the keys required for the vehicle.
These are e.g.:
Two keys each for
z ignition lock
z driver's and passenger's doors (if available)
z fuel tank
z conversion door of the body
z drinking water filler neck (only with external filler neck)
z external flaps
Always deposit a replacement key outside the vehicle. Write down the respective
key number. Our authorised dealers and workshops can offer assistance in case of
loss.
4.2 Registration
Your motorhome is a vehicle which must be registered. Observe national regula-
tions on registration.
Please remember that certain countries require a separate national code sticker in
addition to the EU plate.
Before the journey
4
30 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
4.3 Payload
On loading, make sure that the payload's centre of gravity is as low as possible
(directly above the floor of the vehicle). Otherwise this may affect the driving char-
acteristics of the vehicle.
4.3.1 Terms
Maximum permissible
gross weight in a laden
condition
The maximum permissible gross weight in a laden condition is the weight that a
vehicle may never exceed.
The maximum permissible overall weight in laden condition consists of the mass
in ready-to-drive condition and of the payload.
In the vehicle documents, the manufacturer has specified the maximum permis-
sible gross weight in a laden condition.
X Overloading the vehicle and wrong tyre pressure can cause tyres to burst.
You can lose control of the vehicle.
X Only the maximum permissible gross weight and the mass in a ready-to-
drive condition, not the actual weight of the vehicle, is stated in the vehicle
documents. For your own safety, we recommend that you have your loaded
vehicle (with all passengers, luggage and personal objects) weighed on a
public weighbridge before you set out on your journey.
X Adapt the speed to the payload. The stopping distance is increased if the
payload is high.
Z Do not exceed the maximum permissible gross weight stated in the vehicle
documents by the payload.
Z Built-in accessories and special equipment reduce the payload.
Z Adhere to the axle load stated in the vehicle documents.
Description Load (kg)
Maximum permitted
payloads
Motorhome roof rack 100
Bike rack Triple 50
Quadruple 60
Motorcycle rack 100
Rear garage and rear storage space (dependent on model -
please contact your dealer for further information)
150
Overcab bed 200
Pull-down bed model I 200
Rear bed 200
Bunk beds 60
Folding beds 50
Z Technically speaking, the term "mass" has now replaced the term "weight".
However, "weight" is still the term more frequent in common use. For better
understanding, "mass" is therefore only used in the following sections for fixed
formulations.
Z All specifications according to EU norm DIN EN 1646-2.
Before the journey
4
31Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Permitted mass The permitted mass is the weight specified by the manufacturer for issuing the
type approval. The permitted mass must never exceed the maximum permissible
gross weight of the loaded vehicle.
Mass in ready-to-drive
condition
The mass in ready-to-drive condition is the weight of the ready-to-drive standard
vehicle.
The mass in ready-to-drive condition is made up as follows:
z Unladen weight (mass of the empty vehicle) with factory-installed standard
equipment
z Driver's weight
z Basic equipment weight
Unladen weight includes lubricants such as oils and coolants which have been
filled, the on-board tool set, the spare wheel and a fuel tank which has been filled
up to 90 %.
75 kg are calculated for the weight of the driver, regardless of how much the driver
really weighs.
Basic equipment includes all equipment and fluids required for safe and proper
vehicle use. The weight of the basic equipment includes:
z Water system filled up to 90 % (water tank and pipes)
z Gas bottles filled up to 90 %
z A full heating system
z A full toilet flushing system
z The power cables for the 240 V power supply
z The installation kit for an auxiliary battery if an auxiliary battery can be used
The waste water and sewage tanks are empty.
In the vehicle documents, the manufacturer specifies the mass in ready-to-drive
conditions.
Payload The payload is made up as follows:
z Conventional load
z Additional equipment
z Personal equipment
You will find explanations on the individual components of the payload in the fol-
lowing text.
Example for calculating
the basic equipment
Water tank with 120 l 120 kg
Gas bottles (2 x 11 kg
gas
+ 2 x 14 kg
bottle
) + 50 kg
Boiler with 12 l + 12 kg
240 V power cable + 4 kg
Installation kit for auxiliary battery + 20 kg
Total = 206 kg
Z The vehicle's payload can be increased by reducing the weight in a ready-to-
drive condition. To do this, it is allowed for example to empty the fluid con-
tainers or to remove the gas bottles.
Before the journey
4
32 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Conventional load The conventional load is the weight specified by the manufacturer for the passen-
gers.
Conventional load means: 75 kg are calculated for every seat specified by the man-
ufacturer, regardless of how much the passengers actually weigh. The driver's seat
is already included as part of the mass in ready-to-drive condition and must not be
calculated as part of the conventional load.
In the vehicle documents, the manufacturer specifies the number of seats.
Additional equipment Additional equipment includes accessories and special equipment. Examples of
additional equipment include:
z Caravan coupling
z Awning
z Bike or motorcycle rack
z Satellite unit
Chapter 17 lists the weights of the various items of special equipment; they may
also be obtained from the manufacturer.
Personal equipment Personal equipment includes all items in the vehicle that are not included in the
conventional load or in the additional equipment. For example, personal equip-
ment can include the following:
z Foodstuffs
z Crockery
z Television
z Radio
z Clothes
z Bedding
z Toys
z Books
z Toiletries
No matter where kept, personal equipment also includes:
z Animals
z Bikes
z Boats
z Surfboards
z Sports equipment
For the personal equipment, according to the applicable regulations, the manufac-
turer must use a minimum weight that is determined according to the following
formula:
Formula Minimum weight M (kg) = 10 x N + 10 x L
Explanation N = maximum number of people including the driver, as stated by the manufac-
turer
L = total length of the vehicle in metres
Before the journey
4
33Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
4.3.2 Calculating the payload
The payload (see section 4.3.1) is the difference in weight between
z Maximum permissible gross weight in a laden condition and
z Vehicle mass complete in a ready-to-drive condition.
The calculation of the payload from the difference between the maximum permis-
sible gross weight in laden condition and the mass specified by the manufacturer
in ready-to-drive condition is however only a theoretical value.
Only if the vehicle is weighed with full tanks (fuel and water), full gas bottles and
complete additional equipment on a public weighbridge, can the actual payload
be determined.
To do this, proceed as follows:
First only drive the vehicle on to the weighbridge with the front wheels and
have it weighed.
Then drive the vehicle on to the weighbridge with the back wheels and have it
weighed.
The individual values give the current axle loads. These are important for the cor-
rect loading of the vehicle (see section 4.3.3). The sum of these values is the current
weight of the vehicle.
The actual payload is the difference between the maximum permissible gross
weight in laden condition and the weighed vehicle weight.
This can be used to determine the weight that remains for the personal equipment:
Determine the weight of the passengers and subtract it from the value for the
actual payload.
The result is the weight that is permitted for the actual load of the personal equip-
ment.
X The payload calculation at the factory is partly based on all-inclusive weights.
For safety reasons, the maximum permissible gross weight in a laden condi-
tion must not be exceeded.
X Only the maximum permissible gross weight and the mass in a ready-to-
drive condition, not the actual weight of the vehicle, is stated in the vehicle
documents. For your own safety, we recommend that you have your loaded
vehicle (with all passengers, luggage and personal objects) weighed on a
public weighbridge before you set out on your journey.
Mass in kg to be cal-
culated
Calculation
Example for calculating
the payload
Maximum permissible gross weight accord-
ing to vehicle documents
3500
Vehicle mass in a ready-to-drive condition,
including basic equipment according to ve-
hicle documents
- 3070
This results in a permissible payload of 430
Conventional load e.g.: 3 persons each
weighing 75 kg
- 225
Additional equipment - 40
For the personal equipment this results in = 165
Before the journey
4
34 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
4.3.3 Loading the vehicle correctly
Large storage spaces, such as the rear garage, also have room for heavy objects
(e.g. motorcycle). This might mean that the axle load on the rear axle is exceeded.
However, the individual axles may not be overloaded under any circumstances.
That is why it is important, at which distance to the axles the load is stored.
To distribute the load correctly, you will need a scale, a tape measure, a calculator
and some time.
Two simple formulas are needed to calculate the effect of the weight of the load on
the axles:
Formulas A x G : R = weight on the rear axle
Weight on the rear axle – G = weight on the front axle
Explanation A = distance between storage compartment and front axle in cm
G = weight of the load in the storage compartment in kg
R = wheelbase of the vehicle (distance between axles) in cm
Calculating axle loads:
Multiply the distance between storage compartment and front axle (A) with the
weight of the load in the storage compartment (G) and divide the result by the
wheelbase (R). The result is the weight of the load in the storage compartment
on the rear axle. Make a note of this weight and of the storage compartment.
In a second step, subtract the weight in the storage compartment (G) from the
weight calculated beforehand. If the result is a positive value (example 1), this
means that the load on the front axle is reduced by this value. If the result is a
negative value (example 2), this means that the load on the front axle is
increased. Make a note of this value, too.
X For safety reasons, never exceed the maximum permissible gross weight in a
laden condition.
X Distribute the load evenly on the left and right sides of the vehicle.
X Distribute the load evenly on both axles. In doing so, observe the axle loads
specified in the vehicle documents. Observe the permissible load-carrying
capacity of the tyres (see chapter 15).
X Heavy loads behind the rear axle can reduce the load on the front axle due to
the leverage effect ( ). This applies especially to long rear extensions, if a
motorbike is transported on the rear carrier or if there is a heavy load in the
rear storage space. The release of the front axle negatively affects the driving
quality, especially for front-driven vehicles.
X Store all objects in such a way that they cannot slip.
X Store heavy objects (awning, tin cans, etc.) close to the axles. Low-lying
storage compartments whose doors do not open in the direction of travel
are particularly suited for storing heavy objects.
X Stack light objects (laundry) in the roof storage cabinets.
X Load the bike rack with bicycles only (max. four units).
Z Measure the external distances horizontally from the centre of the front wheel
to the centre of the storage compartment or to the centre of the back wheel.
Before the journey
4
35Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Calculate all storage compartments of the vehicle in the same way.
In a last step, add all weights calculated for the rear axle to the rear axle load and
add (or subtract) all weights calculated for the front axle to (from) the front axle
load.
How to determine rear axle load and front axle load is described in section 4.3.2.
If the calculated value exceeds the permissible axle load, the load must be distrib-
uted in a different way.
If the load on the front axle is too low, the grip of the tyres on the road is reduced
(traction). This applies in particular to vehicles with front wheel drive. In this case,
the load must be redistributed, too.
4.3.4 Roof loads
Example 1 Example 2
Example calculation
Distance to the front axle A (A1) 450 (cm) (A2) 250 (cm)
Weight in the storage compartment G x 100 (kg) x 50 (kg)
Wheelbase of the vehicle R ÷ 325 (cm) ÷ 325 (cm)
Load on the rear axle
(add to the axle load)
138.5 (kg) 38.5 (kg)
Weight in the storage compartment - 100 (kg) - 50 (kg)
Load relief to the front axle
(subtract from the axle load)
38.5 (kg)
Load on the front axle
(add to the axle load)
-11.5 (kg)
X Only climb onto the roof via the ladder at the rear.
X Be careful when stepping onto the ladder. There is danger of slipping if the
ladder is wet or icy.
X Take care when stepping onto the roof. There is danger of slipping when the
roof is wet or icy.
X Do not place too much load on the roof. The road behavior and the stopping
behavior deteriorate as the roof load increases.
X Observe maximum roof load of 100 kg!
X Roofs with glass-fibre reinforced plastic (GRP) surfaces have expansion joints
approx. 150 mm wide in the longitudinal direction on both sides of the roof
in order to prevent excessive expansion of the roof during extreme sunshine.
The GRP covering layer is not bonded in this area. During normal tempera-
tures a slight curvature which expands when heated up is visible. Do not step
onto this area or mount subsequent attachments or accessories.
Z The vehicle roof is not suitable for localised load. Before stepping on to the
roof, extensively cover the area you will be treading on. Materials with a
smooth or soft surface are suitable, for example, a thick polystyrene panel.
Z If the vehicle is equipped with a roof rail, load racks can be mounted on the roof
rail for roof loads (e.g. for surfboards, rubber boats or light canoes). Special
girder systems are available as accessories. The authorised dealer or service
centre will be happy to advise you.
Z The maximum permissible roof load amounts to 100 kg.
Before the journey
4
36 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Rear ladder
Folding downwards:
Insert the key into the locking cylinder (Fig. 3,2) of the rear-ladder locking mech-
anism (Fig. 3,1) and turn it a quarter turn until the key is vertical.
Hold the part of the rear ladder that can fold (Fig. 3,4) and swivel out the safety
catch (Fig. 3,5).
Remove the key and fold down the rear ladder.
Folding upwards:
Fold up the rear ladder and hold it.
Insert the key into the locking cylinder (Fig. 3,2) of the rear-ladder locking mech-
anism (Fig. 3,1).
Swivel the safety catch (Fig. 3,5) inwards around the tube of the fixed part of the
rear ladder (Fig. 3,3).
Turn the key a quarter turn until the key is horizontal.
Check that the rear ladder is locked in place: Pull on the rear ladder lightly.
Z Secure roof loads with tension belts. Do not use rubber expanders.
Z Observe the overall height of the vehicle when the roof rack is loaded.
Z A clearly visible notice stating the overall height should be mounted in the
driver's cabin. This eliminates the need for calculations at bridges and thor-
oughfares.
Fig. 3 Rear-ladder locking mechanism
Before the journey
4
37Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
4.3.5 Fastening system in the rear area
Shifting the fastening rings: Turn the fastening ring (Fig. 4,1) half a rotation anticlockwise.
Slide the fastening ring in the fastening rail (Fig. 4,2) to the desired position.
Turn the fastening ring half a turn clockwise. The fastening ring is seated firmly
again in the fastening rail.
Check that the fastening ring is seated firmly.
4.3.6 Double floor
X Observe the permissible axle loads and maximum permissible gross weight
when loading the rear garage/rear storage space.
X The maximum permitted load of the rear garage/rear storage space amounts
to between 150 kg and 250 kg depending on the model. Do not exceed the
permissible rear axle load.
X Note: If the rear garage or (depending on the model) the rear storage space
is loaded to the maximum, the front axle is relieved through the leverage
effect. The driving characteristics deteriorate.
Z Depending on the vehicle equipment fastening rails with fastening rings are
mounted in the rear garage or in the rear storage space. Always secure the load
at the fastening rings. Use fasten belts or fastening nets for fastening, but never
rubber expanders.
Z Before fastening the load always check that the fastening rings are seated firmly
in the fastening rail. If the fastening rings are not anchored firmly in the fas-
tening rail, intensive steering movements or braking can cause the load to
move and loosen.
Z Distribute the load evenly. Excessive point loads damage the floor covering.
Fig. 4 Fastening rings rear garage
1 Fastening ring
2 Fastening rail
X Observe the permissible axle loads and maximum permissible gross weight
when loading the double floor.
Z Distribute the load evenly. Excessive spot loads can lead to damages of the floor
covering.
Before the journey
4
38 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
4.3.7 Bike rack
Loading the bike rack with
bicycles
When loading the bike rack, observe the centre of gravity. The centre of gravity of
the bicycles must be as close as possible to the rear wall of the vehicle. The bike rack
should always be loaded from the inside to the outside.
Loading the bike rack correctly:
Depending on the model, fold the bike rack down or pull it out.
Place the heaviest bicycle directly against the rear wall.
Place the lightest bicycles in the centre or on the outside of the bike rack.
Secure the front and rear wheels of each bicycle with the retaining straps on the
bike rack.
In addition, fasten the outermost bicycle depending on the model of the bike
rack on the retaining clip or the retaining bracket and to the spacer respectively.
If the bike rack is only loaded with one bicycle, position the bicycle as closely as
possible to the rear wall.
X Observe the permissible axle loads and maximum permissible gross weight
when loading the bike rack.
X Bicycles may not jut out beyond the maximum width of the vehicle. Adjust
the attachments for the bikes accordingly.
X Load the bike rack with bicycles only (max. four units).
X Check the secure attachment of the bicycles on the bike rack after the first
10 km and then at each break in the journey.
X Observe the permissible payload (50-60 kg depending on the model).
Z The identification plate and rear lights must not be covered.
Z Driving with a folded out bike rack without bicycles is not permitted.
Z Before every journey, check:
Is the bike rack without bicycles folded in correctly?
Are the bicycles securely fastened to the bike rack using the bike rack belts?
Is the bike rack locked?
Z Further information can be obtained in the manufacturer's instruction manual.
Before the journey
4
39Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
4.4 Towing
4.4.1 Tow coupling
The tow coupling can be mounted and removed after use. Attaching of a trailer is
described in the manufacturer instructions.
Mounting:
Set the tow coupling (Fig. 5,2) at an angle of 90° to the latch (Fig. 5,1).
Swivel the tow coupling (Fig. 5,2) downwards until the latch (Fig. 5,1) latches
in.
Removing:
Press the latch (Fig. 5,1) upwards.
Swivel the tow coupling (Fig. 5,2) 90° to the left.
Release the latch (Fig. 5,1).
Remove the tow coupling (Fig. 5,2).
X Care is to be taken when connecting and detaching a trailer. Risk of accident
and injury!
X No persons are to be between the towing vehicle and the trailer during posi-
tioning for connecting and detaching.
X Observe the permissible nose weight and rear axle load of the towing
vehicle. Nose weight and rear axle load must not be exceeded. The values of
the nose weight and rear axle load are included in the documents of the
vehicle and the caravan coupling.
Z Trailer with an overrun brake: Do not connect or detach the trailer with the
overrun brake on.
Z Tow coupling with detachable ball neck: If the ball neck is installed incorrectly,
the trailer can break away. Observe the instruction manual issued by the tow
coupling manufacturer.
Z Check the rip cord and electrical connection.
Z Check the lighting.
Fig. 5 Tow coupling
Before the journey
4
40 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
4.5 Entrance step
4.5.1 Mechanically operated entrance step
Pulling out: Pull the entrance step forwards (Fig. 6,2) until it latches into place.
Pushing in:
Slightly lift the entrance step (Fig. 6,1).
Push the entrance step as far as it will go under the base of the vehicle (Fig. 6,3).
Ensure that the entrance step latches in place (Fig. 6,4).
X Before commencing the journey and after short interruptions of the journey,
ensure that the entrance step is completely retracted.
X Do not stand in the direct range of the entrance step while it is being
retracted or extended.
X Do not step on the entrance step until it has extended completely. There is a
risk of injury.
X Do not under any circumstances raise or lower persons or loads with the
entrance step.
Z Take note of the different step heights and make certain that the ground is firm
and even when exiting.
Z Do not grease or lubricate the pivot bearing and joints of the entrance step (see
chapter 12).
Z If the entrance step has not been properly retracted and locked into place, a
warning tone is heard when the ignition is switched on.
Fig. 6 Mechanically operated entrance
step
Before the journey
4
41Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
4.5.2 Electrically operated entrance step
Before stepping on the entrance step, fully extend it (Fig. 7).
Operating switch The switch to operate the entrance step is located on the inside of the vehicle in the
area of the conversion door.
Extending:
Press the rocker switch (Fig. 8,1) down until the entrance step has extended
completely.
Retracting:
Press the rocker switch (Fig. 8,1) up until the entrance step has retracted com-
pletely.
Emergency operation If the electric drive of the entrance step fails, follow the instructions in the instruc-
tion manual of the component manufacturer to manually retract the step.
Push in the entrance step by hand and secure it or lock it using a suitable device.
Contact the customer service immediately.
4.6 PVC-floor covering
Z If the entrance step has not been properly retracted and locked into place, a
warning tone is heard when the ignition is switched on.
Z Follow the warning notice on the entrance step.
Fig. 7 Warning notice for entrance step
O.K.
Fig. 8 Operating switch entrance step
Z Shoes with pointed heels can leave permanent impressions in the PVC-floor
covering. Never wear shoes with pointed heels in the vehicle.
Z Rubber mats or long exposure to ketchup, carrot juice, ink, blood or lipstick can
discolour the PVC-floor covering. If possible, remove stains from the floor imme-
diately.
Before the journey
4
42 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
4.7 Television
Holder in the TV cabinet The flat screen is attached to a console in the TV cabinet.
Storing the flat screen:
Rotate the television to its initial position (Fig. 9) and lock it into place.
Use handle (Fig. 9,1) to push the holder for the flat screen backwards. The latch
(Fig. 9,2) will engage.
Close TV cabinet.
Holder with jointed arm The flat screen is fastened to a jointed arm.
Storing the flat screen:
Swivel flat screen back to its initial position and lock it into place.
X Before commencing the journey, remove the television from the support
and store it securely.
X Before commencing the journey, place and secure the flat screen and screen
support in the initial position. If the screen holder is installed in a TV cabinet:
Close TV cabinet.
X Before commencing the journey, ensure that the antenna is in park position.
Danger of accidents! Park position means: The antenna points towards the
back, is fully lowered and is locked in this position.
Z Further information on positioning the flat screen can be obtained from
chapter 7.
Fig. 9 Holder in the TV cabinet
Fig. 10 Holder with jointed arm
Before the journey
4
43Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
4.8 Sink cover
4.9 Driver's cabin Roman shade
4.9.1 Roman shade for driver's window and front passenger's window
Variant 1
Securing: On the Roman shades for the driver's and passenger's window, push the handle
(Fig. 12,1) onto the cap. The Roman shade is secured.
X In case of an accident or emergency braking the sink cover (Fig. 11,1) can
injure the vehicle passengers. Before the journey, take the sink cover off the
sink and store it securely in the kitchen block or wardrobe.
Fig. 11 Sink cover
X During the journey the Roman shades for the windscreen, the driver's
window and the front passenger's window must be opened, locked and
secured.
Fig. 12 Handle for Roman shades on
driver's/front passenger's win-
dows
Before the journey
4
44 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Variant 2
Securing:
Use the handles (Fig. 13,2) to push the Roman shades for the driver's window
and the front passenger's window under the covers and secure with the Velcro
loops (Fig. 13,1 and Fig. 13,3). The Roman shade is secured.
4.9.2 Roman shade for windscreen
Variant 1
Securing:
Use the handle (Fig. 14,2) to push the Roman shade for the windscreen upwards
until it latches it in place. Secure with the securing loop (Fig. 14,1). The Roman
shade is secured.
Fig. 13 Securing the Roman shades on
driver's/front passenger's win-
dows
Fig. 14 Securing the Roman shade for
the windscreen
Before the journey
4
45Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Variant 2
Securing: Use the handles (Fig. 15,1) to slide the Roman shades for the windscreen under
covers at the A column and fasten the handle on the cover. The Roman shade is
secured.
4.10 Central locking system for kitchen unit
The kitchen unit is equipped with a central locking system. The flaps and drawers
of the kitchen block can be locked and unlocked manually via the switch (Fig. 16).
Locking
Press the switch (Fig. 16,2). The flaps and drawers of the kitchen block are
locked.
Unlocking
Press the switch (Fig. 16,1). The flaps and drawers of the kitchen block are
unlocked.
When the engine is running When you start the vehicle engine, the central locking system is activated automat-
ically. The central locking unit can be disabled during the journey by pressing the
switch. It is locked again after the switch has been released and the opened panel
has been closed.
Fig. 15 Handle of the Roman shade of
the windscreen
Fig. 16 Switch for the kitchen unit's cen-
tral locking system
1
2
Z If a flap or a drawer is still open when the vehicle engine is started, it is locked
automatically after it is closed.
Before the journey
4
46 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
When the engine is not
running
If the vehicle is moved without using the engine, for example while being towed or
loaded, the battery cut-off switch (Fig. 17,1) has to be switched off while the motor
is running. This is the only method to open the lock of the flaps and drawers.
4.11 Snow chains
The use of snow chains is subject to the legal regulations of the individual coun-
tries.
z Always mount snow chains to the drive wheels.
z After a few metres, check the tension of the snow chains.
Fig. 17 Battery cut-off switch
Z Only mount snow chains if there is a clearance of at least 50 mm between the
tyres and the vehicle body.
Z When using snow chains, the tyres, wheel suspension and steering are sub-
jected to an additional load. When using snow chains, drive slowly (maximum
speed 50 km/h) and only on streets which are completely covered with snow.
Otherwise the vehicle could be damaged.
Z Observe the fitting instructions issued by the manufacturer of the snow chains.
Z Only use snow chains approved by the manufacturer.
Z In case of vehicles on IVECO chassis: Only use snow chains approved by IVECO.
Z Do not fit snow chains on alloy wheel rims.
Z If the drive axle of the vehicle has twin tyres (2 tyres next to each other), mount
the the snow chains to the outer tyres.
Z In the case of I-model vehicles only fine-linked snow chains may be used.
Before the journey
4
47Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
4.12 Road safety
Before commencing the journey, work through the checklist:
X Check tyre pressure before a journey or every 2 weeks. Wrong tyre pressure
causes excessive wear and can lead to damage or even to tyre burst. You can
lose control of the vehicle.
No. Checks Checked
Base vehicle
1 All vehicle documents are on board
2 Tyres in proper condition. If spare wheel or tyre repair kit exists,
check.
3 Vehicle lighting, brake lights and reversing lights function
4 Oil levels for engine, gearbox and power steering controlled
5 Coolant and fluid for windscreen washers filled up
6 Brakes function
7 Brakes react evenly
8 When braking, the vehicle remains in the lane
Housing body, outside
9 Awning completely retracted
10 Roof free of snow and ice (in winter)
11 External connections and lines disconnected and stored away
12 External supports removed
13 Fitted steady legs retracted and fixed in place
14 Wheel chocks removed and stored away
15 Entrance step retracted (observe warning tone)
16 External flaps closed and locked
17 Conversion door locked
18 Overall height of the vehicle including roof rack when loaded
measured and noted. Keep the height information close at hand in
the driver's cabin
Housing body, inside
19 Windows and skylights closed and locked
20 Television secured in the TV cabinet or removed from the support
and stored securely
21 Television antenna retracted (if one is built in)
22 Loose parts stored away or fixed in position
23 Open storage spaces empty
24 No gas cartridges or other easily flammable materials stored in the
roof cupboard of the awning light
25 Refrigerator door secured
26 Refrigerator set to 12 V operation
27 All drawers and flaps closed
28 Living area doors and sliding doors secured
29 Pull-down bed secured
Before the journey
4
48 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
30 Swivel seat locking device for driver's seat and front passenger's
seat locked
31 Children's seats mounted to seats with three-point safety belts
32 Shades in the driver's cabin opened and secured
Gas system
33 Gas bottles firmly fixed in the gas bottle compartment so that they
are unable to turn
34 Protective cap set on top of the gas bottle
35 Regulator tap on the gas bottle and gas isolator taps are closed
Electrical system
36 Check the battery voltage of the starter and living area battery (see
chapter 9). If the panel indicates that the battery voltage is too
low, the respective battery will need to be recharged. Observe the
notes and instructions in chapter 9
Z Commence journey with fully charged starter and living
area batteries.
No. Checks Checked
During the journey
5
49Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
5During the journey
Chapter overview
This chapter contains instructions on how to drive the motorhome.
The instructions address the following topics:
z driving speed
z brakes
z seat belts
z seats and headrests
z the backrest adjustment mechanism for the bench
z seating arrangement
z branch block
z electrical window winders
z electrically adjustable external mirrors
z Roman shades in the driver's cabin
z writing and reading rest
z bonnet
z windscreen washer fluid container
z checking the oil level
z filling the tank
5.1 Driving the motorhome
X The base vehicle is a commercial vehicle (small truck). Adjust your driving
technique accordingly.
X Before commencing the journey and after short interruptions of the journey,
ensure that the entrance step is completely retracted.
X During the journey, seat belts should always be worn at the seats that have
seat belts mounted.
X Never open your seat belts when travelling.
X Passengers must remain in the seats provided.
X The doors must remain locked.
X Avoid braking with a jerk.
X If a navigation system is used, only change the destination when the vehicle
is stationary. Drive to a car park or stop in a safe area when changing the des-
tination.
X Do not play DVDs using the monitor of the navigation system during the
journey.
Z Drive slowly on poor roads.
Z Take extreme care when driving onto ferries, crossing uneven roads and driving
in reverse. Because of the relatively large overhang, larger vehicles might swing
out and "touch ground" in unfavourable conditions. This can cause damage to
the underbody or to parts fitted there.
Z If an accident occurs as a result of these instructions not being observed, the
manufacturer will not be responsible for damages caused.
Z The safety measures stipulated in chapter 3 have to be observed.
Z If a reversing camera is installed in the vehicle, the camera is automatically
switched on when driving in reverse gear.
During the journey
5
50 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
5.2 Driving speed
5.3 Brakes
Before each journey Before each journey, check by means of a braking test:
z Do the brakes function?
z Do the brakes react evenly?
z Does the vehicle remain in the lane when braking?
5.4 Seat belts
The vehicle is equipped with automatic three-point safety belts in the living area on
the seats for which seat belts are compulsory by law. National regulations apply
seat-belt fastening.
X The vehicle is equipped with a powerful engine. This means there are suffi-
cient reserves in difficult traffic situations. This high power enables a high
maximum speed and requires above-average driving ability.
X The vehicle provides a large contact surface for wind. A sudden crosswind
can be especially dangerous.
X Uneven or one-sided loading affects road performance.
X Driving on unknown streets, you may encounter hazardous road conditions
and unexpected driving situations. Therefore, in the interest of safety, make
sure your driving speed is appropriate to any given driving situation and
environment.
X Adhere to the national legal speed limits.
X Have defects on the braking system immediately remedied by an authorised
specialist workshop.
Z Avoid block brakings. Block braking gives the tyres "brake plates" of varying
strength. This reduces driving comfort. It might even make the tyres unservice-
able.
X Fasten your seat belts before the beginning of the journey and keep them
fastened during the journey.
X Do not damage or trap belts. Have damaged seat belts changed by an
authorised specialist workshop.
X Do not alter the belt fixing devices, automatic seat belt winders and the belt
clips.
X Inspect the screwed connections of the seat belts from time to time in order
to ensure that they are correctly seated.
X Only use one seat belt for one adult person.
X Do not belt in objects together with persons.
X Seat belts are not sufficient for persons who are less than 150 cm tall. In these
cases use additional restraining devices. Observe test certificate.
X Factory-set three-point safety belts must be used when attaching child
restraint systems.
During the journey
5
51Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
5.4.1 Fastening the seat belt correctly
The safety belt is applied correctly when a fist still fits between your body and a
safety belt at the shoulder.
5.4.2 Adjusting the seat belt correctly
Before setting off, adjust the seat belts so that the shoulder belt passes between
the neck and shoulder joint.
Adjusting the belt guide
downwards:
Firmly press down the belt column (Fig. 18,2) with both hands and then release
it.
The belt column remains at the desired height.
Adjusting the belt guide
upwards:
Press on the marked area (Fig. 18,1) of the cushion.
The lock releases itself. The belt column moves up.
Release the marked area when the desired height is reached.
The belt column remains at the desired height.
X After an accident, replace the seat belts.
X During the journey, do not tilt the backrest too far backwards. Otherwise the
functionality of the seat belt is no longer guaranteed.
X Do not twist the belt. The belt must be positioned smoothly against the
body.
X When fastening the seat belt, adopt the correct sitting position.
Z The seat belts are not adjustable for all models.
Fig. 18 Seat belt, bench
During the journey
5
52 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
5.5 Driver's seat and front passenger's seat
Rotating seats into driving
position
The seats can be rotated in any direction. The seats can only be locked in position
in the direction of travel.
Push both armrests upward.
Push the driver's seat/front passenger's seat backwards or into the central posi-
tion.
Rotate the seat in the direction of travel and lock in position.
Adjusting the armrest The height of the armrests is infinitely adjustable.
Turn the knurled wheel (Fig. 19,2) in an anticlockwise direction (when viewed
from the front). The latch of the armrest is released by this.
Move the armrest to the desired position.
Turn the knurled wheel as far as possible in a clockwise direction.
Adjusting an appropriate
seating position
The position of the driver's and front passenger's seats can be adjusted. The han-
dles which are required for this purpose are positioned to the front, right or left of
the seat.
Pull the handle (Fig. 19,5). The seat can be moved forward or backward.
Turn the knurled knob (Fig. 19,1). The angle of the backrest can be adjusted.
Pull the lever (Fig. 19,4) upwards. The inclination of the seat and backrest can be
set.
X Before commencing the journey, rotate all swivel seats in the direction of
travel and lock in position.
X The seats must remain fixed in position during the journey and are not to be
rotated.
Z The driver's and front passenger's seat are a part of the base vehicle, depending
on model and vehicle equipment. In this case the adjustment of the seats is
described in the operating instructions of the base vehicle.
Fig. 19 Driver's and front passenger's
seats
1 Wheel for unlocking and adjusting the
backrest
2 Armrest adjustment
3 Lever for adjusting the seat height
4 Lever for adjusting the seat inclination
5 Bar for lengthways adjustment
6 Release for turning mechanism
Z Rotating the seats in the pitched vehicle is described in chapter 7.
Z Move the seats all the way down before turning. Otherwise, the seats cannot be
turned.
During the journey
5
53Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Adjusting the seat height Depending on the model, the height of the seat is infinitely adjustable.
Pull the lever (Fig. 19,3) upwards.
Take pressure off or apply pressure to seat. The seat moves up or down.
Release lever when the desired position is reached. The seat is locked.
5.6 Headrests
Before commencing the journey, adjust the headrests (Fig. 20,1) so that the back of
the head is supported at approximately ear height. Push the headrests upwards or
downwards by hand.
5.7 Seating arrangement
Seats which may be used during travel are equipped with a sticker (Fig. 21).
Z The headrests are not adjustable for all models.
Fig. 20 Bench headrests
X During the journey, persons are only to sit on the permitted seats. The
authorised number of seats is stipulated in the vehicle documents.
X During the journey sitting on the divans is not permitted.
X Seat belts must be worn by all passengers.
Fig. 21 "Seat" symbol
During the journey
5
54 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
5.8 Branch block (model I)
The sliding regulator (Fig. 22,2) for the branch block (Fig. 22,1) is located on the out-
side left of the dashboard.
Vehicle heating is coupled with room heater by the sliding regulator. Therefore the
windscreen is heated when the vehicle is at a standstill.
During mobile operation, close the branch block (slide the sliding regulator all the
way down) so that the complete power of the vehicle heater can reach to the front
and side panes.
Close the branch block:
Push the lever (Fig. 22,2) completely downwards. The branch block is closed.
5.9 Electrical window winders (model I)
There is an electrical window winder (Fig. 23) on the driver's side of the vehicle.
Opening:
Press lower part of the switch (Fig. 23,2).
Closing:
Press upper part of the switch (Fig. 23,1).
Fig. 22 Branch block
ruma
1
2
X Remove hands and other objects from the window before closing.
X Even if you leave your vehicle just briefly, remove the ignition key from the
steering lock. Otherwise children may be able to operate the window winder
and injure themselves.
Fig. 23 Switch for electrical window
winder
1
2
During the journey
5
55Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
5.10 Electrically adjustable external mirrors (model I)
Depending on the model, the vehicle is equipped with two electrically adjustable
and heated external mirrors. The switches for external mirror adjustment and the
mirror heater are on the dashboard.
Adjusting:
Select the mirror to be adjusted. To do so, turn the rotary switch (Fig. 24,1) to the
left or right.
Adjust the mirror by pressing the switch (Fig. 24,1) in the appropriate direction.
Switching on the heater:
Press the switch (Fig. 24,2). The switch indicator lamp shows it is in operation.
5.11 Roman shades for windscreen, driver's window and front
passenger's window
Securing the Roman shade for
the windscreen:
Use the handle (Fig. 25,2 and Fig. 26,1) to pull the two halves of the Roman
shade for the windscreen outwards as far as they will go.
Push the locking knobs (Fig. 25,1) upward or downward. If the red dot is visible,
the lock is open.
Fig. 24 Switch for electrically adjustable
external mirrors and mirror
heater
1 2
X While travelling, the Roman shades for the windscreen, driver's window and
front passenger's window must be open, in a fixed position and secured.
Z Further information can be obtained in the manufacturer's instruction manual.
Fig. 25 Lock for the Roman shade of the
windscreen
Fig. 26 Lock for the Roman shade of the
windscreen (model I)
During the journey
5
56 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Securing the Roman shade for
the driver's / front passenger's
window:
On the Roman shades for the driver's and passenger's window, push the handle
(Fig. 27,1) onto the cap. The Roman shade is secured.
5.12 Writing and reading rest
Depending on the model, the motorhome is equipped with a writing and reading
rest (Fig. 28).
5.13 Bonnet
Fig. 27 Locking mechanism for Roman
shades on driver's/front pas-
senger's windows
X During the journey the writing and reading rest must be closed.
Z If there is a passenger airbag, the writing and reading rest is locked so it cannot
be opened.
Fig. 28 Writing and reading rest
X When the bonnet is open, there is a risk of injury in the engine compartment.
X Even if the engine was switched off some time ago, it might still be hot.
Danger of burns!
X Do not work in the engine compartment while the engine is running.
X The bonnet must be kept firmly closed and locked during the journey. After
closing, check whether the lock has engaged. In order to carry this out, pull
on the bonnet.
During the journey
5
57Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
5.13.1 Model I
Opening: Pull the lever (Fig. 29,1) situated on the left-hand side of the vehicle on the dash-
board. The bonnet opens as far as the safety hook allows.
Reach under the bonnet with one hand and actuate the safety hook (Fig. 30,1).
Do this by reaching behind the plate (Fig. 30,2) and pulling it forward.
Move the bonnet in an arch forwards and upwards.
Closing:
Move the bonnet in an arch downwards and backwards until the latch locks
audibly in place.
Check whether the bonnet is locked correctly. In order to carry this out, pull on
the bonnet.
5.14 Filling with washer fluid (model I)
Unlock and open the bonnet.
Remove the lid (Fig. 31,1) from the filler neck of the washer fluid container.
Slowly fill in washer fluid.
Push the lid onto the filler neck of the washer fluid container.
Fig. 29 Release knob on the inside of the
bonnet
Fig. 30 Release knob on the outside of
the bonnet
1
Fig. 31 Washer fluid container filler neck
1
During the journey
5
58 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
5.15 Refilling cooling water
Loosen the two screws (Fig. 32,1) and take off the cover (Fig. 32,2).
Unscrew six hexagon socket screws (Fig. 33,1) and remove them with the
washers.
Remove cover (Fig. 33,2).
Open the cover (Fig. 34,1) carefully and allow the pressure to escape.
Remove the cover and top up with cooling water from a suitable vessel (e.g. a
bottle).
Screw the cover (Fig. 34,1) back onto the cooling water compensator reservoir.
Screw both covers (Fig. 33,2 and Fig. 32,2) securely back in place.
X Allow the coolant to cool down before opening the cooling system. Risk of
scalding!
X Allow the cooling system to cool down before opening. The cooling system
is under high pressure when it is hot. There is a risk of injury!
Fig. 32 Cover in the dashboard Fig. 33 Engine compartment cover
Fig. 34 Cover on the cooling water com-
pensator reservoir
During the journey
5
59Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
5.16 Checking the oil level (model I)
The oil dipstick (Fig. 35,1) is located in the engine compartment behind the front
crossbeam. The oil dipstick is marked in red.
5.17 Filling up with diesel
The fuel filler neck is situated on the exterior of the vehicle, at the front left. It is
covered by a cover flap.
Opening:
Open the cover flap (Fig. 36,1).
Insert the key in the locking cylinder (Fig. 36,3) and turn it in an anticlockwise
direction.
Remove cap.
Fig. 35 Oil dipstick (I model)
X No appliance operated by a naked flame (e.g. heater or refrigerator) may be
in operation when filling the tank, on ferries or in the garage. Danger of
explosion!
X The cap for the fuel filler neck and for the drinking water filler neck are very
similar in some models. Before filling the tank, always check the label.
Z The fuel filler neck is labelled with the word "Diesel".
Fig. 36 Cover flap for the fuel filler neck Fig. 37 Opened cover flap for with fuel
filler neck
D I E S E L
1
2
3
During the journey
5
60 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Closing: Place the cap on the fuel filler neck.
Turn key in a clockwise direction.
Remove the key.
Check that the cap is fastened securely on the fuel filler neck.
Close the cover flap (Fig. 37,1).
Pitching the motorhome
6
61Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
6Pitching the motorhome
Chapter overview
This chapter contains instructions on how to pitch the vehicle.
The instructions address the following topics:
z handbrake
z entrance step
z wheel chocks
z operation of the supports
z 240 V connection
z refrigerator
z awning
z satellite unit
6.1 Handbrake
Firmly apply the handbrake when parking the vehicle.
6.2 Entrance step
In order to exit the vehicle, first fully extend the entrance step.
6.3 Wheel chocks
When parking the vehicle on slopes or inclines the wheel chocks in the vehicle must
be used. The wheel chocks are standard equipment.
6.4 Supports
6.4.1 General instructions
Z Pitch the vehicle so that it is as horizontal as possible. Secure the vehicle to pre-
vent it from rolling.
Z Animals (especially mice) can cause great damage to the interior of the vehicle.
To prevent this from happening, regularly check the vehicle for damages or
animal traces after pitching.
Z If there is any risk of frost, release the handbrake every now and then and apply
it again. This will prevent it from freezing or rusting. Prior to releasing the hand-
brake, secure the vehicle so that is cannot roll away.
Z Do not use the fitted supports as a vehicle jack. They supports are only for sta-
bilising the parked vehicle to prevent the rear axle from bottoming out.
Z When pitching the vehicle, ensure that the supports are evenly loaded.
Z Before driving away, wind up the supports as far as they can go, fully retract and
secure them.
Z When the ground is soft, place a pad or block under the supports in order to pre-
vent the vehicle from sinking into the ground.
Pitching the motorhome
6
62 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
6.4.2 Steady legs (AL-KO)
In order to ensure their correct function, clean and grease the interior tubes of the
steady legs regularly.
The length of the steady legs can be adjusted according to the model.
Extending:
Place the socket spanner on the hexagon nut (Fig. 38,1) and rotate until the
steady leg is in a perpendicular downward position.
Remove the splint (Fig. 38,4) out of the support foot extension (Fig. 38,5).
Extend the support foot extension until it has reached the required length.
Insert the splint in the support foot extension.
Rotate the hexagonal nut until the steady leg rests completely on the ground
and the vehicle is in a horizontal position.
Retracting:
Place the socket spanner on the hexagon nut (Fig. 38,1) and rotate until the
steady leg is clear of the ground.
Remove the splint (Fig. 38,4) out of the support foot extension (Fig. 38,5).
Push in the support foot extension (Fig. 38,5) and insert the splint (Fig. 38,4) in
the drilled hole in the support foot extension.
Rotate the hexagonal nut (Fig. 38,1) with the socket spanner until the steady leg
has swung upwards and the guide disc (Fig. 38,3) has completely retracted into
the notch (Fig. 38,2).
6.5 240 V connection
The vehicle can be connected to a 240 V power supply (see chapter 9).
Z Depending on the model, the hexagonal nut has a joint, which can be used to
bring the attached socket spanner into a more convenient position for turning.
Fig. 38 Steady leg
Z Before commencing the journey, observe the following: Are all steady legs and
support foot extensions retracted completely and secured with the splint?
Pitching the motorhome
6
63Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
6.6 Refrigerator
6.6.1 Absorption refrigerator
The 12 V operation of the refrigerator is only possible when the vehicle engine is
running. If the vehicle engine is switched off, set the refrigerator to 240 V operation
or gas operation.
6.6.2 Compressor refrigerator
The refrigerator only functions in 12 V operation.
6.7 Awning
Advantages of the awning The advantages of an awning are:
z The awning provides shade.
z The awning creates a covered vestibule and thus expands the space.
z The vehicle thus becomes more homelike.
Putting up the awning:
Insert the hook (Fig. 39,1) of the crank rod (Fig. 39,2) into the lug and turn by 90°.
Hold the crank rod with one hand at the upper end and with the other hand at
the lower turning handle.
Turn the crank rod counter-clockwise and extend the awning by a maximum of
1 m.
Fold out the support legs (Fig. 40,1) and set them on the ground.
Extend the awning further.
Tension the awning using the support legs.
Z In case of strong wind, strong rain or snowfall retract the awning.
Z In case of light rain reduce one of the support legs so that the water can run off.
Z Only retract the awning if the cloth is dry. If the awning has to be retracted while
the cloth is wet: Extend the awning again as soon as possible so that the cloth
can dry.
Z Before retracting the awning, remove leaves and coarse soiling from it.
Z Use the awning only as protection against the sun.
Z Additionally observe the manufacturer's instruction manual.
Z The crank rod of the awning is located in the rear area.
Fig. 39 Awning Fig. 40 Putting up the awning
max. 1m
Pitching the motorhome
6
64 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Secure the support legs to the ground using tent pegs.
Turn the crank rod by 90° and remove it.
Retracting the awning:
Insert the hook of the crank rod into the lug and turn by 90°.
Remove the tent pegs of the support legs.
Hold the crank rod with one hand at the upper end and with the other hand at
the lower turning handle.
Turn the crank rod clockwise and retract the awning up to 1 m.
Fold in the support legs.
Retract the awning completely.
Turn the crank rod by 90° and remove it.
6.8 Satellite unit
Switching on and extending
the satellite unit:
Switch on the satellite unit by using the ON/OFF button (Fig. 42, 3).
Press the SAT button (Fig. 42,1) several times to select a satellite and start the
search run.
The satellite unit extends and searches for the set satellites automatically.
Further operation is carried out by means of the remote control (observe the
manufacturer instructions).
Fig. 41 Teleco satellite unit
Z Retract the satellite unit before commencing your journey.
Z Retract the satellite unit in case of bad weather and wind in order to avoid storm
damage.
Fig. 42 Panel menu consumers
SAT DOWN
ON/OFF
ASTRA 19
HOT BIRD
ASTRA 23
ASTRA 4
EUTELSAT 5W
THOR
ASTRA 28
POWER
1 2
3
Pitching the motorhome
6
65Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Retracting and switching off
the satellite unit:
Press the DOWN button (Fig. 42,2) to retract the satellite unit.
The satellite unit is retracted.
Press ON/OFF button (Fig. 42,3).
The satellite unit is retracted and the television is switched off.
6.9 Cable connection
Depending on the model, the vehicle can be fitted with a cable connection. This is
located on the outside of the vehicle.
Fig. 43 Cable connection
1 SAT connection
2 Power connection
3 TV connection
4 12 V connection
3
4
1
2
Pitching the motorhome
6
66 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Living
7
67Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
7Living
Chapter overview
This chapter contains instructions about living in the vehicle.
The instructions address the following topics:
z opening and closing the doors and external flaps
z ventilation of the vehicle
z opening and closing the windows and blinds
z opening and closing the skylights
z rotating the seats
z modifying the table surfaces
z converting tables
z operating the central locking on the kitchen block
z positioning the television
z setting all the lights
z light switches
z extending the seating groups
z using the beds
7.1 Doors
X Only drive with locked doors.
Z Locking the doors can prevent them from opening of their own accord, e.g.
during an accident.
Z Locked doors also prevent forced entry, e.g. when waiting at traffic lights. How-
ever, in an emergency, locked doors make it more difficult for helpers to enter
the vehicle.
Z When leaving the vehicle, always lock the doors.
Z Depending on the model, the locks of the driver's and the front passenger's
doors are part of the base vehicle. In this case, the opening and closing of the
driver's door and the front passenger's door is described in the operating
manual of the base vehicle.
Living
7
68 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
7.1.1 Conversion door, outside
Opening: Insert the key into locking cylinder (Fig. 44,1) and turn until the door lock is
unlatched.
Return the key to the central position and remove it.
Pull on the handle (Fig. 44,2). The door is open.
Locking:
Insert the key into locking cylinder (Fig. 44,1) and turn until the door lock is
engaged.
Return the key to the central position and remove it.
7.1.2 Conversion door, inside (with locking lever)
Opening: Pull on the handle (Fig. 45,1). The door lock is unlatched. The locking lever
(Fig. 45,2) jumps out automatically.
Locking:
Press the locking lever (Fig. 45,2).
Fig. 44 Door lock of conversion door,
outside
1
2
Fig. 45 Door lock of conversion door,
inside
Living
7
69Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
7.1.3 Driver's door, outside
Opening: Insert the key into locking cylinder (Fig. 46,1) and turn until the door lock is
unlatched.
Return the key to the central position and remove it.
Pull on the handle (Fig. 46,2). The door is open.
Locking:
Insert the key into locking cylinder (Fig. 46,1) and turn until the door lock is
engaged.
Return the key to the central position and remove it.
7.1.4 Driver's door, inside (without lock)
Pull on the handle (Fig. 47,1). The door lock is unlatched.
Fig. 46 Door lock of driver's door, out-
side
1
2
Fig. 47 Door lock of driver's door, inside
1
Living
7
70 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
7.1.5 Driver's door, inside (with lock)
Opening: Pull the handle (Fig. 48,1).
Locking:
Press the handle (Fig. 48,1) into the handle recess (Fig. 48,2).
7.1.6 Insect screen on the conversion door
Closing: Pull out the insect screen completely by the bar (Fig. 49,1).
Opening:
Push the insect screen into its initial position by the bar (Fig. 49,1).
Fig. 48 Door lock of conversion door,
inside
Z Open the insect screen completely before closing the conversion door.
Fig. 49 Insect screen
Living
7
71Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
7.1.7 Conversion door window (variant 1)
The conversion door window is fitted with a Roman shade.
Closing:
Grip the Roman shade (Fig. 50,2) in the middle of the bar (Fig. 50,1), pull it
upwards and then release it at the desired height. The Roman shade will stay at
this height.
Opening:
Grip the Roman shade in the middle of the bar and push it down.
7.1.8 Conversion door window (variant 2)
The conversion door window is fitted with a roller insect screen and blind.
Opening the window:
Press the locking device (Fig. 51,3) to the rear.
Press the handle (Fig. 51,2) together and push the window down.
Closing the window:
Push the window upwards until the handle (Fig. 51,2) latches into the locking
mechanism (Fig. 51,1).
Roller insect screen To close and open the roller insect screen:
Closing:
Grip the end rod (Fig. 52,1) of the roller insect screen in the middle and move it
to the end rod of the blind.
Let the latch latch in.
Adjust the screen/blind continuously by moving the end rods.
Opening:
Hold the end rod (Fig. 52,1) of the roller insect screen and press the latch.
Return the end rod of the roller insect screen to the limit stop on the frame.
Fig. 50 Roman shade
Fig. 51 Window in the conversion door Fig. 52 Blind
Living
7
72 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
7.2 External flaps
The external flaps fitted to the vehicle are all fitted with identical locking cylinders.
Therefore, all locks can be opened with a single key.
7.2.1 Flap lock with recessed handle
Opening: Insert key into locking cylinder (Fig. 53,1) and turn a quarter turn. The flap lock
is unlatched.
Remove the key.
Pull on the lock handle (Fig. 53,2). The external flap is open.
Closing:
Firmly close the external flap.
Insert key into locking cylinder and turn a quarter turn. The flap lock is locked.
Remove the key.
7.2.2 Holding the external flaps in position
Variant 1 Some external flaps have a securing hook with which the flap can be held in the
opened position.
Z Before commencing the journey, close all external flaps and lock them.
Z To open and close the external flap, open or close all locks that are fitted to the
external flap.
Z When leaving the vehicle, close all external flaps.
Z To open the external flap, pull all the lock handles fitted to that particular
external flap at the same time.
Fig. 53 Flap lock with recessed handle
X When opening the latch and holding it in position ensure that the securing
hook is located correctly. Danger of injury through flap falling shut!
Living
7
73Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Holding in position Open the external flap (Fig. 55,1) and fold it upwards against the vehicle side.
Use one hand to hold the external flap in this position.
Use the other hand to pull out the securing hook (Fig. 54,1).
Turn the securing hook (Fig. 55,2) upwards and secure the external flap
(Fig. 55,1) behind it.
Closing
Hold the external flap in position.
Pull the securing hook (Fig. 55,2) and turn it downwards.
Carefully slide the securing hook back into the initial position (Fig. 54,1).
Fold the external flap downwards and close it.
Variant 2 Some external flaps have a securing hook on the vehicle exterior with which the
flap can be held in the opened position.
Holding in position
Open the external flap (Fig. 56,1) and turn the securing hook (Fig. 56,2) upwards
at the
vehicle side.
Open the external flap upwards and latch it into the securing hook.
Closing
Hold the external flap in position.
Press the securing hook (Fig. 56,2) upwards.
Fold the external flap downwards and close it.
Fig. 54 Securing hook external flap, ini-
tial position
Fig. 55 Securing hook external flap,
holding position
X When opening the latch and holding it in position ensure that the securing
hook is located correctly. Danger of injury through flap falling shut!
Fig. 56 Securing hook external flap
2
1
Living
7
74 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
7.3 Driver's cabin partition
Depending on the model, the vehicle is fitted with a driver's cabin partition.
Lock on living area side To close and open the driver's cabin partition:
Closing:
Unlock and slide closed the door (Fig. 57,1).
Turn the handle (Fig. 57,2) anticlockwise until the door is locked.
Opening:
Turn the handle (Fig. 57,2) clockwise until the door is unlocked.
Slide open the door (Fig. 57,1) and secure it.
Lock on the driver's cabin
side
To close and open the driver's cabin partition:
Closing:
Unlock and the door (Fig. 57,1) and push it closed at the handle (Fig. 58,2).
Insert the key in the locking cylinder (Fig. 58,1) and turn clockwise until the door
is locked.
Opening:
Insert the key in the locking cylinder and turn it anticlockwise.
Slide open the door and secure it.
7.4 Ventilation
Z Only drive with the doors secured.
Fig. 57 Driver's cabin partition Fig. 58 Driver's cabin lock
X The oxygen in the vehicle interior is used up by breathing and the use of gas
operated appliances. That is why the oxygen needs to be replaced on a con-
stant basis. For this purpose, forced ventilation options (e.g. skylights with
forced ventilation, mushroom-shaped vents or floor vents) are fitted to the
vehicle. Never cover or block forced ventilations from the inside or outside
with objects such as e.g. a winter mat. Keep forced ventilations clear of snow
and leaves. There is a danger of suffocation due to increased CO
2
levels.
Z Although sufficient ventilation is provided, in certain weather conditions, con-
densation can form on metal objects (e.g. screwed connections in the floor).
Z Additional cold spots can occur at thermal "bridges" (e.g. mushroom-shaped
vents, skylight edges, sockets, filler necks, flaps, etc.).
Living
7
75Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Condensation Ensure that there is a continuous exchange of air by providing frequent and effi-
cient ventilation. This is the only method for ensuring that condensation and
resulting mould is not formed during cool weather. During the colder season, a
pleasant living climate is created if heating output, air distribution and ventilation
are synchronized. To avoid draft close the air outlet nozzles on the dashboard and
set the air distribution of the base vehicle to air circulation.
If the vehicle is laid up for a longer period, occasionally ventilate it well, especially
in summer as heat accumulation can occur. Do not only air the interior, but also the
storage compartments which are accessible from the outside. Air the parking place
as well if the vehicle is parked in a closed space (e.g. garage). The occurrence of con-
densation could lead to the formation of mould.
7.5 Windows
Z The windows are fitted with a blind or Roman shade and with an insect screen
or folding insect screen. After the latch has been released, the blind and insect
screen automatically spring back to the initial position by tensile force. In order
not to damage the tension mechanics, hold onto the blind or insect screen and
allow it to slowly return to the initial position. The Roman shade and folding
insect screen are made of thin woven fabric. In order not to damage the Roman
shade or the insect screen, grasp the respective handle and carefully return it to
the initial position.
Z Do not keep blinds closed over a longer period of time as that can cause
increased material wear.
Z If the blind or the Roman shade is completely closed, exposure to direct sun-
light can cause heat to accumulate between the blind/the Roman shade and
the glass window. The window could be damaged. For that reason, close the
blind/Roman shade only 2/3 of the way in direct sunlight.
Z Before commencing the journey, close the windows.
Z Depending on the weather, close the windows far enough to prevent moisture
from entering.
Z To open and close the hinged window, open or close all catch levers which are
fitted to the hinged window.
Z When leaving the vehicle, always close the windows.
Z In extreme weather conditions or if the temperature fluctuates strongly, a light
condensation film can form on the double-glazed acrylic glass. The glass is
designed in such a way that condensation can evaporate when the external
temperature increases. There is no danger of the double-glazed acrylic glass
being damaged by condensation.
Living
7
76 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
7.5.1 Sliding window with lock (variant 1)
Opening: Pull out the lock (Fig. 59,1).
Press handle (Fig. 59,2) and push it forward or backward at the same time.
Open window half up to the required position.
Closing:
Close the window as far as it can go.
Push in the lock.
7.5.2 Sliding window with lock (variant 2)
Opening: Turn the locking knob (Fig. 59,1) into the vertical position.
Press handle (Fig. 59,2) and push it forward or backward at the same time.
Open window half up to the required position.
Closing:
Close the window as far as it can go.
Turn the locking knob into the horizontal position.
Fig. 59 Sliding window with slide lock
Fig. 60 Sliding window with slide lock
1
Living
7
77Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
7.5.3 Sliding window with lock (variant 3)
Opening: Turn the locking knob (Fig. 59,1) into the vertical position.
Press handle (Fig. 59,2) and push it forward or backward at the same time.
Open window half up to the required position.
Closing:
Close the window as far as it can go.
Turn the locking knob into the horizontal position.
7.5.4 Sliding window without lock (variant 1)
Opening: Press handle (Fig. 62,1) and push or pull it forward or backward at the same
time.
Open window half up to the required position.
Closing:
Close the window as far as possible and let the handle lock in place.
Fig. 61 Sliding window with slide lock
Fig. 62 Sliding window
1
Living
7
78 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
7.5.5 Sliding window without lock (variant 2)
Opening: Pull the handle flap (Fig. 64,1) and push or pull the handle forwards at the same
time.
Open window half up to the required position.
Closing:
Close the window as far as possible and let the handle lock in place.
7.5.6 Hinged window with rotary hinges
Opening: Turn the catch lever (Fig. 65,3) a quarter turn towards the centre of the window.
Open the hinged window until the required position has been reached and use
knurled knob (Fig. 66,1) to secure in position.
The hinged window remains locked in the required position.
Closing:
Turn knurled knob (Fig. 66,1) until the latch is released.
Close the hinged window.
Turn the catch lever (Fig. 65,3) a quarter turn towards the window frame. The
locking catch (Fig. 65,2) is located on the inside of the window catch (Fig. 65,1).
Fig. 63 Sliding window without lock Fig. 64 Sliding window without lock
Z When opening the hinged windows, ensure that there are no torsional forces.
Open and close the hinged windows evenly.
Fig. 65 Catch lever in "closed" position Fig. 66 Hinged window with rotary
hinges, open
Living
7
79Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Continuous ventilation With the catch lever, the hinged window can be placed in 2 positions:
z "Continuous ventilation" (Fig. 67)
z Firmly closed (Fig. 65)
To place the hinged window into the "continuous ventilation" position:
Turn the catch lever (Fig. 67,3) a quarter turn towards the centre of the window.
Lightly open the hinged window outwards.
Return the catch lever to its initial position. The locking catch (Fig. 67,2) has to
be moved into the recess of window catch (Fig. 67,1).
During the journey, the hinged window may not be in "continuous ventilation"
position.
If it rains, the "continuous ventilation" hinged window position could lead to
splashing water penetrating the living area. Therefore, close the hinged windows
completely.
Fig. 67 Catch lever in the "continuous
ventilation" position
Living
7
80 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
7.5.7 Hinged window with automatic hinges
Opening: If it exists, press the safety knob (Fig. 69,3) down and hold it.
Turn the catch lever (Fig. 68,3) a quarter turn towards the centre of the window.
Open the hinged window to the desired latched position. The automatic hinge
(Fig. 70,1) locks in place automatically.
The hinged window remains locked in the required position.
Closing:
Open the hinged window as wide as necessary until the latch releases.
Close the hinged window.
If it exists, press the safety knob (Fig. 69,3) down and hold it.
Turn the catch lever (Fig. 68,3) a quarter turn towards the window frame. The
locking catch (Fig. 68,2) is located on the inside of the window catch (Fig. 68,1).
Z Open the window completely, to release the lock. If the locking device is not
released and the window is closed nevertheless, there is the danger of the
window breaking due to the massive counter-pressure.
Z When opening the hinged windows, ensure that there are no torsional forces.
Open and close the hinged windows evenly.
Z If the locking lever is equipped with a safety knob, press the safety knob when-
ever you use the locking lever.
Fig. 68 Catch lever in "closed" position Fig. 69 Catch lever with safety knob in
"closed" position
Fig. 70 Hinged window with automatic
hinges, open
Living
7
81Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Continuous ventilation With the catch lever, the hinged window can be placed in two positions:
z "Continuous ventilation" (Fig. 71)
z Firmly closed (Fig. 68).
To place the hinged window into the "continuous ventilation" position:
If it exists, press the safety knob (Fig. 69,3) down and hold it.
Turn the catch lever (Fig. 71,3) a quarter turn towards the centre of the window.
Slightly open the hinged window outwards.
If it exists, press the safety knob (Fig. 69,3) down and hold it.
Turn the catch lever a quarter turn towards the window frame. The locking
catch (Fig. 71,2) has to be moved into the recess of window catch (Fig. 71,1).
If necessary, ensure that the safety knob is not pushed in but rather that it
secures the catch lever.
During the journey, the hinged window may not be in "continuous ventilation"
position.
If it rains, the "continuous ventilation" hinged window position could lead to
splashing water penetrating the living area. Therefore, close the hinged windows
completely.
Fig. 71 Catch lever in the "continuous
ventilation" position
Fig. 72 Catch lever with safety knob in
"closed" position
Living
7
82 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
7.5.8 Blind and insect screen
The windows are fitted with a blind and an insect screen. The blind and insect
screen are adjusted separately.
Blind The blind is located in the upper blind box.
Closing:
Pull blind at the handle (Fig. 73,2) downwards. If the blind is to be completely
closed, it is suspended into the locking devices (Fig. 73,3) situated on both sides
of the window frame.
Opening:
If the blind is completely closed: Press handle (Fig. 73,2) downwards and, at the
same time, tilt it slightly inward. The blind can be taken out of the locking
devices situated on both sides of the window frame.
If the blind is in an intermediate position: Pull the handle (Fig. 73,2) slightly
downwards until the locking device releases.
Use handle to return blind slowly to its initial position.
Insect screen The insect screen is located in the upper blind box.
Closing:
Pull insect screen at the handle (Fig. 73,1) down and hang it into the locking
devices (Fig. 73,3) situated on both sides of the window frame.
Opening:
Press handle (Fig. 73,1) downwards and, at the same time, tilt it slightly inward.
The insect screen can be taken out of the locking devices situated on both sides
of the window frame.
Use handle to return the insect screen slowly to its initial position.
Z Open blinds before commencing the journey. When the blinds are closed,
vibrations can damage the spring shaft.
Fig. 73 Hinged window
Living
7
83Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
7.5.9 Roman shade for the windscreen
Variant 1
Closing: Release the fastener of the securing loop (Fig. 74,1) at the Roman shade.
Press the locking mechanism (Fig. 74,2) at the handle of the Roman shade and
pull it down to the desired height.
Opening:
Push the Roman shades carefully upwards at the handle until the latch
(Fig. 74,2) latches in.
Secure the Roman shade with the securing loop (Fig. 74,1).
Variant 2
Closing:
Grasp the handles (Fig. 74,2) of the Roman shades at both sides of the wind-
screen and draw carefully to the middle of the windscreen until the magnetic
catch keeps the Roman shades closed.
Opening:
Carefully push the Roman shades at the handle under the cover of the A-col-
umns.
Push the handle onto the upper part. The Roman shade is secured.
Fig. 74 Roman shade for the windscreen
Fig. 75 Handle of the Roman shade for
the windscreen
Living
7
84 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
7.5.10 Roman shade for driver's window and front passenger's window
Variant 1
Closing:
Grasp the handle (Fig. 76,1) of the Roman shades and draw carefully forwards
until the magnetic catch keeps the Roman shades closed.
Opening:
Using the handle, carefully push the Roman shades back under the cover.
Push the handle (Fig. 76,2) onto the upper part. The Roman shade is secured.
Variant 2
Closing:
Open the Velcro of the securing loops (Fig. 77,3) on both sides.
Grasp the handles (Fig. 77,1 and 2) of the Roman shades one after the other and
draw carefully towards each other until the magnetic catch keeps the Roman
shade closed.
Opening:
Carefully push the Roman shades back at the handles (Fig. 77,1 and 2).
Secure the Roman shade with the Velcro of the securing loop (Fig. 77,3).
Fig. 76 Roman shade for driver's
window and front passenger's
window
Fig. 77 Roman shade for driver's
window and front passenger's
window
Living
7
85Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
7.5.11 Gathered blinds
Depending on the model, the vehicle is fitted with gathered blinds.
Gathering the blind:
Pull down the cord weight (Fig. 78,1). The cords pull up and gather the blind.
Press the cord weight (Fig. 79,2) onto the Velcro (Fig. 79,1).
Lowering the blind:
Remove the cord weight (Fig. 79,2) from the Velcro (Fig. 79,1).
Guide the cord weight slowly upwards. The end rod pulls the blind down.
7.6 Skylights
Depending on the model, skylights with or without forced ventilation are fitted to
the vehicle. If a skylight is fitted without forced ventilation, the forced ventilation is
performed using mushroom-shaped vents.
Fig. 78 Gathered blind Fig. 79 Cord weight
X The apertures for forced ventilation must always be kept open. Never cover
or block forced ventilations with objects such as e.g. a winter mat. Keep
forced ventilations clear of snow and leaves.
Z The skylights are fitted with a blind or Roman shade and with an insect screen
or folding insect screen. After the latch has been released, the blind and insect
screen automatically spring back to the initial position by tensile force. In order
not to damage the tension mechanics, hold onto the blind or insect screen and
allow it to slowly return to the initial position. The Roman shade and folding
insect screen are made of thin woven fabric. In order not to damage the Roman
shade or the insect screen, grasp the respective handle and carefully return it to
the initial position.
Z Do not keep blinds closed over a longer period of time as that can cause
increased material wear.
Z If the blind or the Roman shade is completely closed, exposure to direct sun-
light can cause heat to accumulate between the blind/the Roman shade and
the skylight. The skylight could be damaged. For that reason, close the blind/
Roman shade only 2/3 of the way in direct sunlight. Open the skylight slightly
or move it to ventilation position.
Z Depending on the weather, close the skylights far enough to prevent moisture
from entering.
Z Do not climb on the skylights.
Z Before commencing the journey, close the skylights.
Z Before commencing the journey, check that the skylights are closed and locked.
Living
7
86 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
7.6.1 Skylight with snap latch
The skylight can be pushed upwards either from one side or from both sides.
Depending on the version, the skylight is fitted with a blind.
Opening:
Pull on the handle (Fig. 80,5).
Fold the insect screen (Fig. 80,4) downwards.
Push the spring-loaded latch (Fig. 80,1) towards the inside of the skylight
(Fig. 80,8). At the same time use the handle (Fig. 80,2) to press the skylight
upwards.
Swing the insect screen upwards (Fig. 80,4) until it latches in place.
Closing:
Pull on the handle (Fig. 80,5).
Fold the insect screen (Fig. 80,4) downwards.
Using both handles (Fig. 80,2), pull down the skylight (Fig. 80,8) with force until
the two snap latches (Fig. 80,1) lock into place.
Swing the insect screen upwards (Fig. 80,4) until it latches in place.
Blind To close and open the blind:
Closing:
Pull the handle (Fig. 80,7) of the blind and hook the hook rail (Fig. 80,3) into the
retainer (Fig. 80,6) on the insect screen.
Opening:
Release the hook rail (Fig. 80,3) from the retainer (Fig. 80,6) and feed the blind
back slowly.
Z Before commencing the journey, open the blinds or Roman shades.
Z Apply talc to the rubber seals of the skylights at least once a year.
Z When leaving the vehicle, always close the skylights.
Fig. 80 Skylight with snap latch
Living
7
88 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Insect screen To close and open the insect screen:
Closing:
Pull the insect screen by the handle to the opposite handle of the Roman shade.
Opening:
Press the rear part of the handle of the insect screen. The latch is released.
Use handle to return the insect screen slowly to its initial position.
7.6.3 Wind-up skylight
The wind-up skylight can be opened using the manual crank.
Opening:
Rotate the hand crank (Fig. 85,2) until a resistance can be felt (max. opening
angle 70°).
Closing:
Rotate the hand crank until the wind-up skylight is closed. The wind-up skylight
can be locked after rotating two or three more times.
Check the locking mechanism. To do so, press your hand against the acrylic
glass.
Roman shade The Roman shade can be closed in any position, as desired. If the Roman shade is
locked with the insect screen, the insect screen is also moved along on closing the
Roman shade.
Closing:
Pull the handle of the Roman shade (Fig. 85,3) and release in the desired posi-
tion. The Roman shade will stay in that position.
Opening:
Slowly push the Roman shade at the handle to its initial position.
Insect screen If the insect screen is locked with the Roman shade, the Roman shade is also moved
along on closing the insect screen.
Closing:
Pull insect screen at the handle (Fig. 85,1) to the opposite handle of the Roman
shade (Fig. 85,3) and allow to engage.
Opening:
Press the handle of the insect screen (Fig. 85,1) at the back upwards and detach
the insect screen from the Roman shade (Fig. 85,3).
Slowly push insect screen at the handle to its initial position.
Fig. 85 Wind-up skylight
Living
7
89Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
7.7 Rotating seats
The lever for rotating the seat is located at the front or at the side of the seat,
depending on model.
Turning:
Push both armrests at the driver's/front passenger's seat upward.
Push the driver's seat/front passenger's seat backwards or into the central posi-
tion.
Push or pull the lever to turn the seat (Fig. 86,6 ). The seat is released from the
locking device.
The seats can be rotated in any direction. The seats can only be locked in position
in the direction of travel.
X Before commencing the journey, rotate all swivel seats in the direction of
travel and lock in position. During the journey, the swivel seats must remain
locked in place in the direction of travel.
Z Setting the position of the seats and armrests is described in chapter 5.
Z Move the seats all the way down before turning. Otherwise, the seats cannot be
turned.
Fig. 86 Driver's and front passenger's
seats
Living
7
90 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
7.8 Bench and individual seats
Depending on the model, the vehicle is equipped with a bench with adjustable
individual seats.
Adjusting an appropriate
seating position
Pull the handle (Fig. 87,1). The seat can be moved forward or backward.
Pull the handle (Fig. 87,3). The angle of the backrest can be adjusted.
Pull the handle (Fig. 87,2). The seat can be adjusted transversely to the direction
of travel.
7.9 Tables
7.9.1 Suspension table with fold-out leg
The suspension table size can be enlarged by inserting a table-top extension.
Fig. 87 Bench and individual seats
1 Lengthways adjustment
2 Cross adjustment
3 Backrest adjustment
3
2
1
X The backrest is under strong spring tension. If there is no resistance to the
backrest, it quickly moves forward after unlocking.
Z Depending on the model, different table-top extensions and fold-out legs are
used. Therefore the table can deviate from the type shown here. The principle
of the conversion is the same for all tables.
Fig. 88 Extend suspension table
Living
7
91Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Extending: Undo the knurled screws (Fig. 88,2).
Lift the table-top slightly and pull out it out as far as possible. The table exten-
sion (Fig. 88,1) is fully extended.
Set down the table.
Insert the table-top extension in the table extension.
Lift the table-top slightly and push it back as far as possible.
Tighten the knurled screws.
Reducing size:
Undo the knurled screws (Fig. 88,2).
Slightly lift the front of the table-top and pull out.
Remove the table-top extension and store it securely.
Lift the table-top slightly and push it back as far as possible. The table extension
(Fig. 88,1) is fully retracted.
Set down the table.
Tighten the knurled screws.
The table's fold-out leg enables it to be used as a bed foundation.
Conversion to bed foundation:
Lift the front of the table-top (Fig. 89,1) by approx. 45°.
Fold the lower part of the fold-out leg (Fig. 89,3) by 90°. Depending on the
model, pull the lower part of the fold-out leg down or push the release knob.
Press the release knob on the lock (Fig. 89,4).
Swivel the table-top approx. 45° upward and remove the table from the
retainer.
Depending on the model, insert both additional support legs (Fig. 89,2) into the
holders (Fig. 89,5) on the bottom side of the table.
Insert the table into the lower retainer and lock it.
Fig. 89 Bed foundation
Living
7
92 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
7.9.2 Suspension table (bar seating group)
The suspension table size can be enlarged by pulling out a table-top extension.
Extending:
Loosen knurled screw (Fig. 90,1).
Pull out the table-top extension (Fig. 90,2) as far as possible (Fig. 91).
Guide table-top extension (Fig. 91,1) upwards in a circular movement. The
table-top extension lies flush with the table-top.
Reducing size:
Pull table-top extension (Fig. 91,1) away from the table-top as far as it will go
and press downwards against the resistance of the retaining springs. The table-
top extension moves downwards in a circular movement (Fig. 91).
Push in the table-top extension as far as it will go.
Tighten knurled screw (Fig. 90,1).
The table's fold-out leg enables it to be used as a bed foundation.
Conversion to bed foundation:
Slightly raise the front of the table-top (Fig. 92,1).
Unlock table leg (Fig. 92,3) at the hinge and fold it in.
Push the table-top approx. 45° upwards and remove holders (Fig. 92,4) from the
upper mounting rail.
Depending on the model, insert both additional support legs (Fig. 92,2) into the
holders (Fig. 92,5) on the bottom side of the table.
Attach suspension table to the lower mounting rail and rest it onto the table leg
hinge.
Fig. 90 Lock for table-top extension Fig. 91 Table-top extension
12
1
Fig. 92 Bed foundation
Living
7
93Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
7.9.3 Swivel table for the round seating group
Fastening to the floor: Place the swivel table next to the holder (Fig. 93,3) or on the holder (Fig. 94,2).
Place the bar (Fig. 93,2) with the securing bolt (Fig. 93,1) over the table leg.
Move the bar and possibly also the swivel table in such a way that the securing
bolt (Fig. 93,1 or Fig. 94,1) can be screwed into the holder (Fig. 93,3 or Fig. 94,2).
Screw the securing bolt into the holder and tighten firmly.
7.9.4 Fixed table (movable table-top)
The top of the fixed table can be moved both lengthways and crossways.
Moving in a lengthways
direction:
Loosen knurled screw (Fig. 95,1).
Move table-top (Fig. 95,2) to the desired position.
Retighten the knurled screw.
Moving in a crossways
direction:
Loosen knurled screw (Fig. 95,3).
Move table-top (Fig. 95,2) to the desired position.
Retighten the knurled screw.
The fixed table cannot be used as a bed foundation.
X Before commencing the journey, reduce the size of the swivel table and
secure it.
Fig. 93 Lock for swivel table with clamp Fig. 94 Lock for swivel table without
clamp
1
2
3
2
1
Fig. 95 Fixed table
Living
7
94 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
7.9.5 Single-column table (movable table-top)
The top of the single-column table can be moved crossways.
Moving the table-top: Push the locking lever (Fig. 96,2) down.
Move the table-top (Fig. 96,1) to the desired position.
Press the locking lever (Fig. 96,2) back upwards.
7.9.6 Fixed table
Fastening to the floor: Place the fixed table with the perforated plate (Fig. 98,2) on to the holder
(Fig. 98,3).
Move the fixed table in such a way that the securing bolt (Fig. 98,1) can be
screwed into the holder (Fig. 98,3).
Screw the securing bolt into the holder and tighten firmly.
Fig. 96 Lock single-column table
(locked)
Fig. 97 Lock single-column table
(unlocked)
2
1
2
1
X Lock the fixed table in position before commencing the journey.
Fig. 98 Locking mechanism for fixed
table
1
3
2
Living
7
95Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
The table-top of the fixed table can be moved lengthways or folded to the side.
Moving in a lengthways
direction:
Loosen the fixing screws (Fig. 99,2 and 3).
Shift the table-top.
Lock the table-top with the fixing screws.
Folding the table-top to the
side:
Remove the fixing screw (Fig. 99,1).
Fold the table-top to the side.
Depending on the model, the table top of the fixed table can be enlarged.
Extending:
Undo the knurled screws (Fig. 99,2 and 3).
Pull the table top apart.
Insert the table-top extension (Fig. 100,1).
Push the table top back together.
Tighten the knurled screws.
Reducing size:
Undo the knurled screws (Fig. 99,2 and 3).
Pull the table top apart.
Remove the table-top extension (Fig. 100,1) and store it securely.
Push the table top back together.
Tighten the knurled screws.
Fig. 99 Fixed table (from below)
1
23
Fig. 100 Extending the fixed table
1
Living
7
96 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
7.9.7 Lift-off table for the round seating group
The lift-off table's lifting mechanism permits it to be used as a bed foundation.
Conversion to bed foundation:
Swivel the catch lever (Fig. 101,2) to the left. The lock is open.
Press the table-top (Fig. 101,1) in the middle downwards to the desired stop
limit (Fig. 101,3 or 4) and hold it down.
Swivel the catch lever (Fig. 101,2) to the right. The lift-off table is locked.
7.10 Central locking system for kitchen unit
The kitchen unit is equipped with a central locking system. The flaps and drawers
of the kitchen block can be locked and unlocked manually via the switch (Fig. 102).
Locking
Press the switch (Fig. 102,2). The flaps and drawers of the kitchen block are
locked.
Unlocking
Press the switch (Fig. 102,1). The flaps and drawers of the kitchen block are
unlocked.
Z The lift-off table is not secured to the floor. Before the journey, lower the lift-off
table to the top limit and secure to the benches with the straps provided.
Fig. 101 Lift-off table for the round
seating group
4
3
2
1
Fig. 102 Switch for the kitchen unit's cen-
tral locking system
1
2
Living
7
97Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
7.11 Television
Flat screen in the TV cabinet The flat screen is attached to a console in the TV cabinet.
Pulling the television console
forward:
Press the release knob (Fig. 103,5) and pull the holder for the flat screen forward
as far as possible by the handle (Fig. 103,4).
Swivelling the television
console:
Pull the release knob (Fig. 103,1) and swivel flat screen (Fig. 103,2) to the desired
position.
Loosen knurled screw (Fig. 103,3).
Set the desired angle for the flat screen and re-tighten the knurled screw.
Flat screen with jointed arm The flat screen is fastened to a jointed arm.
Positioning the flat screen with
jointed arm:
Press the lever (Fig. 104,2) downwards to release the flat screen from the latch
(Fig. 104,1). Release the lever.
Swivel the flat screen into the required position.
Take hold of the flat screen at the top and bottom edge with both hands and set
the desired angle of inclination.
X Before commencing the journey, remove the television from the support
and store it securely.
X Before commencing the journey, place and secure the flat screen and screen
support in the initial position. If the screen holder is installed in a TV cabinet:
Close TV cabinet.
X Before commencing the journey, ensure that the antenna is in park position.
Danger of accidents!
Fig. 103 TV cabinet
Fig. 104 Holder with jointed arm
Living
7
98 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
7.12 Lamps
Depending on the model the lights are equipped with halogen, fluorescents or LED
lamps. For information about replacing the lamps and, if appropriate, the batteries
see Chapter 13.
Moving the spotlight:
Grasp the holder (Fig. 105,1) and turn it 45°.
Remove the spotlight (Fig. 105,2) from the rail system.
Insert the spotlight (Fig. 105,2) into the rail system at the desired position and
turn 45°.
7.12.1 Plug-in light
The plug-in lights can be plugged into the sockets provided. The sockets are dis-
tributed throughout the vehicle.
Removing a plug-in light:
Grip the plug-in light at the base (Fig. 106,3).
Push the release knob (Fig. 106,4).
Pull the plug-in light (Fig. 106,1) out of the socket (Fig. 106,5).
Plugging in the plug-in light:
Insert the plug in the base of the plug-in light into the socket (Fig. 107,1) until it
engages audibly. When doing this, pay attention to the position of the contacts
(Fig. 107,2).
X Bulbs and light fittings can be extremely hot.
X Let the bulbs and lamp holders cool down before touching them.
X When the light is switched on or is still hot, a safety distance of at least 30 cm
to combustible material such as net curtains or curtains has to be main-
tained. Fire hazard!
Fig. 105 Spot light (example)
1
2
Fig. 106 Socket with plugged-in light Fig. 107 Socket
Living
7
99Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Swiveling the plug-in light: Grip the plug-in light by the "swan neck" (Fig. 106,2) (if present) or by the
housing, and swivel.
7.12.2 Light in the elevating roof
Switching on the light: Push the switch (Fig. 108,1) to the left.
Switching the light off:
Push the switch (Fig. 108,1) to the centre position.
Switching on and off with the
remote control:
Push the switch (Fig. 108,1) to the right.
Press the button (Fig. 109,1) to switch the light on and off.
7.13 Light switch
Depending on the model, there is a light switch for lighting the entrance at the
bottom of the entrance area (Fig. 110,1).
Fig. 108 Light in the elevating roof Fig. 109 Remote control of the light in the
elevating roof
1
OFF
REMOTE
CONTROL
1
Z The light switches have different layouts according to the model. The light
switches are located either directly on the corresponding lamp or next to the
lamp, e.g. in the vicinity of the seating group.
Fig. 110 Light switch for lighting
entrance
1
Living
7
100 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
7.14 Extending the seating group
7.14.1 Extending the central seating group
Extend the table (Fig. 111,3) (see section 7.9).
Pull on the handle (Fig. 111,8) and open the flap (Fig. 111,4).
Fold up bench seat extension (Fig. 112,7) and wedge together with the flap
(Fig. 112,4).
Place the back cushions (Fig. 112,1) and the seat cushions (Fig. 112,2) on the
bench seat extension.
Insert the additional cushions (Fig. 112,6) between the seat cushions and the
exterior wall.
Insert the additional cushions (Fig. 112,5) between the back cushions and the
exterior wall.
Fig. 111 Before extending
Fig. 112 After extending
1 Back cushion
2 Seat cushion
3 Table
4 Flap
5 Additional cushion
6 Additional cushion
7 Bench seat extension
8 Handle
Living
7
101Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
7.15 Beds
7.15.1 Overcab bed
Access ladder Always use the access ladder (Fig. 113,4) provided as standard to access the
overcab bed.
Attaching:
Attach the ladder with the rails to the holder (Fig. 113,5) on the alcove panel.
Safety net The safety net (Fig. 113,3) is stored as standard between the mattress and slatted
frame. Only use the safety net if persons are already in the alcove.
Setting up:
Fasten the retaining straps (Fig. 113,1) to the holders on the ceiling (Fig. 113,2).
X The maximum permitted overcab bed load is 200 kg.
X Only use the overcab bed, if the safety net is set up.
X Never allow small children to remain in the overcab bed without supervision.
X But in particular with regard to small children less than 6 years of age, users
should ensure that they cannot fall out of the overcab bed.
X Use separate children's beds or travel cots suitable for children.
Z Do not load the overcab bed without mattress. The plastic mould part can
break!
Fig. 113 Overcab bed
2
4
3
1
2
1
5
Living
7
102 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Folding mechanism Depending on the model, the overcab bed can be folded upwards. This simplifies
passage from driver's cabin to living area.
Folding upwards:
If appropriate, open the driver's cabin partition (see section 7.3).
Lift the mattress forwards and set it down on the panel.
Fold the front of the overcab bed (Fig. 114,1) upwards. The overcab bed is kept
in the upper position by gas-pressure springs.
Folding downwards:
Pull overcab bed downwards.
If necessary, push the mattress behind the panel.
7.15.2 Pull-down bed (model I)
Fig. 114 Overcab bed, folded upwards
1
X The maximum permitted pull-down bed load is 200 kg.
X The pull-down bed is not to be used for the storage of luggage. When the
bed is not being used, only place the bed linen which is required for two per-
sons in it.
X Before commencing the journey, secure the pull-down bed to the roof with
the retaining belt. Tighten the retaining belt firmly.
X Only use the pull-down bed, if the safety net is set up.
X Never allow small children to remain in the pull-down bed without supervi-
sion.
X But in particular with regard to small children less than 6 years of age, users
should ensure that they cannot fall out of the pull-down bed.
X Use separate children's beds or travel cots suitable for children.
X Switch off the reading lamps on the underside of the pull-down bed when
the bed is lowered. Fire hazard!
X Switch off the reading lamps in the pull-down bed before the bed is pushed
up. Fire hazard!
X Depending on the seat model, the backrest is under strong spring tension. If
there is no resistance to the backrest in these seats, it quickly moves forward
after unlocking.
X Only move the pull-down bed if there are no loads on it.
Z When folding up the pull-down bed ensure that the bedding does not press
onto the side curtains. This causes the curtains to be clamped in the rods so that
they can be damaged or soiled.
Living
7
103Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Preparing the driver's cabin Depending on equipment, the driver's and front passenger's seats have to be
adjusted in different ways before lowering the pull-down bed.
Variant 1 The seats of the central seating group in opposite direction to the direction of
travel are not equipped with headrests (no safety package).
Turn the driver's seat and the front passenger's seat to the direction of vehicle
travel, lock them in place and move them backwards.
Fold the backrest back.
Close the shade in the driver's cabin.
Variant 2 The seats of the central seating group in opposite direction to the direction of
travel are equipped with headrests (safety package). The headrests on driver's and
front passenger's seats can be removed.
Remove the headrests.
Turn the driver's seat to the direction of travel, lock it in place and move it back-
wards.
Fold the backrest of the passenger's seat back.
Push the front passenger's seat forwards and fold the backrest back completely.
Turn the front passenger's seat in the opposite direction to the direction of
travel, so that the pull-down bed can be lowered.
Close the shade in the driver's cabin.
Variant 3 The seats of the central seating group in opposite direction to the direction of
travel are equipped with headrests (safety package). The headrests on driver's and
front passenger's seats can not be removed.
Push the driver's seat and the front passenger's seat forwards and fold the back-
rest back completely.
Turn the driver's seat and the front passenger's seat in the opposite direction to
the direction of travel, so that the pull-down bed can be lowered completely.
Close the shade in the driver's cabin.
Variant 4 The rests of the driver's and front passenger's seats must be tipped forwards before
the pull-down bed is lowered.
Turn the driver's and the front passenger's seat to the direction of travel, lock it
in place and move them backwards.
Release the backrest and fold it completely forwards.
Close the shade in the driver's cabin.
Living
7
104 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Manual pull-down bed
(variant 1)
Lowering the pull-down bed:
Switch off the reading lamps on the underside of the pull-down bed.
Open the fastener of the retaining belt.
Swing the pull-down bed down in a circle until it locks into place audibly.
Folding the pull-down bed up:
Switch off the reading lamps on the ceiling above the pull-down bed.
Loosen the retaining straps of the safety net and lay the safety net under the
mattress.
Use both hands to push the pull-down bed upwards.
Secure the pull-down bed to the roof (Fig. 115,2) by means of the retaining belt
(Fig. 115,5).
Access ladder Always use the access ladder provided as standard to access the pull-down bed.
Attaching:
Hook the access ladder to the pull-down bed by attaching both brackets into
the U-bolts (Fig. 115,4).
Safety net The safety net is stored as standard between the mattress and slatted frame. Only
use the safety net if persons are already in the alcove.
Setting up:
Fasten the retaining straps (Fig. 115,1) to the holders on the ceiling (Fig. 115,2).
Fig. 115 Manual pull-down bed Fig. 116 Manual pull-down bed retaining
belt
4 4
PRESS
Living
7
105Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Manual pull-down bed
(variant 2)
Lowering the pull-down bed:
Switch off the reading lamps on the underside of the pull-down bed.
Open the fastener of the retaining belt.
Pull the handle lever (Fig. 117,2) downwards in order to unlock the pull-down
bed.
Pull the pull-down bed down in a circle with both hands on the bar (Fig. 117,1)
until it locks into place audibly.
Folding the pull-down bed up:
Switch off the reading lamps on the ceiling above the pull-down bed.
Loosen the retaining straps of the safety net and lay the safety net under the
mattress.
Push the pull-down bed up in a circle with both hands on the bar until it locks
into place audibly.
Secure the pull-down bed to the roof by means of the retaining belt (Fig. 118).
Access ladder Always use the access ladder provided as standard to access the pull-down bed.
Attaching:
Hook the access ladder to the pull-down bed by attaching both brackets into
the bar (Fig. 117,1).
Safety net The safety net is stored as standard between the mattress and slatted frame. Only
use the safety net if persons are already in the alcove.
Setting up:
Fasten the retaining straps (Fig. 113,1) to the holders on the ceiling (Fig. 113,2).
Fig. 117 Manual pull-down bed Fig. 118 Manual pull-down bed retaining
belt
PRESS
Living
7
106 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Manual pull-down bed
(variant 3)
Lowering the pull-down bed:
Switch off the reading lamps on the underside of the pull-down bed.
Open the fastener of the retaining belt.
Pull the locking knob (Fig. 119, 2) in order to unlock the pull-down bed.
Pull the pull-down bed down in a circle with both hands on the bar (Fig. 119,1)
until it locks into place audibly.
Folding the pull-down bed up:
Switch off the reading lamps on the ceiling above the pull-down bed.
Loosen the retaining straps of the safety net and lay the safety net under the
mattress.
Push the pull-down bed up in a circle with both hands on the bar until it locks
into place audibly.
Secure the pull-down bed to the roof by means of the retaining belt (Fig. 120).
Access ladder Always use the access ladder provided as standard to access the pull-down bed.
Attaching:
Hook the access ladder to the pull-down bed by attaching both brackets into
the bar (Fig. 119,1).
Safety net The safety net is stored as standard between the mattress and slatted frame. Only
use the safety net if persons are already in the alcove.
Setting up:
Fasten the retaining straps (Fig. 113,1) to the holders on the ceiling (Fig. 113,2).
Fig. 119 Hubbett manuell Fig. 120 Sicherungsgurt Hubbett manuell
1 2
PRESS
Living
7
107Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Manual pull-down bed with
extendable frame
Lowering the pull-down bed:
Switch off the reading lamps on the underside of the pull-down bed.
Turn the black handle (Fig. 121,2 and Fig. 122) at the bottom of the bed to
release the locking mechanism.
Pull the pull-down bed down in a circle with both hands on the bar (Fig. 121,1)
until it locks into place audibly.
Press the button at the front of the pull-down bed (Fig. 121,3) to unlock the
extendable frame.
Pull the bar (Fig. 121,1) with both hands to increase the bed area.
Fasten the safety net with the retaining straps to the ceiling.
Folding the pull-down bed up:
Switch off the reading lamps on the ceiling above the pull-down bed.
Loosen the retaining straps of the safety net and lay the safety net under the
mattress.
Use both hands to push the pull-down bed upwards.
Access ladder Always use the access ladder provided as standard to access the pull-down bed.
Attaching:
Hook the access ladder to the pull-down bed by fitting both brackets into the
bar.
Safety net The safety net is stored as standard between the mattress and slatted frame. Only
use the safety net if persons are already in the alcove.
Setting up:
Fasten the retaining straps to the holders on the ceiling.
Fig. 121 Manual pull-down bed Fig. 122 Handle of pull-down bed
Living
7
108 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Electrical pull-down bed
(variant 1)
Lowering the pull-down bed:
Switch off the reading lamps on the underside of the pull-down bed.
Turn the handle (Fig. 123,2) underneath the pull-down bed.
The pull-down bed is lowered automatically.
Folding the pull-down bed up:
Switch off the reading lamps on the ceiling above the pull-down bed.
Loosen the retaining straps of the safety net and lay the safety net under the
mattress.
Turn the handle underneath the pull-down bed.
The pull-down bed folds up automatically.
Access ladder Always use the access ladder provided as standard to access the pull-down bed.
Hook the access ladder to the pull-down bed by fitting both brackets into the
holding bar (Fig. 123,1).
Safety net The safety net is stored as standard between the mattress and slatted frame. Only
use the safety net if persons are already in the pull-down bed.
Setting up:
Fasten the retaining straps (Fig. 115,1) to the holders (Fig. 115,3) on the ceiling.
Fig. 123 Electrical pull-down bed Fig. 124 Electrical pull-down bed handle
Living
7
109Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Electrical pull-down bed
(variant 2)
Lowering or lifting the pull-
down bed:
Insert the key (Fig. 125, 3) into the operating panel (Fig. 125, 2).
Press the or (Fig. 125, 1) button and keep it pressed.
The respective LED (Fig. 125, 2) lights up and the pull-down bed moves down or
up.
When the desired position has been reached, release the or (Fig. 125, 1)
button again. The respective LED (Fig. 125, 2) extinguishes.
Remove the key (Fig. 125, 3).
Safety net The safety net (Fig. 126, 2) is stored as standard between the mattress and slatted
frame. Do not use the safety net until the person is already in bed.
Setting up:
Fasten the retaining straps (Fig. 126, 1) to the holders on the ceiling.
X After the pull-down bed has reached its position, be sure to remove the key
from the operating panel.
X Ensure that no-one is on or under the pull-down bed when the pull-down
bed is being moved.
Z Attach the safety guard.
Fig. 125 Operating panel for the electrical
pull-down bed
Fig. 126 Safety net
Living
7
110 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
7.15.3 Pull-down bed (model T)
The pull-down bed is located above the front seating group.
Opening the pull-down bed:
Switch off the reading lamps on the underside of the pull-down bed.
Loosen the retaining belt (Fig. 127).
With both hands, pull the pull-down bed down as far as it will go.
Closing the pull-down bed:
Switch off the reading lamps in the pull-down bed.
Loosen the retaining straps of the safety net and lay the safety net under the
mattress.
Use both hands to push the pull-down bed upwards as far as it will go.
Attach the retaining belt (Fig. 127).
X The maximum permitted pull-down bed load is 200 kg.
X The pull-down bed is not to be used for the storage of luggage. When the
bed is not being used, only place the bed linen which is required for two per-
sons in it.
X Before commencing the journey, secure the pull-down bed. To do this, lock
the pull-down bed.
X Only use the pull-down bed if it is moved all the way down and the safety net
is in position.
X Never allow small children to remain in the pull-down bed without supervi-
sion.
X But in particular with regard to small children less than 6 years of age, users
should ensure that they cannot fall out of the pull-down bed.
X Use separate children's beds or travel cots suitable for children.
X Switch off the reading lamps on the underside of the pull-down bed when
the bed is lowered. Fire hazard!
X Switch off the reading lamps in the pull-down bed before the bed is pushed
up. Fire hazard!
Z When folding up the pull-down bed ensure that the bedding does not press
onto the side curtains. This causes the curtains to be clamped in the rods so that
they can be damaged or soiled.
Fig. 127 Safety belt
PRESS
Living
7
111Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Access ladder Always use the access ladder provided as standard to access the pull-down bed.
Hook the access ladder to the pull-down bed by attaching both brackets into
the U-bolts (Fig. 128,1).
Safety net The safety net (Fig. 129,2) with the retaining straps is stowed under the mattress.
Only use the safety net if persons are already in the pull-down bed.
Tensioning:
Fasten the retaining straps (Fig. 129,1) to the holders on the ceiling.
Fig. 128 Access ladder holder Fig. 129 Safety net holder
Living
7
112 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
7.15.4 Bunk bed
Depending on the model, the rear area is fitted with a bunk bed. The bunk bed can
also be used as a rear garage.
Converting the bunk bed into
the rear garage:
Pull on the loop (Fig. 130,3) and release the latch (Fig. 130,1).
Pull the slatted frame (Fig. 130,2) together with the mattress forward until it
latches in place.
Access ladder Always use the access ladder provided as standard to reach the top bed.
Attaching:
Attach the access ladder with the rails to the holder (Fig. 131,3) on the panel.
Safety net The safety net (Fig. 131,1) is stored as standard between the mattress and slatted
frame. Do not use the safety net until the person is already in bed.
Setting up:
Fasten the retaining straps (Fig. 131,2) to the holders on the ceiling.
X The maximum permitted bunk bed load is 100 kg.
X Only use the bunk bed, if the safety net is set up.
X Never allow small children to remain in the bunk bed without supervision.
X But in particular with regard to small children less than 6 years of age, users
should ensure that they cannot fall out of the bunk bed.
X Use separate children's beds or travel cots suitable for children.
Fig. 130 Bunk bed (rear)
Fig. 131 Safety net
Living
7
113Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
7.15.5 Bunk bed (side)
Depending on the model, the side area is fitted with a bunk bed. The bunk bed can
also be used as a storage area.
Converting the storage area to
a bunk bed:
Open the storage flap and fold out the support leg (Fig. 132,2) under the bed.
Pull the loop (Fig. 132,1) and tilt the bed (Fig. 132,3) downwards.
Take the mattress (Fig. 133,3) off the top bed and place it on the bottom bed.
Access ladder Always use the access ladder provided as standard to reach the top bed.
Attaching:
Attach the access ladder with the rails to the holder (Fig. 133,4) on the panel.
Safety net The safety net (Fig. 133,1) is stored as standard between the mattress and slatted
frame. Do not use the safety net until the persons are already in bed.
Setting up:
Fasten the retaining straps (Fig. 133,2) to the holders on the ceiling.
X Only use the bunk bed with the safety net or safety guard (depending on the
model) in position.
X The maximum permitted bunk bed load is 100 kg.
X Never allow small children to remain in the bunk bed without supervision.
X But in particular with regard to small children less than 6 years of age, users
should ensure that they cannot fall out of the bunk bed.
X Use separate children's beds or travel cots suitable for children.
Z Remove the mattress from the bottom bed and put it on the top bed before
converting the bunk bed into a storage compartment.
Fig. 132 Supports and unlocking device Fig. 133 Bunk bed (side)
1
2
3
4
Living
7
114 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
7.15.6 Fixed bed (gas-pressure springs)
A storage compartment is underneath the bed. Lift up the slatted frame to place
items in the storage compartment or to empty it from the inside of the vehicle.
Opening:
Lift the mattress forwards and set it down on the panel.
Lift slatted frame. The gas-pressure springs (Fig. 134,1) hold the slatted frame
open.
Closing:
Press the slatted frame downwards against the resistance of the gas-pressure
springs.
If necessary, push the mattress behind the panel.
7.15.7 Bed in sleeper roof
Depending on the model, the vehicle is fitted with a sleeper roof.
Fig. 134 Fixed bed
X The maximum permitted load on the bed in the sleeper roof is 200 kg.
X Before commencing the journey, retract the sleeper roof.
X Only use the bed in the sleeper roof if the safety guards are in position.
X Never leave small children without supervision.
X But in particular with regard to small children less than 6 years of age, users
should ensure that they cannot fall out of the bed.
X Switch off the reading lamps in the sleeper roof before retracting the sleeper
roof. Fire hazard!
Z Attach the safety guard if persons are already in the sleeper roof.
Living
7
115Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Opening: Release the safeguards (Fig. 136) by pulling them.
Push the sleeper roof (Fig. 135,2) upwards with both hands on the handles.
Pull the mattress (Fig. 135,1) downwards at the pulling device (Fig. 135,3) until
it engages audibly.
Closing:
Close elastic bands in the sleeper roof so that the cloth bellows are not pinched.
Press the mattress (Fig. 135,1) upwards.
Pull the sleeper roof downwards at the pulling device (Fig. 135,4).
Lightly pull the safeguards (Fig. 136,1) downwards and hook them in.
Fig. 135 Bed in sleeper roof Fig. 136 Securing of the sleeper roof
1 2
3
4
Z When the sleeper roof is being retracted: Ensure that the safety guards and the
cloth bellows are not pinched.
Living
7
116 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
7.16 Converting seating groups for sleeping
7.16.1 Central seating group
Convert the table (Fig. 137,3) to a bed foundation (see section 7.9).
Depending on the model, insert the bar (Fig. 137,4) or pull it inwards. The bar is
correctly positioned if it supports the table-top about 15 - 20 cm behind the
table leg.
Pull the seat cushions (Fig. 138,2) into the centre.
Insert the back cushions (Fig. 138,1) between the seat cushions and the wall.
X In the event of an accident, emergency braking or on uneven road surfaces,
additional cushions with reinforced undersides can be thrown through the
vehicle and injure the occupants of the vehicle. Before setting off, stow the
additional cushions safely away or secure them with the straps.
Z Depending on the model, the seating group can be different in shape and posi-
tion to the one shown here.
Z Depending on the model, an enclosed additional cushion must be inserted
between the seat cushions.
Fig. 137 Prior to conversion
Fig. 138 After conversion
1 Back cushion
2 Seat cushion
3 Table
4 Bar
5 Mounting rail
Z Depending on the model, instead of the second back cushion (Fig. 138,1) an
additional cushion must be inserted.
Living
7
117Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
7.16.2 Central seating group with extension
Extend the table (Fig. 139,3) and convert it into a bed foundation (see
section 7.9).
Insert the bar (Fig. 139,7) or pull it inwards. The bar is correctly positioned if it
supports the table-top about 15 - 20 cm behind the table leg.
Pull on the handle (Fig. 139,8) and open the flap (Fig. 139,5).
Fold up the bench seat extension (Fig. 140,6) and wedge it with the flap.
Pull the seat cushions (Fig. 141,2) forwards and to the middle.
Insert the back cushions (Fig. 141,1) between the seat cushions and the wall.
Insert the additional cushions (Fig. 141,9) between the back cushions and the
wall.
Insert the additional cushions (Fig. 141,10) between the seat cushions and the
wall.
Fig. 139 Prior to conversion
Fig. 140 During conversion
Fig. 141 After conversion
1 Back cushion
2 Seat cushion
3 Table
4 Mounting rail
5 Flap
6 Bench seat extension
7 Bar
8 Handle
9 Additional cushion
10 Additional cushion
Z Depending on the model, instead of the second back cushion (Fig. 141,1) and
the second additional cushion (Fig. 141,9) two smaller additional cushions must
be inserted.
Living
7
118 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
7.16.3 Facing seating unit with extension
Extend the table (Fig. 142,3) and convert it into a bed foundation (see
section 7.9).
Remove the back cushion (Fig. 142,1) and lay it aside.
Pull the handle and open the flap (Fig. 142,6).
Fold up the bench seat extension (Fig. 143,7) and wedge it with the flap.
Pull the seat cushions (Fig. 144,2 and 4) forward and to the middle.
Place the back cushion (Fig. 144,5) between the seat cushion and the wall.
Insert the additional cushion (Fig. 144,8) between the seat cushion and the wall.
Place the additional cushions (Fig. 144,9, 10 and 11) between the cushions on
the table and the seat base and the wall.
Fig. 142 Prior to conversion
Fig. 143 During conversion
Fig. 144 After conversion
1 Back cushion
2 Seat cushion
3 Table
4 Seat cushion
5 Back cushion
6 Flap
7 Bench seat extension
8 Additional cushion
9 Additional cushion
10 Additional cushion
11 Additional cushion
Living
7
119Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
7.16.4 Facing seating unit with deflecting wall mat
Convert the table (Fig. 145,3) to a bed foundation (see Section 7.9).
Insert the bar (Fig. 145,4) or pull it inwards. The bar is correctly positioned if it
supports the table-top about 15 - 20 cm behind the table leg.
Pull the seat cushion (Fig. 146,2 and 7) to the centre so that it adjoins the other
seat cushion.
Fold over the back cushion (Fig. 146,1) and lay it on the bench.
Fold over the back cushion (Fig. 146,1) and lay it next to the back cushion on the
bench.
Lay the additional cushions (Fig. 146,8) in the gap between the seat cushions
and the back cushions.
Fig. 145 Prior to conversion
Fig. 146 After conversion
1 Back cushion
2 Seat cushion
3 Table
4 Bar
5 Mounting rail
6 Back cushion
7 Seat cushion
8 Additional cushion
1
2
1
2
3 4
6
7
6
7
1 2 3 2 1
54
1
2
2
6
7
88
7
2 2 8 1
Living
7
120 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
7.16.5 Central seating group with divan
Convert the central seating group for sleeping (see section 7.16.2).
Pull out the slatted frame (Fig. 148,3).
Pull the seat cushion (Fig. 149,2) to the central seating group.
Remove the additional cushion (Fig. 149,1) from the back cushion (Fig. 148,4).
The additional cushion is fixed to the back cushion with Velcro and can easily be
separated.
Lay the back cushion aside.
Insert the additional cushion between the seat cushions and the exterior wall.
Fig. 147 Prior to conversion
Fig. 148 During conversion
Fig. 149 After conversion
1 Additional cushion
2 Seat cushion
3 Slatted frame
4 Back cushion
Z For model A 5831 a small additional cushion must be inserted on the divan
behind the front passenger's seat.
Living
7
121Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
7.16.6 Round seating group (without slatted frame)
Convert the table (Fig. 150,3) to a bed foundation (see section 7.9).
Pull the seat cushions (Fig. 151,2) into the centre.
Insert the back cushions (Fig. 151,1) between the seat cushions and the exterior
wall.
Remove the back cushions (Fig. 151,4 and 5) and lay them aside.
Fig. 150 Prior to conversion
Fig. 151 During conversion
Fig. 152 After conversion
1 Back cushion
2 Seat cushion
3 Table
4 Back cushion
5 Back cushion
Living
7
122 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
7.16.7 Round seating group
Convert the table (Fig. 153,3) to a bed foundation (see section 7.9).
Pull the seat cushions (Fig. 154,2) into the centre.
Insert the back cushions (Fig. 154,1) between the seat cushions and the exterior
wall.
Remove the back cushions (Fig. 154,4) and lay them aside.
Fig. 153 Prior to conversion
Fig. 154 During conversion
Fig. 155 After conversion
1 Back cushion
2 Seat cushion
3 Table
4 Back cushion
Living
7
123Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
7.16.8 Front bench seat
Turn the driver's seat (Fig. 156,4) and push it all the way forward.
Convert the table (Fig. 156,3) to a bed foundation (see section 7.9).
Variant 1
If the vehicle has a guest bed foundation (Fig. 157,6), remove the back cushion
(Fig. 156,1) and the seat cushion (Fig. 156,2) and lay them aside.
Depending on the model, lay the included guest bed foundation (Fig. 157,6)
onto the table. Lay the front edge of the guest bed foundation directly against
the driver's seat or the brace on the driver's cabin.
Place the additional cushion (Fig. 157,5) on the driver's seat.
Place the seat cushion (Fig. 157,2) on the table.
Insert the back cushion (Fig. 157,1) between the seat cushion and the rear wall.
Observe the wedged form.
Variant 2
Place the additional cushion (Fig. 158,5) on the driver's seat.
Place the seat cushion (Fig. 158,2) on the table.
Insert the additional cushion (Fig. 158,7) between the seat cushion and the rear
wall.
Both variants
Push back the driver's seat (Fig. 157,4 or Fig. 158,4) again.
Fig. 156 Prior to conversion
1 Back cushion
2 Seat cushion
3 Table
4 Driver's seat
5 Additional cushion
6 Guest bed foundation
7 Additional cushion
Fig. 157 After conversion (variant 1) Fig. 158 After conversion (variant 2)
Z If sport seats are fitted in the vehicle: Place a seat wedge on the driver's seat
before putting on the additional cushion.
Living
7
124 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
7.16.9 Front bench seat with divan
Extend the table (Fig. 159,3) and convert it into a bed foundation (see
section 7.9).
Pull the handle and open the flap (Fig. 159,6).
Fold up the bench seat extension (Fig. 160,7) and wedge it with the flap.
Pull the seat cushion (Fig. 160,2) of the divan into the middle.
Place the back cushion (Fig. 160,1) of the divan between the seat cushion and
the wall.
Pull the seat cushion (Fig. 160,5) forwards onto the table.
Variant 1
Fold over the back cushion (Fig. 161,4) and pull it into the middle.
Insert the additional cushion (Fig. 161,8) between the back cushion (Fig. 161,4)
and the seat cushion (Fig. 161,5).
Variant 2
Remove the back cushion (Fig. 160,4) and lay it aside.
Insert the additional cushions (Fig. 162,10 and 11) between the seat cushion
(Fig. 162,5) and the wall.
Both variants
Place the additional cushion (Fig. 161,9 or Fig. 162,9) between the back cushion
(Fig. 161,1 or Fig. 162,1) and the seat cushion (Fig. 161,2 or Fig. 162,2).
Fig. 159 Prior to conversion
1 Back cushion
2 Seat cushion
3 Table
4 Back cushion
5 Seat cushion
6 Flap
7 Bench seat extension
8 Additional cushion
9 Additional cushion
10 Additional cushion
11 Additional cushion
Fig. 160 During conversion
Fig. 161 After conversion (variant 1) Fig. 162 After conversion (variant 2)
Living
7
125Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
7.16.10 Front bench seat with divan (extendable)
Extend the table (Fig. 163,4) and convert it into a bed foundation (see
section 7.9).
Pull the handle and open the flap (Fig. 163,7).
Fold up the bench seat extension (Fig. 164,8) and wedge it with the flap.
Pull out the bedding box extension (Fig. 164,3).
Pull the seat cushion (Fig. 164,2) of the divan into the middle.
Place the back cushion (Fig. 164,1) of the divan between the seat cushion and
the wall.
Pull the seat cushion (Fig. 164,6) forwards onto the table.
Variant 1
Fold over the back cushion (Fig. 165,5) and pull it into the middle.
Insert the additional cushion (Fig. 165,9) between the back cushion (Fig. 165,5)
and the seat cushion (Fig. 165,6).
Variant 2
Remove the back cushion (Fig. 164,5) and lay it aside.
Insert the additional cushions (Fig. 166,11 and 12) between the seat cushion
(Fig. 166,6) and the rear wall.
Both variants
Place the additional cushion (Fig. 165,10 or Fig. 166,10) between the back
cushion (Fig. 165,1 or Fig. 166,1) and the seat cushion (Fig. 165,2 or Fig. 166,2).
Fig. 163 Prior to conversion
1 Back cushion
2 Seat cushion
3 Bedding box extension
4 Table
5 Back cushion
6 Seat cushion
7 Flap
8 Bench seat extension
9 Additional cushion
10 Additional cushion
11 Additional cushion
12 Additional cushion
Fig. 164 During conversion
Fig. 165 After conversion (variant 1) Fig. 166 After conversion (variant 2)
Living
7
126 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
7.16.11 Front bench seat with lengthwise seat
Extend the table (Fig. 167,3) and convert the extended suspension table into a
bed foundation (see section 7.9).
Pull the handle and open the flap (Fig. 167,6).
Fold up the bench seat extension (Fig. 168,7) and wedge it with the flap.
Remove the back cushion of the lengthwise seat (Fig. 168,1) and lay it aside.
Pull the seat cushion of the lengthwise seat (Fig. 168,2) forwards as far as the
table.
Insert the additional cushion (Fig. 169,8) between the seat cushion of the
lengthwise seat and the rear wall.
Pull the seat cushion of the bench (Fig. 168,5) forwards onto the table.
Fold over the back cushion of the seat bench (Fig. 168,4) and pull it onto the
seat bench extension.
Insert the additional cushion (Fig. 168,9) between the seat cushion and the back
cushion.
Place the additional cushions (Fig. 168,10, 11 and 12) between the side wall and
the cushions on the table and the seat base.
Fig. 167 Prior to conversion
Fig. 168 During conversion
Fig. 169 After conversion
1 Back cushion
2 Seat cushion
3 Table
4 Back cushion
5 Seat cushion
6 Flap
7 Bench seat extension
8 Additional cushion
9 Additional cushion
10 Additional cushion
11 Additional cushion
12 Additional cushion
13 Additional cushion (special models)
13
Living
7
127Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
7.16.12 Front seating group
Convert the table (Fig. 170,3) to a bed foundation (see section 7.9).
Pull the seat cushions (Fig. 171,2 and 4) into the centre.
Insert the back cushions (Fig. 171,1 and 5) between the seat cushions and the
exterior wall.
Place the additional cushion (Fig. 172,6) between the seat cushions (Fig. 172,2
and 4).
Fig. 170 Prior to conversion
Fig. 171 During conversion
Fig. 172 After conversion
1 Back cushion
2 Seat cushion
3 Table
4 Seat cushion
5 Back cushion
6 Additional cushion
Living
7
128 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
7.16.13 L-seating group
Turn the driver's seat and push it all the way up.
Convert the table (Fig. 173,3) to a bed foundation (see section 7.9).
Fold up and support the table top.
Pull the handle and open the flap of the seat bench extension.
Fold up the bench seat extension (Fig. 174,6) and wedge it with the flap.
Place the additional cushion (Fig. 175,7) on the table.
Lay the seat cushions (Fig. 175,4 and 5) onto the table behind the additional
cushion.
Pull the seat cushion (Fig. 175,2) forwards.
Insert the back cushion (Fig. 175,1) between the seat cushion and the rear wall.
Place the additional cushions (Fig. 175,8 and 9) between the side wall and the
cushions on the table and the seat base.
Push back the driver's seat as a retainer.
Fig. 173 Prior to conversion
Fig. 174 During conversion
Fig. 175 After conversion
1 Back cushion
2 Seat cushion
3 Table
4 Seat cushion
5 Seat cushion
6 Bench seat extension
7 Additional cushion
8 Additional cushion
9 Additional cushion
Living
7
129Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
7.17 Bath area
The door of the toilet area (Fig. 176,1) can be locked into a bath area in 1-3 different
opening widths depending on the equipment. Depending on the selected
opening width, different room segments can be combined with each other.
Room division options The room door allows
z the toilet area to be closed for itself.
z the toilet area and the shower area to be combined.
z the toilet area, the shower area and the wardrobe to be combined.
7.18 Sleeping area partition
Depending on the model the sleeping area in the rear can be partitioned by a
folding door or by a sliding door.
7.18.1 Sliding door
Closing the sliding door: Release the securing strap (Fig. 178,1).
Pull the sliding door (Fig. 178,2) into the closing position.
Opening the sliding door:
Push the sliding door (Fig. 178,2) into the open position.
Secure the sliding door with the securing strap (Fig. 178,1).
Fig. 176 Bath area Fig. 177 EVAN bath area
1
Z Sliding doors or folding doors can bang shut uncontrolled while travelling.
Material damage can occur. Before commencing the journey open the sleeping
area partition and secure it with the securing strap.
Fig. 178 Sliding door
1
2
Living
7
130 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
7.18.2 Folding door
Closing the folding door: Release the securing strap (Fig. 179,2).
Pull the folding door (Fig. 179,1) into the closing position.
Opening the folding door:
Push the folding door (Fig. 179,1) into the open position.
Secure the folding door with the securing strap (Fig. 179,2).
Fig. 179 Folding door
1
2
Gas system
8
131Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
8Gas system
Chapter overview
This chapter contains instructions regarding the gas system of the vehicle.
The instructions address the following topics:
z safety
z gas consumption
z changing the gas bottles
z gas isolator taps
z hose break guard
z external gas connection
z automatic switching facility
The operation of the gas operation appliances of the vehicle is described in
chapter 10.
8.1 General
X Before commencing the journey, when leaving the vehicle or when gas
equipment is not in use, close all gas isolator taps and the main isolator tap
on the gas bottle.
X No appliance operated by a naked flame (e.g. heater or refrigerator) may be
in operation when filling the tank, on ferries or in the garage. Danger of
explosion!
X Do not use appliances operated with a naked flame in closed spaces (e.g.
garages). Danger of poisoning and suffocation!
X Only have the gas system maintained, repaired or altered by an authorised
specialist workshop.
X Have the gas system checked by an authorised specialist workshop
according to the national regulations before commissioning. This also
applies for not registered vehicles. For modifications to the gas system have
the gas system immediately checked by an authorised specialist workshop.
X The gas pressure regulator and exhaust gas pipes must also be inspected.
The gas pressure regulator has to be replaced after 10 years at the latest. The
vehicle owner is responsible for seeing that this is carried out.
X In case of a defect of the gas system (gas odour, high gas consumption) there
is danger of explosion! Close regulator tap on the gas bottle immediately.
Open doors and windows and ventilate well.
X If the gas system is defective: Do not smoke; do not ignite any open flames,
and do not operate electric switches (light switches etc.).
X Before using the cooker make sure that there is sufficient ventilation. Open
windows or the skylight.
X Do not use the gas cooker or gas oven for heating purposes.
X If there are several gas devices, each gas device must have its own gas iso-
lator tap. If individual gas devices are not in use, close the respective gas iso-
lator tap.
X Ignition safety valves must close within 1 minute after the gas flame has
extinguished. A clicking sound is audible. Check function from time to time.
X The built-in gas devices are exclusively meant for use with propane or butane
gas or a mixture of both. The gas pressure regulator as well as all built-in gas
devices are designed for a gas pressure of 30 mbar.
Gas system
8
132 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
8.2 Gas bottles
X Propane gas is capable of gasification up to -42 °C, whereas butane gas gas-
ifies at 0 °C. Below these temperatures no gas pressure is available. Butane
gas is unsuitable for use in winter.
X Regularly inspect the gas tube fitted to the gas bottle connection for tight-
ness. The gas tube must not have any tears and must not be porous. Have the
gas tube replaced by an authorised specialist workshop no later than
ten years after the manufacturing date. The operator of the gas system must
see to it that the parts are replaced.
X Due to its function and construction, the gas bottle compartment is a space
which is open to the exterior. Never cover or block up the standard forced
ventilations. Otherwise gas that is emitted can not be diverted to the outside.
X Do not use the gas bottle compartment as storage space as it is not moisture-
proof.
X Secure the gas bottle compartment against unauthorised access. To do this,
lock the compartment.
X The regulator tap on the gas bottle must be accessible.
X Only connect gas-operated devices (e.g. gas grill) which have been designed
for a gas pressure of 30 mbar.
X The exhaust gas pipe must be fitted tightly to the heating system and to the
vent and must be sealed. The exhaust gas pipe must not show any evidence
of damage.
X Exhaust fumes must be able to escape into the atmosphere unhindered and
fresh air must be able to enter unhindered. For this reason, keep the exhaust
pipe and intake openings clean and unobstructed (e.g. free from snow and
ice). For this reason, no snow walls or aprons may lie against the vehicle.
X Gas bottles are only to be transported within the designated gas bottle com-
partment.
X Place the gas bottles in vertical position in the gas bottle compartment.
X Fasten the gas bottles so that they are unable to turn or tilt.
X If the gas bottles are not connected to the gas tube, always place the protec-
tive cap on top.
X Close the regulator tap on the gas bottle before the gas pressure regulator or
gas tube are removed from the gas bottle.
X The gas pressure regulator or the gas tube must only be secured with a suit-
able gas spanner (Do not overtighten).
X Only use special gas pressure regulators with a safety valve designed for
vehicle use. Other gas pressure regulators are not permitted and cannot
meet the demanding requirements.
X Use the gas pressure regulator defroster if the temperature falls below 5 °C.
X Use only 11 kg or 5 kg gas bottles. Camping gas bottles with built-in check
valve (blue bottle with max. 2.5 or 3 kg content) are can be used in excep-
tional cases with a safety valve.
X Use the shortest possible tube lengths (150 cm max.) for external gas bottles.
X Never block the floor ventilation openings below the gas bottles.
Gas system
8
133Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
8.3 Gas consumption
Example A full 11 kg gas bottle is sufficient to:
z Cook for 3 days using one flame,
z Heat for 22 hours on full output or
z Cool for 25 days.
Z With some models, the gas bottle compartment is located right next to the con-
version door. With these models, only open the gas bottle compartment when
the conversion door is closed. Danger from damages.
Z For gas-operated units the gas pressure must be reduced to 30 mbar.
Z Connect gas pressure regulator complete with safety valve directly to bottle
valve.
The gas pressure regulator reduces the gas pressure in the gas bottle down to
the operating pressure of the gas devices.
Z For filling and connecting the gas bottles in Europe the accessories shops have
corresponding Euro filling sets and Euro bottle sets.
Z Information available at the dealers or service centre.
Z For information on the gas supply in Europe see chapter 18.
Z The data about gas consumption of the individual gas devices is standard
average values.
Appliances Gas consumption in grams/hour
Heater Approx. 170 - 490 g/h
Cooker, per cooker Approx. 140 - 165 g/h
Refrigerator Approx. 18 g/h
Gas system
8
134 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
8.4 Changing gas bottles
Depending on the model, the gas bottle holder can be pulled out of the gas bottle
compartment:
Open external gas bottle compartment (see section 7.2).
If there is a guard plate (Fig. 181,1), fold it down.
Unlock the slide (Fig. 181,3) using the handle (Fig. 181,2).
Pull out the slide (Fig. 181,3) as far as possible.
Turn back the handle (Fig. 181,2).
Close the regulator tap (Fig. 182,4) on the gas bottle. Pay attention to the direc-
tion of the arrow.
Unscrew the gas pressure regulator (Fig. 182,2) from the gas bottle at the hex-
agon nut (Fig. 182,3).
Remove the gas pressure regulator and the gas tube (Fig. 182,1) from the gas
bottle.
Release the fixing belts and remove the gas bottle.
Place a filled gas bottle in the gas bottle compartment.
Fix gas bottle in place with the fixing belts.
Position the gas pressure regulator (Fig. 182,2) and the gas tube (Fig. 182,1) on
the gas bottle and screw in tightly to the gas bottle at the hexagonal nut
(Fig. 182,3).
X When changing gas bottles, do not smoke or create any open fire.
X When you have changed the gas bottle, check whether gas escapes at the
connection points and unions. Use a leakage search spray to spray the rele-
vant connection point or union. These agents are available at the accessories
shop.
Fig. 180 Gas bottle compartment Fig. 181 Gas bottle compartment with
extendable slide
Fig. 182 Gas bottle connection
Gas system
8
135Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Unlock the slide (Fig. 181,3) using the handle (Fig. 181,2).
Push in the slide (Fig. 181,3) as far as possible, and turn back the handle
(Fig. 181,2).
If there is a guard plate (Fig. 181,1), fold it up.
Close the external flap (see section 7.2).
8.4.1 Changing a gas bottle in the vehicle inside
Depending on the vehicle equipment the gas bottle compartment can also be
located in the vehicle inside.
Open the flap in the vehicle floor (Fig. 183,1).
Close the regulator tap (Fig. 182,4) on the gas bottle. Pay attention to the direc-
tion of the arrow.
Hold the gas pressure regulator (Fig. 182,2) and open the knurled nut
(Fig. 182,3) (left-handed thread).
Remove the gas pressure regulator and the gas tube (Fig. 182,1) from the gas
bottle.
Release the fixing belts and remove the gas bottle.
Place a filled gas bottle in the gas bottle compartment.
Fix gas bottle in place with the fixing belts.
Position the gas pressure regulator (Fig. 182,2) and the gas tube (Fig. 182,1) on
the gas bottle and tighten the knurled nut (Fig. 182,3) by hand (left-handed
thread).
Close the flap in the vehicle floor (Fig. 183,1).
8.5 Gas isolator taps
Fig. 183 Symbols for the gas isolator taps
1
Fig. 184 Symbols for the gas isolator taps
1 Refrigerator
2 Cooker
3 Heater/boiler
4 Oven
Gas system
8
136 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
A gas isolator tap (Fig. 184) for every gas device is built into the vehicle.
The gas isolator taps can be found on the front of the cooker.
8.6 External gas connection
The external gas connection (Fig. 186) is located at the rear or to the left or right of
the vehicle depending on the model.
Connect the external gas device to the connection point (Fig. 186,2).
Open the gas isolator tap (Fig. 186,1).
Fig. 185 Symbols for the gas isolator taps,
alternative
1 Refrigerator/oven
2 Cooker
3 Heater/boiler
X If the external gas connection is not in use, always close the gas isolator tap.
X Only gas appliances with a suitable adapter should be connected to the
external gas connection.
X Connect only external gas appliances which are designed for an operation
pressure of 30 mbar.
X Once you have made the connection and opened the gas isolator tap, make
sure that no gas is escaping at the connection point. If there is a leak in the
external gas connection, gas will escape into the open air. Immediately close
the gas isolator tap and the regulator tap on the gas bottle. Have the external
gas connection checked by an authorised specialist workshop.
X When connecting an external gas appliance, make sure that there is nothing
near the external gas connection that could cause a spark.
X Do not use the external gas connection to fill gas bottles. Observe the infor-
mation stickers on the external gas connection.
Fig. 186 External gas connection, gas iso-
lator tap closed
1
2
Gas system
8
137Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
8.7 DuoControl CS switching facility
The DuoControl is an automatic switching facility with a remote display for a two-
bottle gas system. The DuoControl switching facility automatically switches gas
supply from the primary bottle to the reserve bottle as soon as the primary bottle
is either empty or no longer ready for operation. The gas appliances may still con-
tinue operation. The DuoControl switching facility is suitable for all commercial gas
bottles from 3 kg to 33 kg.
Construction of the unit The DuoControl switching facility consists of a reversing valve (Fig. 187,3) and an
operating unit (Fig. 188). The reversing valve is installed between the gas tubes
(Fig. 187,2 and 5). The knob (Fig. 187,4) on the reversing valve is used to select
which of the gas bottles is to be used as a primary bottle and which is to be used as
a reserve bottle.
The reversing valve is equipped with the regulator defroster Eis-Ex. This prevents
damage to the gas system during the winter months.
Only the electrical functions can be switched at the operating unit (Fig. 188). The
regulator taps on the gas bottles (Fig. 187,1 and 6) must be opened manually.
The reversing valve provides a constant gas pressure, regardless of which gas
bottle is being drawn upon. The two indicator lamps on the operating unit indicate
the level of the primary bottle. When the green indicator lamp (Fig. 188,6) illumi-
nates, the primary bottle is full. When the red indicator lamp (Fig. 188,5) illumi-
nates, the primary bottle is empty. In this case, the reserve bottle is used for the gas
supply.
X Do not use the switching facility in closed spaces.
X During the journey the gas system may only be operated with a crash sensor
and suitable high-pressure hoses with hose break guard. Danger of explo-
sion!
Z If the vehicle is equipped with a panel of the DT series and the switching facility
is operated via this panel, the operating unit is redundant.
Z Also read the manufacturer's instruction manual.
Fig. 187 DuoControl switching facility Fig. 188 Operating unit
Gas system
8
138 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Operating modes The DuoControl switching facility has two operating modes:
z Winter operation "On and heating"
z Summer operation "On"
Putting into operation:
Open the regulator taps on the gas bottles (Fig. 187,1 and 6).
Use the knob (Fig. 187,4) on the reversing valve (Fig. 187,3) to select the gas
bottle which is to be the primary source of gas (primary bottle).
Always turn the knob as far as it will go.
Switch on the DuoControl switching facility at the operating unit (Fig. 188).
To do so, set the rocker switch (Fig. 188,7) to winter operation "On and heating"
(Fig. 188,2) or to summer operation "On" (Fig. 188,4). The reversing valve is now
deaerated. The yellow indicator lamp (Fig. 188,1) illuminates if the winter oper-
ation has been selected and the regulator defroster is activated.
Switching off: Set the rocker switch (Fig. 188,7) to " " (Fig. 188,3). The yellow indicator lamp
(Fig. 188,1) goes out.
Close the regulator taps on the gas bottles (Fig. 187,1 and 6).
Remote display The indicator lamps on the operating unit (Fig. 188,5 and 6) indicate in the vehicle
interior whether the primary bottle is ready for operation.
Changing gas bottles If the green indicator lamp (Fig. 188,6) stops illuminating during operation and the
red indicator lamp (Fig. 188,5) illuminates, the gas bottle selected as primary bottle
is empty and needs to be changed. The reserve bottle continues supplying the gas
appliances with gas.
Changing gas bottles:
Close the regulator tap on the empty gas bottle.
Unscrew the gas tube of the gas bottle.
Connect the full gas bottle to the gas tube.
Open the regulator tap on the gas bottle.
Set the knob on the reversing valve with a half-turn, so that the newly replaced
gas bottle will serve as a reserve bottle.
Press the button for the hose break guard at the high-pressure hose to activate
it.
If necessary, press the reset button at the crash sensor.
X When changing gas bottles, do not smoke or create any open fire.
Gas system
8
139Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Crash sensor The crash sensor protects against unwanted gas discharge. In the event of an acci-
dent (above an impact speed of approx. 15 km/h) or an excess inclination of the
vehicle the gas supply will automatically be interrupted.
If the crash sensor was triggered, it must be released manually.
Releasing:
Press in the release button (Fig. 189,1) with a pin (Fig. 189,2) for several seconds.
Hose break guard The hose break guard protects against gas escaping in case of a defect or the high-
pressure hose tearing off.
The hose break guard has to be activated after the gas bottle has been replaced.
Activating:
Firmly press the green button at the high-pressure hose (Fig. 190).
Z Only if the vehicle is equipped with a crash sensor and suitable high-pressure
hoses with hose break guard, may the living area heater be operated during the
journey.
Z Additionally observe the manufacturer's instruction manual.
Fig. 189 Crash sensor
1
2
Z Use a suitable high-pressure hose with hose break guard and country-specific
connection for gas bottles.
Fig. 190 High-pressure hoses with hose
break guard (country-specific
variants)
Gas system
8
140 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Electrical system
9
141Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
9Electrical system
Chapter overview
This chapter contains instructions regarding the electrical system of the vehicle.
The instructions address the following topics:
z safety
z explanations of terms relating to the battery
z 12 V power supply
z living area battery
z loading the batteries
z AC converter
z auxiliary charging unit
z transformer/rectifier
z panel
z 240 V power supply
z connection to the 240 V power supply
z fuse rating
The operation of the electrical appliances of the housing body is described in
chapter 10.
9.1 General safety instructions
The vehicle is a safe place during a storm (Faraday cage). However, to protect the
electrical devices, disconnect the 240 V connection and retract the antennae as a
precaution.
X Only allow qualified personnel to work on the electrical system.
X All electronic devices (e.g. mobile telephones, radios, televisions or DVD
players) which have been retrofitted to the vehicle and are operated during
the journey must have certain features: These are the CE certification, the
EMC inspection (electromagnetic compatibility) and the "E1" inspection.
Only in this way can the functional reliability of the vehicle be ensured. Oth-
erwise the airbag may be triggered or interference to the on-board elec-
tronics may result.
Electrical system
9
142 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
9.2 Terms
Off-load voltage The off-load voltage is the voltage of the battery in idle condition, i. e. no current is
consumed and the battery is not being charged.
Closed circuit current Some electrical appliances, such as the clock and the indicator lamps, require con-
tinuous electric current, for this reason they are referred to as inactive appliances.
This closed circuit current flows even if the 12 V power supply has been switched
off.
Total discharge Total discharge of the battery is imminent, if a battery is completely discharged by
an active appliance and by closed circuit current.
Capacity Capacity refers to the amount of electricity which can be stored in a battery.
The capacity of a battery is given in ampere hours (Ah). If a battery possesses a
capacity of 80 Ah, then the battery can dispense a current of 1 A for 80 hours or a
current of 2 A for 40 hours.
External influences such as temperature may alter the storage capacity of the bat-
tery.
9.3 12 V power supply
When the vehicle is not connected to the 240 V power supply or the 240 V power
supply is switched off, the living area battery supplies the living area with 12 V DC.
The living area battery has a limited power supply only. For this reason, electrical
appliances such as the radio and the lights should not be operated for a long time
without using the 240 V power supply.
During heater operation, the circulation fan is switched on and off by a thermostat
control. As a result the living area battery is loaded if no 240 V power supply is con-
nected.
When the vehicle engine is running, the vehicle alternator recharges the living area
battery and the starter battery.
The 12 V power supply can be cut off with the 12 V main switch on the panel.
Depending on the model, the heater, basic light/entrance step and reserve 4 or
only the electrical entrance step remain on standby. The refrigerator is then only
operated with 12 V if the vehicle engine is running. This helps to prevent the living
area battery from being run down too quickly.
Z Total discharge damages the battery.
Z To disconnect all electrical 12 V appliances from the power supply, disconnect
the living area battery from the 12 V power supply. Depending on the model,
either press the switch on the transformer/rectifier or activate the battery sepa-
ration on the panel to do so.
Z The radio in the driver's cabin and the independent vehicle heater are by
default connected to the living area battery via a separate fuse. These appli-
ances will stay operational if the living area battery is disconnected from the
power supply via the battery cut-off switch of the transformer/rectifier or the
battery separation on the panel.
Electrical system
9
143Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
9.3.1 Living area battery
Position Depending on the model, the living area battery is installed either under the
driver's seat, under the front passenger's seat or in the bench behind the front pas-
senger's seat.
X When changing the living area battery, use only batteries which meet the
minimum capacity of the charger. Observe the separate instruction manual
for the charger. Lower-capacity batteries will generate a great deal of heat
when they are charged. Danger of explosion!
X Devices with a maximum of 10 A can be connected to the sockets of the 12 V
power supply. Fire hazard!
Z Use the charger module provided on the transformer/rectifier to charge the
living area battery. When charging externally, use a regulated charger that is
suitable for the battery type and the capacity of the living area battery.
Z Prior to commencing a journey ensure the living area battery is fully charged.
For this reason charge the battery for at least 24 hours before commencing the
journey.
Z During the trip, use every opportunity to charge the living area battery.
Z Charge the living area battery for at least 24 hours after the journey.
Z Before a temporary lay-up charge the battery for at least 24 hours, for longer
standstills 48 hours.
Z Interrupt the power circuit at times if the vehicle is not used for longer than 24
hours.
Z For long periods of inactivity (4 weeks or more), disconnect the living area bat-
tery from the 12 V power supply and recharge it regularly (charge for 24 hours
at least every 12 weeks).
Z In winter store the charged battery in a place which is cool and protected from
frost and recharge every 12 weeks.
Z When the living area battery is changed, only use batteries of the same type.
Z Before disconnecting or connecting the terminals of the battery, switch off the
vehicle engine, the 240 V and 12 V power supplies as well as all the appliances.
Danger of short circuit!
Z Do not use the ignition when the starter battery or the living area battery is dis-
connected. Danger of short circuit!
Z Take note of the battery manufacturer's users and maintenance instructions.
Z The battery is maintenance-free. Maintenance-free means:
It is not necessary to check the acid level.
It is not necessary to lubricate the battery poles.
It is not necessary to refill the distilled water.
Even a maintenance-free battery must be charged regularly.
Electrical system
9
144 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Discharging The living area battery is discharged by the closed circuit current which some elec-
trical appliances continuously require.
The self-discharge rate of the battery is dependant on temperature. At 20 to 25 °C
the self-discharge rate is approx. 3 % of the capacity per month. The self-discharge
rate will increase with rising temperatures: At 35 °C the self-discharge rate is
approx. 20 % of the capacity per month.
During periods of low external temperatures, the battery will lose part of its
capacity.
An older battery no longer has the complete capacity available.
The higher the number of active electrical appliances, the faster the energy of the
living area battery is consumed.
Second living area battery Depending on the model a second living area battery can be installed to extend the
available battery capacity.
Z Total discharge damages the battery.
Z Recharge battery in good time.
Z Appliances such as the safety/drainage valve, charger, solar charge regulator
and panel consume approx. 20 mA to 65 mA of electricity from the battery
capacity, even when the 12 V main switch is turned off. Therefore disconnect
the living area battery from the 12 V power supply, if the vehicle will not be used
for a long period of time.
Z Consumers such as the car radio or the navigation system should not run in
standby mode over longer periods. To do so, switch the car radio switch to "0".
The navigation system can be switched off via switch directly at the device. Also
observe the model-specific information in the instruction manual of the
devices.
Z Alterations to the battery system may only be carried out by an authorised
dealer.
Z When a second living area battery is installed, both the batteries used must be
of the same manufacturer, type and age.
Z The installation of a second battery or battery models with a higher capacity
extends the charging time correspondingly (e.g. double the charging time at
the installation of a second battery).
Electrical system
9
145Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
9.4 Charging the living area battery and starter battery
The starter battery can only be fully charged with an external charger. If a 240 V
power supply is used, the transformer/rectifier charges the starter battery with a
float charge only. Even in mobile operation, the vehicle engine alternator is not
capable of completely charging the starter battery.
9.4.1 Charging using a 240 V power supply
If the vehicle is connected to the 240 V power supply, the living area battery and
the starter battery are automatically charged by the charger module on the trans-
former/rectifier. The starter battery is only charged with a float charge. The
charging current is adapted to suit the charging condition of the battery. This
ensures that it is not possible to overload the battery.
To make use of the maximum output from the charger module on the transformer/
rectifier, switch off all electrical appliances during charging.
9.4.2 Charging using the vehicle engine
When the vehicle engine is running, the vehicle alternator recharges the living area
battery and the starter battery. When the vehicle engine is switched off, the bat-
teries are automatically disconnected from one another by a relay in the trans-
former/rectifier. This prevents the starter battery from being run down by electrical
appliances in the living area. The starting capability of the vehicle is thus preserved.
The charging condition of the living area battery or the starter battery can be read
on the panel.
X The acid in the battery is poisonous and corrosive. Any contact with the skin
or the eyes is to be avoided.
X In the case of charging with an external charger there is danger of explosion.
Only charge the battery in a well ventilated area and away from naked flames
or possible sources of sparks.
X Always remove the living area battery or the starter battery from the vehicle
when charging them using an external charger.
Z Do not connect the battery cables to the wrong poles.
Z If the starter battery or living area battery are disconnected, do not apply the
ignition. Danger of short circuit!
Z Before disconnecting or connecting the terminals of the battery, switch off the
vehicle engine as well as the 240 V and 12 V power supplies and all appliances.
Danger of short circuit!
Z Before charging the battery, check whether the external charger is approved for
the battery type.
Z Observe the instruction manuals for the base vehicle and the charger.
Z Irreparable damage to the living area battery will result if it is overcharged.
Electrical system
9
146 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
9.4.3 Charging with an external charger
When charging the living area battery and the starter battery with an external
charger, proceed as follows:
Turn off the vehicle engine.
Switch off 12 V main switch on the panel. The indicator lamp will go off.
Disconnect the living area battery from the 12 V power supply.
Disconnect the mains plug from the transformer/rectifier.
Switch off all gas appliances, all gas isolator taps and close the regulator tap on
the gas bottle.
There is a danger of short circuit when disconnecting the battery poles. For this
reason, first disconnect the negative terminal on the living area battery or the
starter battery and then the positive.
Remove the living area battery or the starter battery from the vehicle.
Check that the external charger is turned off.
Connect the external charger to the living area battery or the starter battery. Pay
attention to the polarity: First connect the positive terminal "+" to the positive
pole of the battery, then connect the negative terminal "–" to the negative pole
of the battery.
Switch on the external charger.
See the instructions for use of the connected charger for information con-
cerning charge period required for the battery.
See the specifications on the battery for information concerning its strength.
Disconnect the external charger in reverse order.
Electrical system
9
147Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
9.5 AC converter
Some models have a converter installed in the vehicle.
The AC converter supplies the 230 V sockets with voltage. When the vehicle is not
connected to the 230 V supply, the connected battery supplies the voltage.
The battery has a limited power supply only. For this reason, the electrical appli-
ances should not be operated for a long time without using the 230 V power
supply.
The converter can be switched to two operating modes with the main switch
(Fig. 191,1):
z I "On" = unit permanently switched on.
z II "Remo." = unit can be switched on and off at the external switch (Fig. 192,1).
The LEDs at the converter show the operating mode "Power Status" (Fig. 191,2), the
load range "Load Level" (Fig. 191,3) and the voltage range "Input Level" (Fig. 191,4).
The external switch for the converter (Fig. 192) is located in the interior of the
vehicle, for example in the entrance area. The switch is labeled with "Converter".
The LED (Fig. 192,1) indicates the operating state of the converter.
Z Do not cover the ventilation slots. Danger of overheating!
Z Additionally observe the manufacturer's instruction manual.
Fig. 191 Displays and operating controls Fig. 192 External switch
Electrical system
9
148 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
9.6 Auxiliary charging unit
The auxiliary charging unit (Fig. 193) supports the transformer/rectifier's charging
performance. Therefore, do not switch off the auxiliary charging unit.
Location The auxiliary charging unit is fitted next to the transformer/rectifier.
9.7 Transformer/rectifier (EBL 99)
Z Do not cover the ventilation slots. Danger of overheating!
Fig. 193 Auxiliary charging unit
1 Mains switch (on rear side of unit)
2 Battery selector switch
("Blei-Säure/Blei-Gel" (lead-acid/dryfill))
3 Fuse
Z Do not cover the ventilation slots. Danger of overheating!
Z Depending on the model, not all slots for the fuses are occupied.
Z Further information can be obtained in the manufacturer's instruction manual.
Electrical system
9
149Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Functions The transformer/rectifier has the following functions:
z The transformer/rectifier charges the living area battery. The transformer/recti-
fier charges the starter battery with a float charge only.
z The transformer/rectifier monitors the voltage in the living area battery.
z The transformer/rectifier distributes the current to the 12 V circuits and secures
them. Devices with a maximum of 10 A can be connected to the sockets.
z The transformer/rectifier contains connections for a solar charge regulator, an
auxiliary charging unit as well as other control and monitoring functions.
z When the engine is turned off, the transformer/rectifier separates the starter
battery electrically from the living area battery. This prevents the 12 V living
area appliances from discharging the starter battery.
The transformer/rectifier only works in conjunction with a panel.
When the transformer/rectifier is subject to a heavy load, the fitted charger module
reduces the charging current. This protects the charger from overheating. The
transformer/rectifier is subject to a heavy load when e.g. an empty living area bat-
tery is being charged, additional electrical appliances are turned on and the
ambient temperatures are high.
Position Depending on the model, the transformer/rectifier is located in the seat console
under the driver's seat or the front passenger's seat.
Fig. 194 Transformer/rectifier (EBL 99)
1 Main supply socket 240 V~
2 Output: Block 1 - refrigerator
3 Input: Block 2 - control lines, alternator D+
4 Output: Block 4 - heater, safety/drainage valve, basic light (lighting in the entrance
area), entrance step
5 Output: Block 3 - panel
6 Output: Block 5 -
Display solar cell at the board control (if fitted), spare 2, spare 3,
spare 4
7 Output: Block 6 - solar charge regulator (if fitted)
8 Output: Block 7 - auxiliary charging unit
9 Output: Block 8 - consumer circuit 1, consumer circuit 2, TV, water pump, spare 1,
spare 5, spare 6
10 Battery selector switch ("Blei-Säure/Blei-Gel" (lead acid/dryfill))
11 Fuses
12 Battery cut-off switch ("Batterie Ein/Aus" (battery On/Off))
Electrical system
9
150 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
9.7.1 Battery cut-off switch
The battery cut-off switch disconnects all the living area 12 V appliances, even the
safety/drainage valve. This prevents the living area battery from slowly discharging
if the vehicle is not used for a longer period of time (e.g. temporary lay-up).
The batteries can still be charged by the transformer/rectifier when the battery cut-
off switch is turned off.
Switching on/off:
Press the battery cut-off switch up: Battery ON ("Batterie EIN").
Press the battery cut-off switch down: Battery OFF ("Batterie AUS").
9.7.2 Battery selector switch
The battery selector switch is used to set the charger module in the transformer/
rectifier to the type of living area battery installed in the vehicle ("lead acid" or "dry-
fill" battery).
Z When the battery cut-off switch is OFF, the safety/drainage valve opens. The
water flows out of the boiler. When the battery cut-off switch is ON again, close
the safety/drainage valve of the boiler by hand.
Z Also switch off a refrigerator with automatic power selection system. The refrig-
erator will otherwise switch to gas operation.
Z After switching the battery cut-off switch back on again: Put the basic light
(lighting in the entrance area), entrance step, heater and spare 4 back into
service (depending on the model). To do so, switch on the 12 V main switch
briefly. This also applies if the living area battery was disconnected and then
reconnected.
X If the battery selector switch is set incorrectly, there is the danger of the for-
mation of detonating (oxy-hydrogen gas). Danger of explosion!
Z Incorrect setting of the battery selector switch damages the living area battery.
Z The factory settings of the battery selector switch must not be changed.
Electrical system
9
151Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
9.7.3 Battery monitor
The battery monitor in the transformer/rectifier monitors the voltage in the living
area battery.
If the battery voltage falls below 10.5 V, the battery monitor in the transformer/rec-
tifier switches off all of the 12 V appliances, excluding the safety/drainage valve.
A refrigerator with automatic power selection system switches to gas operation.
Measures:
Switch off all electrical appliances that are not absolutely essential at the corre-
sponding switch.
If necessary, use the 12 V main switch to switch the 12 V power supply back on
for a short while. This is only possible, however, when the battery voltage is
above 11 V. If the voltage is below this level, the 12 V power supply cannot be
switched on again until the living area battery has been recharged.
9.7.4 Charging the battery
When the vehicle engine is running, the vehicle alternator recharges the living area
battery and the starter battery. When the vehicle engine is switched off, the bat-
teries are automatically disconnected from one another by a relay in the trans-
former/rectifier. This prevents the starter battery from being run down by electrical
appliances in the living area. The starting capability of the vehicle is thus preserved.
The charging condition of the living area battery or the starter battery can be read
on the panel.
If the vehicle is connected to the 240 V power supply, the living area battery and
the starter battery are automatically charged by the charger module on the trans-
former/rectifier. The starter battery is only charged with a float charge. The
charging current is adapted to suit the charging condition of the battery. This
ensures that it is not possible to overload the battery.
To make use of the maximum output from the charger module on the transformer/
rectifier, switch off all electrical appliances during charging.
Z You must fully recharge a discharged living area battery as soon as possible.
Electrical system
9
152 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
9.8 Transformer/rectifier (EBL 101)
Functions The transformer/rectifier has the following functions:
z The transformer/rectifier charges the living area battery. The transformer/recti-
fier charges the starter battery with a float charge only.
z The transformer/rectifier monitors the voltage in the living area battery.
z The transformer/rectifier distributes the current to the 12 V circuits and secures
them. Devices with a maximum of 10 A can be connected to the sockets.
z The transformer/rectifier contains connections for a solar charge regulator and
an auxiliary charging unit as well as other control and monitoring functions.
z When the engine is turned off, the transformer/rectifier separates the starter
battery electrically from the living area battery. This prevents the 12 V living
area appliances from discharging the starter battery.
The transformer/rectifier only works in conjunction with a panel.
Z Do not cover the ventilation slots. Danger of overheating!
Z Depending on the model, not all slots for the fuses are occupied.
Z Further information can be obtained in the manufacturer's instruction manual.
Fig. 195 Transformer/rectifier (EBL 101)
1 Main supply socket 240 V~
2 Connections block 1: Refrigerator
3 Connections block 2: Alternator D+, sensor/control lines, refrigerator power supply
4 Connections block 4: Heater, safety/drainage valve, basic light (lighting in the entrance
area), entrance step
5 Connections block 3: Panel
6 Connections block 5: Spare 2, spare 3, spare 4
7 Connections block 9: Panel
8 Connections block 6: Solar charge regulator (if fitted)
9 Connections block 10:
Display solar cell at the board control (if fitted)
10 Connections block 7: Auxiliary charging unit
11 Connections block 8: Consumer circuit 1, consumer circuit 2, TV, water pump, spare 1,
spare 5, spare 6
12 Battery selector switch: "Blei-Säure/Blei-Gel" (lead-acid/dryfill)
13 Fuses
14 Battery cut-off switch: "Batterie Ein/Aus" (battery On/Off)
1
ELEKTROBLOCK
EBL 101
2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
131413
Electrical system
9
153Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
When the transformer/rectifier is subject to a heavy load, the fitted charger module
reduces the charging current. This protects the charger from overheating. The
transformer/rectifier is subject to a heavy load when e.g. an empty living area bat-
tery is being charged, additional electrical appliances are turned on and the
ambient temperatures are high.
Position Depending on the model, the transformer/rectifier (Fig. 195) is installed in the seat
console under the driver's seat or the front passenger's seat.
9.8.1 Battery cut-off switch
The battery cut-off switch disconnects all the living area 12 V appliances, even the
safety/drainage valve. This prevents the living area battery from slowly discharging
if the vehicle is not used for a longer period of time (e.g. temporary lay-up).
The batteries can still be charged by the transformer/rectifier when the battery cut-
off switch is turned off.
Switching on/off:
Press the battery cut-off switch up: Battery ON ("Batterie EIN").
Press the battery cut-off switch down: Battery OFF ("Batterie AUS").
9.8.2 Battery selector switch
The battery selector switch is used to set the charger module in the transformer/
rectifier to the type of living area battery installed in the vehicle ("lead acid" or "dry-
fill" battery).
Z When the battery cut-off switch is OFF, the safety/drainage valve opens. The
water flows out of the boiler. When the battery cut-off switch is ON again, close
the safety/drainage valve of the boiler by hand.
Z Also switch off a refrigerator with automatic power selection system. The refrig-
erator will otherwise switch to gas operation.
Z After switching the battery cut-off switch back on again: Put the basic light
(lighting in the entrance area), entrance step, heater and spare 4 back into
service (depending on the model). To do so, switch on the 12 V main switch
briefly. This also applies if the living area battery was disconnected and then
reconnected.
X If the battery selector switch is set incorrectly, there is the danger of the for-
mation of detonating (oxy-hydrogen gas). Danger of explosion!
Z Incorrect setting of the battery selector switch damages the living area battery.
Z The factory settings of the battery selector switch must not be changed.
Electrical system
9
154 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
9.8.3 Battery monitor
The battery monitor in the transformer/rectifier monitors the voltage in the living
area battery.
If the battery voltage falls below 10.5 V, the battery monitor in the transformer/rec-
tifier switches off all of the 12 V appliances, excluding the safety/drainage valve.
A refrigerator with automatic power selection system switches to gas operation.
Measures:
Switch off all electrical appliances that are not absolutely essential at the corre-
sponding switch.
If necessary, use the 12 V main switch to switch the 12 V power supply back on
for a short while. This is only possible, however, when the battery voltage is
above 11 V. If the voltage is below this level, the 12 V power supply cannot be
switched on again until the living area battery has been recharged.
9.8.4 Charging the battery
When the vehicle engine is running, the vehicle alternator recharges the living area
battery and the starter battery. When the vehicle engine is switched off, the bat-
teries are automatically disconnected from one another by a relay in the trans-
former/rectifier. This prevents the starter battery from being run down by electrical
appliances in the living area. The starting capability of the vehicle is thus preserved.
The charging condition of the living area battery or the starter battery can be read
on the panel.
If the vehicle is connected to the 240 V power supply, the living area battery and
the starter battery are automatically charged by the charger module on the trans-
former/rectifier. The starter battery is only charged with a float charge. The
charging current is adapted to suit the charging condition of the battery. This
ensures that it is not possible to overload the battery.
To make use of the maximum output from the charger module on the transformer/
rectifier, switch off all electrical appliances during charging.
Z You must fully recharge a discharged living area battery as soon as possible.
Electrical system
9
155Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
9.9 Transformer/rectifier (EBL 220)
Functions The transformer/rectifier has the following functions:
z The transformer/rectifier charges the living area battery. The transformer/recti-
fier charges the starter battery with a float charge only.
z The transformer/rectifier monitors the voltage in the living area battery.
z The transformer/rectifier distributes the current to the 12 V circuits and secures
them. Devices with a maximum of 10 A can be connected to the sockets.
z The transformer/rectifier contains connections for a solar charge regulator and
an auxiliary charging unit as well as other control and monitoring functions.
z When the engine is turned off, the transformer/rectifier separates the starter
battery electrically from the living area battery. This prevents the 12 V living
area appliances from discharging the starter battery.
Z Do not cover the ventilation slots. Danger of overheating!
Z Depending on the model, not all fuse slots are fitted with fuses.
Z Further information can be obtained in the manufacturer's instruction manual.
Fig. 196 Transformer/rectifier (EBL 101)
1 Connections block 1 and 2: Auxiliary charging unit
2 Fuses
3 Fuses
4 Connections block 9: Solar regulator (if fitted), only LRS
Connections block 10: Main connections
Connections block 11: ST Panel
5 Main supply socket 240 V~
6 Battery cut-off switch: Battery On/Off 4
7 Connections block 13: DT/LT Panel
8 Connections block 12: Living area battery sensor, D+
9 Connections block 8: Frost protection valve, gas alarm, step, TV, antenna
10 Connections block 6: Heating, Reserve 1, Reserve 2, Consumer circuit 1, Consumer cir-
cuit 2, Consumer circuit 3, Pump, D+
11 Connections block 7: Awning, D+, Consumer circuit 4, Consumer circuit 5, tank heater,
exterior light
12 Switch: Number of optional devices
13 Fuses
14 Battery cut-off switch: Solar regulator (if fitted), only LR
15 Connections block 4
Connections block 3: Refrigerator, folding bed
1
ELEKTROBLOCK
EBL 101
2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
131413
1 2 3 4 5 6
789101112131415
Electrical system
9
156 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
The transformer/rectifier only works in conjunction with a panel.
When the transformer/rectifier is subject to a heavy load, the fitted charger module
reduces the charging current. This protects the charger from overheating. The
transformer/rectifier is subject to a heavy load when e.g. an empty living area bat-
tery is being charged, additional electrical appliances are turned on and the
ambient temperatures are high.
Position Depending on the model, the transformer/rectifier (Fig. 195) is installed in the seat
console under the driver's seat or the front passenger's seat.
9.9.1 Battery cut-off switch
The battery cut-off switch disconnects all the living area 12 V appliances, even the
safety/drainage valve. This prevents the living area battery from slowly discharging
if the vehicle is not used for a longer period of time (e.g. temporary lay-up).
The batteries can still be charged by the transformer/rectifier when the battery cut-
off switch is turned off.
Switching on/off:
Press the battery cut-off switch up: Battery ON ("Batterie EIN").
Press the battery cut-off switch down: Battery OFF ("Batterie AUS").
9.9.2 Battery selector switch
The battery selector switch is used to set the charger module in the transformer/
rectifier to the type of living area battery installed in the vehicle ("lead acid" or "dry-
fill" battery).
Z When the battery cut-off switch is OFF, the safety/drainage valve opens. The
water flows out of the boiler. When the battery cut-off switch is ON again, close
the safety/drainage valve of the boiler by hand.
Z Also switch off a refrigerator with automatic power selection system. The refrig-
erator will otherwise switch to gas operation.
Z After switching the battery cut-off switch back on again: Put the basic light
(lighting in the entrance area), entrance step, heater and spare 4 back into
service (depending on the model). To do so, switch on the 12 V main switch
briefly. This also applies if the living area battery was disconnected and then
reconnected.
X If the battery selector switch is set incorrectly, there is the danger of the for-
mation of detonating (oxy-hydrogen gas). Danger of explosion!
Z Incorrect setting of the battery selector switch damages the living area battery.
Z The factory settings of the battery selector switch must not be changed.
Electrical system
9
157Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
9.9.3 Battery monitor
The battery monitor in the transformer/rectifier monitors the voltage in the living
area battery.
If the battery voltage falls below 10.5 V, the battery monitor in the transformer/rec-
tifier switches off all of the 12 V appliances, excluding the safety/drainage valve.
A refrigerator with automatic power selection system switches to gas operation.
Measures:
Switch off all electrical appliances that are not absolutely essential at the corre-
sponding switch.
If necessary, use the 12 V main switch to switch the 12 V power supply back on
for a short while. This is only possible, however, when the battery voltage is
above 11 V. If the voltage is below this level, the 12 V power supply cannot be
switched on again until the living area battery has been recharged.
9.9.4 Charging the battery
When the vehicle engine is running, the vehicle alternator recharges the living area
battery and the starter battery. When the vehicle engine is switched off, the bat-
teries are automatically disconnected from one another by a relay in the trans-
former/rectifier. This prevents the starter battery from being run down by electrical
appliances in the living area. The starting capability of the vehicle is thus preserved.
The charging condition of the living area battery or the starter battery can be read
on the panel.
If the vehicle is connected to the 240 V power supply, the living area battery and
the starter battery are automatically charged by the charger module on the trans-
former/rectifier. The starter battery is only charged with a float charge. The
charging current is adapted to suit the charging condition of the battery. This
ensures that it is not possible to overload the battery.
To make use of the maximum output from the charger module on the transformer/
rectifier, switch off all electrical appliances during charging.
9.10 Panel IT 992
Z You must fully recharge a discharged living area battery as soon as possible.
Fig. 197 Panel IT 992
1 V/tank gauge
2 Current gauge
3 12 V indicator lamp
4 12 V main switch
5 240 V indicator lamp
6 Rocker switch for circulating pump
7 Rocker switch for reading the level in
the water or waste water tanks
8 ALARM warning light for the living area
battery
9 Rocker switch for reading the battery
voltage of the starter and living area
batteries
1 2 3
456789
Electrical system
9
158 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
9.10.1 V/tank gauge for battery voltage and water or waste water levels
Battery voltage The V/tank gauge is for the indication of the battery voltage of the starter battery
or the living area battery.
With the V/tank gauge (Fig. 197,1), note the top scale. The gauge automatically
lights up as soon as a switch is pressed.
Displays:
Push the rocker switch (Fig. 197,9) up " ": The battery voltage of the starter
battery is displayed.
Push the rocker switch (Fig. 197,9) down " ": The battery voltage of the living
area battery is displayed.
The following tables will help you correctly interpret the battery voltage of the
living area battery displayed on the panel IT 992.
Battery voltage
(values during op-
eration)
Mobile operation
(vehicle moving,
no 240 V connec-
tion)
Battery operation
(vehicle station-
ary, no 240 V con-
nection)
Power operation
(vehicle station-
ary, 240 V connec-
tion)
Danger of total
discharge (battery
alarm)
11 V or less
1)
1)
The battery guard switches all the appliances off (at 10.5 V).
12 V power supply
overload
If appliances are
switched off: Bat-
tery flat
If appliances are
switched on: Bat-
tery overload
12 V power supply
overload
The battery is not
charged by the al-
ternator, the alter-
nator's regulator is
defective
The battery is not
charged by the
transformer/rectifi-
er, the transformer/
rectifier is defective
11.1 V to 13.2 V 12 V power supply
overload
2)
2)
If the voltage does not exceed this range for several hours.
Normal range 12 V power supply
overload
2)
The battery is not
charged by the al-
ternator, the alter-
nator's regulator is
defective
The battery is not
charged by the
transformer/rectifi-
er, the transformer/
rectifier is defective
13.3 V to 13.7 V Battery is being
charged (main
charge)
Occurs only briefly
after charging
Battery is being
charged (main
charge)
13.8 V to 14.4 V Battery being
charged (float
charge)
Battery being
charged (float
charge)
Over 14.5 V Battery is over-
charged, defective
alternator control
Battery is over-
charged, defective
transformer/rectifi-
er
Electrical system
9
159Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Volume of water/waste
water
The V/tank gauge is for the indication of the quantity of water or waste water.
With the V/tank gauge (Fig. 197,1), use the bottom scale. The gauge automatically
lights up as soon as a switch is pressed.
Displays:
Push the rocker switch (Fig. 197,7) up " ": The volume of water is displayed.
Push the rocker switch (Fig. 197,7) down " ": The volume of waste water is dis-
played.
9.10.2 Battery alarm for the living area battery
The red ALARM warning light (Fig. 197,8) flashes as soon as the voltage of the living
area battery falls below 11 V (measured under operation) and there is a risk of a
total discharge.
Values for off-load voltage Charging condition of the battery
Less than 11 V Totally discharged
12.3 V 50 %
12.5 V 75 %
More than 12.8 V Full
Z Total discharge causes irreparable damage to the battery.
Z Only read the tank levels briefly. Keeping the reading option on for a long time
can damage the transducers.
Z When the battery alarm comes on, switch off the appliances and charge the
living area battery, either by mobile operation or by connection to a 240 V
power supply.
Z Total discharge damages the battery.
Z If the battery voltage falls below 10.5 V, the battery monitor in the transformer/
rectifier switches off all of the 12 V appliances, excluding the safety/drainage
valve.
Electrical system
9
160 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
9.10.3 Current gauge for charging/discharging the living area battery
The battery current actually flowing is permanently displayed on the current gauge
(Fig. 197,2). The gauge automatically lights up as soon as a switch is pressed.
z Red "discharging" zone: Battery is being discharged at the discharging current
indicated between 0 and 30 A.
z Indicator "0": Battery is neither being charged nor discharged.
z Green "charging" zone: Battery is being charged at the charging current indi-
cated between 0 and 30 A.
9.10.4 12 V main switch
The 12 V main switch (Fig. 197,4) switches the panel and the 12 V power supply of
the living area on and off.
Exception: Depending on the model, safety/drainage valve, heater, basic light
(lighting in the entrance area), entrance step and spare remain ready to operate.
Switching on:
Push the rocker switch (Fig. 197,4) up " ": The 12 V living area power
supply is switched on. The indicator lamp (Fig. 197,3) lights up green.
Switching off:
Push the rocker switch (Fig. 197,4) down " ": The 12 V living area power
supply is switched off. The indicator lamp (Fig. 197,3) goes out.
Display Mobile operation
(vehicle moving,
no 240 V connec-
tion)
Battery operation
(vehicle station-
ary, no 240 V con-
nection)
Power operation
(vehicle station-
ary, 240 V connec-
tion)
Notes for charging/
discharge display
Red "discharging"
zone (discharging
current)
No charge!
Too many appli-
ances are switched
on or the alternator
is defective
Appliances are on
Battery is being dis-
charged
No charge!
Too many appli-
ances are switched
on
0 A (there is no cur-
rent)
Battery fully or vir-
tually charged
1)
1)
If the indicator falls from the green range to 0 and all appliances are switched off (apart
from the refrigerator).
Appliances are
switched off
Battery fully or vir-
tually charged
2)
2)
If the indicator falls from the green range to 0 and all appliances are switched off.
Green zone (charg-
ing current)
Battery is being
charged (up to
30 A possible)
Battery is being
charged (only pos-
sible with solar
power)
Battery is being
charged (up to
max. 16 A possible;
with 32 A auxiliary
charging unit)
Z When leaving the vehicle, switch off the 12 V main switch. This prevents any
unnecessary discharge of the living area battery.
Z Appliances such as the safety/drainage valve, charger, solar charge regulator
and panel consume approx. 20 mA to 65 mA of electricity from the battery
capacity, even when the 12 V main switch is turned off. Therefore disconnect
the living area battery from the 12 V power supply, if the vehicle will not be used
for a long period of time.
Electrical system
9
161Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
9.10.5 12 V indicator lamp
The 12 V indicator lamp (Fig. 197,3) illuminates whenever the 12 V main switch
(Fig. 197,4) is switched on.
9.10.6 240 V indicator lamp
The yellow 240 V indicator lamp (Fig. 197,5) illuminates whenever line voltage is
available at the transformer/rectifier input.
9.10.7 Switch for circulating pump
Switching on: Press the upper part of the rocker switch (Fig. 197,6): The circulating pump is
switched on.
Switching off:
Press the lower part of the rocker switch (Fig. 197,6) " ": The circulating
pump is switched off.
9.11 Panel MP 20-T
Z The luminance of the LEDs and the symbols adapts automatically to the
ambient light.
Z The displays can only be called up if the 12 V power supply is switched on.
Z As soon as a button is pressed, the gauge is automatically illuminated. The dis-
play goes out 20 seconds after the last key has been pressed.
Z Further information can be obtained in the manufacturer's instruction manual.
Fig. 198 Panel MP 20-T
1 240 V indicator lamp
2 Volt symbol
3 Ampere symbol
4 Interior temperature button
5 Digital display
6 External temperature button
7 Water tank symbol
8 Waste water tank symbol
9 Clock gauge
10 Lock
11 Reserve button
12 Tanks gauge
13 Tanks button
14 Living area battery button
15 Starter battery button
16 Symbol for starter battery and living area battery
17 Batteries gauge
18 Button for 12 V power supply (12 V main switch)
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
1112131415161718
12V
0% 0%
100% 100%
Electrical system
9
162 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
9.11.1 240 V indicator lamp
The 240 V indicator lamp (Fig. 198,1) illuminates whenever line voltage is available
at the transformer/rectifier input.
9.11.2 12 V main switch
The 12 V main switch (Fig. 198,18) switches the panel and the 12 V power supply of
the living area on and off.
Exception: Heater, safety/drainage valve, basic light (lighting in the entrance area)
and entrance step remain operational.
Switching on:
Briefly press the "12 V" button (Fig. 198,18). The 12 V living area power supply is
switched on. The "12 V" indicator lights up.
Switching off:
Briefly press the "12 V" button (Fig. 198,18). The 12 V living area power supply is
switched off. The "12 V" indicator goes out.
Activating battery
disconnection (transformer/
rectifier without battery cut-off
switch):
Switch off 12 V power supply.
Press button for living area battery (Fig. 198,14) and hold it down for approx.
10 seconds. The "V" volt (Fig. 198,2) and "A" ampere (Fig. 198,3) symbols flash
three times. The living area battery is disconnected from the 12 V power supply.
Deactivating battery
disconnection (transformer/
rectifier without battery cut-off
switch):
Press the "12 V" button (Fig. 198,18) and hold it down for approx. 5 seconds. The
"V" volt symbol (Fig. 198,2) flashes three times. The living area battery is con-
nected to the 12 V power supply. The indicator lights up after approx.
2 seconds.
9.11.3 Batteries gauge
The voltage and charging/discharging of the living area battery or the starter bat-
tery voltage can be indicated using the batteries gauge.
Displays:
Press button for living area battery " " (Fig. 198,14). The "V" volt symbol
(Fig. 198,2) lights up. Depending on whether the battery is being charged or
discharged, the "A" ampere symbol lights up white or red respectively. The bat-
tery voltage and current of the living area battery are displayed using the LEDs
in the gauge.
Press button for starter battery " " (Fig. 198,15). The "V" volt symbol
(Fig. 198,2) lights up. The battery voltage of the starter battery is displayed
using the LEDs in the gauge.
Z If, after switching on, the "11.0" LED of the volt indicator and the "V" volt symbol
(Fig. 198,2) in the batteries gauge (Fig. 198,17) flash, the voltage of the living
area battery is too low. Charge battery.
Z If, after switching on, the "12 V" indicator, the symbol for the living area battery
(Fig. 198,16) and the "V" volt symbol (Fig. 198,2) flash three times, battery sepa-
ration is activated. Deactivate battery separation.
Z When leaving the vehicle, switch off the 12 V main switch. This prevents any
unnecessary discharge of the living area battery.
Z Appliances such as the safety/drainage valve, charger, solar charge regulator
and panel consume approx. 20 mA to 65 mA of electricity from the battery
capacity, even when the 12 V main switch is turned off. Therefore disconnect
the living area battery from the 12 V power supply, if the vehicle will not be used
for a long period of time.
Electrical system
9
163Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
The tables below will help you interpret the statuses displayed on the panel.
Volt indicator (blue)
1 LED 2 LEDs 3 LEDs 4 LEDs 5 LEDs 6 LEDs 7 LEDs 8 LEDs
< 11.0 V 11.5 V 12.0 V 12.2 V 12.5 V 12.7 V 13.0 V > 13.5 V
Battery voltage
(values during op-
eration)
Mobile operation
(vehicle moving,
no 240 V connec-
tion)
Battery operation
(vehicle station-
ary, no 240 V con-
nection)
Power operation
(vehicle station-
ary, 240 V connec-
tion)
Danger of total
discharge (battery
alarm)
11 V or less
1)
1)
The battery guard switches all the appliances off (at 10.5 V).
12 V power supply
overload
If appliances are
switched off: Bat-
tery flat
If appliances are
switched on: Bat-
tery overload
12 V power supply
overload
The battery is not
charged by the al-
ternator, the alter-
nator's regulator is
defective
The battery is not
charged by the
transformer/rectifi-
er, the transformer/
rectifier is defective
11.5 V to 13 V 12 V power supply
overload
2)
2)
If the voltage does not exceed this range for several hours.
Normal range 12 V power supply
overload
2)
The battery is not
charged by the al-
ternator, the alter-
nator's regulator is
defective
The battery is not
charged by the
transformer/rectifi-
er, the transformer/
rectifier is defective
Over 13.5 V Battery is being
charged (main
charge)
Occurs only briefly
after charging
Battery is being
charged (main
charge)
Values for off-load voltage Charging condition of the battery
Less than 11 V Totally discharged
12.0 V 0 % (discharged)
12.2 V 25 %
12.3 V 50 %
12.5 V 75 %
More than 12.8 V Full
Z Total discharge causes irreparable damage to the battery.
Electrical system
9
164 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
9.11.4 Tank gauge
The water and waste water quantities can be indicated using the tank gauge.
Displays:
Press tanks button " " (Fig. 198,13). The water tank " " (Fig. 198,7) and
waste water tank " " (Fig. 198,8) symbols light up. The fill level of the water
tank (left-hand scale) and the waste water tank (right-hand scale) are indicated
using the LEDs in the gauge.
The table below will help you interpret the levels displayed on the panel.
9.11.5 Alarms
Battery alarm The "V" volt symbol (Fig. 198,2) and the "11.0" LED flash as soon as the battery
voltage falls below 11 V (measured during operation) and there is the threat of a
total discharge.
Measures:
When the battery alarm comes on, switch off the appliances and charge the bat-
tery, either by mobile operation or by connection to a 240 V power supply.
Ampere indicator (blue)
1 LED 2 LEDs 3 LEDs 4 LEDs 5 LEDs 6 LEDs 7 LEDs 8 LEDs
Discharging with: Charging with:
> 30 A > 10 A > 3 A > 1 A Ap-
prox.
0 A
> 1 A > 3 A > 10 A
Current displayed System status "A" ampere symbol
-30 A to -10 A Battery is being heavily dis-
charged
Lights up red
-10 A to -1 A Battery is being discharged Lights up white
0 A Battery current is low or
0 A
Lights up white
+1 A to +10 A Battery being charged Lights up white
Level indicator (blue)
1 LED 2 LEDs 3 LEDs 4 LEDs 5 LEDs 6 LEDs 7 LEDs 8 LEDs
25 % 50 % 75 % 100 %
Z The alarm functions are only active when the corresponding display is called up.
Perform checks regularly.
Z It is best to perform checks in the morning, before the 12 V appliances are
switched on.
Z Total discharge damages the battery.
Z If the battery voltage falls below 10.5 V, the battery monitor in the transformer/
rectifier switches off all of the 12 V appliances, excluding the safety/drainage
valve.
Electrical system
9
165Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Tank alarm
The water tank symbol " " (Fig. 198,7) or waste water tank symbol " "
(Fig. 198,8) flashes when the water tank is empty or the waste water tank is full.
Measures:
Fill water tank or empty waste water tank.
9.11.6 Temperature display
The internal and external temperatures can be indicated using the digital display
(Fig. 198,5).
Displays:
Press internal temperature button " " (Fig. 198,4). The internal temperature
is displayed.
Press external temperature button " " (Fig. 198,6). The external tempera-
ture is displayed.
9.11.7 Clock gauge
The clock gauge (Fig. 198,9) displays the time. The clock has its own battery and is
not connected to the 12 V power supply.
Detach the clock if the battery needs to be replaced or the clock needs to be set.
Detaching clock:
Turn lock (Fig. 198,10) one quarter turn. The lock is released.
Detach clock by pulling forwards.
Fitting clock:
Install clock.
Lightly press lock (Fig. 198,10) and turn a quarter turn.
Check lock by lightly pulling on the clock.
9.11.8 Switch for tank heater
The tank heater can be turned on and off using the "Res" button (Fig. 198,11).
Switching on:
Press "Res" reserve button (Fig. 198,11). The "Res" symbol lights up.
Switching off:
Press "Res" reserve button (Fig. 198,11). The "Res" symbol goes out.
Z If, when the fill levels are called up, the LEDs in the scale flash in addition to the
tank symbol, a sensor error has occurred. Clean tank sensors.
Z The switch status is saved when the 12 V power supply is switched off. This
means: If the tank heater was on when the 12 V power supply was switched off,
the heater is also switched on when the 12 V power supply is switched back on.
Electrical system
9
166 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
9.12 240 V power supply
The 240 V power supply provides electricity for:
z sockets with earth contact for appliances with maximum 16 A
z refrigerator
z transformer/rectifier
z air conditioning unit
The electrical appliances connected to the 12 V power supply of the living area are
supplied with voltage by the living area battery.
Connect the vehicle to an external 240 V power supply system as often as possible.
The charger module in the transformer/rectifier automatically charges the living
area battery. In addition to this, the starter battery is charged with a float charge.
9.12.1 240 V connection
The vehicle can be connected to an external 240 V power supply. The cable may
have a length of maximum 25 m.
9.12.2 Power cable for external 240 V connection
Power cable
z Three-core (3 x 2.5 mm
2
) flexible rubber sheathed cable
z Maximum 25 m in length
z 1 plug with earth contact
z 1 socket with earth contact (plug-in devices according to EN 60309)
X Only allow qualified personnel to work on the electrical system.
X The external 240 V power supply must be protected by fuse with a fault cur-
rent protection switch (FI-switches, 30 mA).
Z For the connection points on camp sites (camping distributors) highly sensitive
fault current protection switches (FI-switches, 30 mA) are obligatory.
X Completely unwind the cable on cable drums to prevent overheating. Fire
hazard!
Electrical system
9
167Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Connection possibilities For your power cable, we recommend using a CEE connection cable with a CEE
plug and coupling. If this type of connection is not feasible, we recommend the fol-
lowing combination with a safety plug:
z Adapter cable:
CEE 17 socket with earth contact (Fig. 199,1) – plug with earth contact
(Fig. 199,2)
z Cable reel:
Socket with earth contact (Fig. 199,3) – plug with earth contact (Fig. 199,4)
z Adapter cable:
CEE 17 socket with earth contact (Fig. 199,5) – plug with earth contact
(Fig. 199,6)
Depending on the design, the flap for the 240 V connection is designated with the
symbol " ".
Connecting the power cable: Open external flap.
Depending on the design, tilt the cover upwards.
Insert connector.
Fig. 199 Connection possibilities 240 V
connection
Fig. 200 Connecting an angled connector
with socket
X When using a CEE 17 angled connector with rear socket (Fig. 200,1) only use
a rubberised and sealed IP 44 socket with earth contact (Fig. 200,2). Do not
use sockets without earth contact (Fig. 200,3). Danger of electrocution!
Z Depending on the design, disconnect the connector before removing it.
Electrical system
9
168 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
9.13 Fuses
9.13.1 12 V fuses
The appliances connected to the 12 V power supply in the living area are fused indi-
vidually. The fuses are accessible at different positions in the vehicle.
An intact 12 V fuse can be detected by the unbroken fuse element (Fig. 201,1). If the
fuse element is broken (Fig. 201,2), change the fuse.
Fuses for the starter battery The fuses are located near the starter battery or near the transformer/rectifier.
For vehicles on a Fiat chassis, the fuses are installed near the transformer/rectifier
in the console of the driver's seat.
Fuses on the living area
battery
The fuses are located near the living area battery or in the driver's cabin in front of
the driver's seat.
For vehicles on a Fiat chassis, the fuses are installed in the console of the front pas-
senger's seat.
X Only replace defective fuses when the cause of the defect is known and has
been remedied.
X Only replace defective fuses when the power supply is switched off. Danger
of electrocution!
X Never bridge or repair fuses. Fire hazard!
Z Before changing the fuses, check the rating and colour of the fuses in question.
When changing fuses, use only fuses with the same ratings as the fuses fitted at
the factory.
Fig. 201 12 V fuse
1 Unbroken fuse element
2 Broken fuse element
Electrical system
9
169Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Fuse for the Thetford toilet
(swivel toilet)
The fuse is located in the locker wall of the Thetford cassette.
Changing:
Open the flap for the Thetford cassette on the outside of the vehicle.
Pull out the Thetford cassette completely.
Replace fuse (Fig. 202,1 or Fig. 203,1 ).
Fuse for the Thetford toilet
(fixed seat)
The fuse is located in the locker wall of the Thetford cassette.
Changing:
Open the flap for the Thetford cassette on the outside of the vehicle.
Remove the Thetford cassette and swing out the flap in the housing panel.
Replace fuse (Fig. 204,1).
Fig. 202 Fuse for the Thetford toilet
1Flat fuse 3 A/purple
Fig. 203 Fuse for the Thetford toilet (alter-
native)
Fig. 204 Fuse for the Thetford toilet
1 Flat fuse 3 A/purple
Electrical system
9
170 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Fuse for the Dometic toilet The fuse is located on the rear side of the control unit for the toilet.
Changing:
Lift the control unit for the toilet (Fig. 205,1) with a suitable tool and pull it from
the wall.
Replace fuse (Fig. 205,2).
9.13.2 240 V fuse
The number of automatic circuit breakers may differ depending on the model and
optional devices.
The 240 V connection is protected by one or several two-pole automatic circuit
breakers (Fig. 206).
Position The automatic circuit breaker is located in the wardrobe, in the rear garage, or
under a cover in the rear area (under the slatted frame), depending on the model.
Fig. 205 Fuse for toilet
1 Control unit
2 Flat fuse 7.5 A/brown
1
2
Fig. 206 240 V automatic circuit breaker
Appliances
10
171Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
10Appliances
Chapter overview
This chapter contains instructions regarding the appliances of the vehicle.
The instructions refer exclusively to the operation of the appliances.
Further information about the appliances can be found in the instruction manuals
for the appliances, included separately with the vehicle.
The instructions address the following topics:
z heater
z air conditioning unit
z boiler
z gas cooker
z gas oven
z microwave oven
z extractor hood
z refrigerator
z air conditioning unit
z vacuum cleaner
10.1 General
The heater, boiler, cooker, refrigerator and air conditioning unit are fitted
depending on the model of the vehicle.
In this instruction manual a description is given only for the operation of the appli-
ances and their particular features.
Z The heat exchanger of the Truma hot-air heater has to be replaced after
30 years. The heat exchanger of the Alde hot-water heater has to be replaced
after 10 years. Only the manufacturer of the heater or an authorised specialist
workshop is allowed to replace the heat exchanger. The operator of the heater
must see to it that the parts are replaced.
Z The heat exchanger of the Alde hot-water heater has to be replaced after
10 years. Only the manufacturer of the heater or an authorised specialist work-
shop is allowed to replace the heat exchanger. The operator of the heater must
see to it that the parts are replaced.
Z For safety reasons, spare parts for pieces of heating appliances must corre-
spond with manufacturer's instructions and be permitted by the manufacturer
as a spare part. These spare parts may only be fitted by the manufacturer or an
authorised specialist workshop.
Z Further information can be obtained in the instruction manual for the respec-
tive appliance.
Appliances
10
172 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
To operate gas appliances, first open the regulator tap on the gas bottle and the
gas isolator tap corresponding to the appliance.
10.2 Heater
Initial start-up When lighting the heater for the first time a small amount of smoke and odour will
occur. Immediately set the operating switch of the heater to its highest position.
Open doors and windows and ventilate well. Smoke and odour will disappear by
themselves after a while.
10.2.1 Models with waste gas vent on the right-hand side of the vehicle
Fig. 207 Symbols for the gas isolator taps
1 Refrigerator
2 Cooker
3 Heater/boiler
4 Oven
X Never let gas escape unburned due to danger of explosion.
X Never run the heater in gas operation when refuelling, on ferries or in the
garage. Danger of explosion!
X Never operate the heater in gas operation in closed spaces (e.g. garages).
Danger of poisoning and suffocation!
X If the awning is put up and the heater is running in gas operation, exhaust
gases from the heater can escape into the awning area. Danger of suffoca-
tion! Make sure the area is sufficiently ventilated.
Appliances
10
173Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
10.2.2 To heat properly
Hot air distribution Several air outlet nozzles (Fig. 208) are built into the vehicle. Pipes conduct the
warm air to the air outlet nozzles. Turn the air outlet nozzles in a suitable position
so the air can escape as required. To avoid draft close the air outlet nozzles on the
dashboard and set the air distribution of the base vehicle to air circulation.
Adjusting the air outlet
nozzles
z Fully open: Full hot air stream
z Half or partially open: Reduced hot air stream
When five air outlet nozzles are completely opened, less warm air escapes through
each nozzle. However, if only three air outlet nozzles are opened, more warm air
flows out of each nozzle.
10.2.3 Hot-air heater Truma Combi
Operating modes The heater has two operating modes:
z Winter operation
z Summer operation
It is only possible to heat the vehicle in the "Winter" operating mode. With the
"Summer" operating mode only water in the boiler is heated. It is not possible to
heat the vehicle in this operating mode.
Fig. 208 Air outlet nozzle
Z If the heater is not in operation when there is risk of frost, empty the entire
heating system.
Z Do not use the space above and behind the heater as a storage compartment.
Fig. 209 Operating unit for heater/boiler
1 Temperature control knob
2 Summer operation water temperature
40 °C or 60 °C
3 Rotary switch
4 Off
5 Winter operation "Heater without
boiler"
6 Winter operation "Heater and boiler"
7 Indicator lamp green:
Lit = "Heater in operation"
Flashing = "After-running for
temperature-reduction of the device is
active"
8 Indicator lamp yellow/red:
Lit yellow = "Boiler heating-up phase"
Flashing/lit red = "Fault"
1
2
3
4
5
Combi
2
3
4
5
6
78
1
Appliances
10
174 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Selecting operating mode: Set the operating mode using the rotary switch (Fig. 209,3).
The power supply of the heater cannot be interrupted by means of the 12 V main
switch.
Winter operation The heater selects the necessary burner setting according to the set heating level.
In the "Heater and boiler" (Fig. 209,6) operating mode, the water in the boiler is also
heated. The heater can be operated with an empty boiler in the "Heater without
boiler" (Fig. 209,5) operating mode.
Switching on:
Open the regulator tap on the gas bottle and the gas isolator tap "Heater/
boiler".
Turn the temperature control knob (Fig. 209,1) on the operating unit to the
desired heating level.
Set the rotary switch (Fig. 209,3) to winter operation "Heater without boiler"
(Fig. 209,5) or to winter mode "Heater and boiler" (Fig. 209,6).
The green indicator lamp (Fig. 209,7) lights up.
The circulation fan automatically switches on when the heater is activated.
Switching off: Set the rotary switch (Fig. 209,3) to " " (Fig. 209,4).
Close the gas isolator tap "Heater/Boiler" and the main regulator tap on the gas
bottle.
After switching off the heater, the circulation fan may still run for a moment to use
up the residual heat.
Summer operation It is not possible to heat the vehicle in the "Summer" operating mode. In this oper-
ating mode, only water in the boiler is heated.
Variant: Heater with gas
and 240 V electrical
operation
Z Further information can be obtained from the separate instruction manual "Gas
heater".
Z For further information about the use of the boiler see Section "Boiler".
Z 240 V electrical operation is only possible when the vehicle is connected to the
240 V power supply.
Z Select the output level for 240 V electrical operation so that it corresponds to
the fuse protection of the 240 V connection (900 W for 3.9 A fuse, 1800 W for
7.8 A fuse).
Z When the heater on the operating unit is set to summer operation and the
energy selector switch is set to mixed operation, the heater still runs only in
240 V operation. The gas burner is not switched on.
Appliances
10
175Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
The heater can be operated with different types of energy:
z Gas operation (Fig. 210,3)
z 240 V electrical operation with the output levels 900 W (Fig. 210,2) or 1800 W
(Fig. 210,1)
z Gas and 240 V electrical operation (mixed operation) with the output levels
900 W (Fig. 210,4) or 1800 W (Fig. 210,5)
The combination gas operation and 240 V electrical operation reduces the heating-
up time (only possible when the heater on the operating unit (Fig. 209) is set to
winter operation).
When 240 V electrical operation is selected, the yellow indicator lamp illuminates
(Fig. 210,6).
10.2.4 Alde hot-water heater
The hot-water heater has been fitted below in the wardrobe.
Fig. 210 Energy selector switch for
heater/boiler
1 240 V electrical operation (1800 W)
2 240 V electrical operation (900 W)
3 Gas operation
4 Gas and 240 V electrical operation
(900 W)
5 Gas and 240 V electrical operation
(1800 W)
6 Yellow indicator lamp "240 V electrical
operation"
Z Further information can be obtained from the separate "Gas heater" instruction
manual.
Z For further information about the use of the boiler see section "Boiler".
Z Never run hot-water heater without heating fluid. Observe notes in chapter 13.
Z Never drill holes in the floor. This might damage the hot-water pipes.
Z Do not use the space above and behind the heater as a storage compartment.
Z Do not block storage areas by loading them completely since otherwise con-
vection is no longer possible for the radiators. The heating air distribution is
reduced.
Z The circulating pump must always be turned on when the hot-water heater is
in operation.
Z We recommend to bleed the heating system after the initial heater operation
and to check the glycol content. Observe notes in chapter 13.
Z When the heater is turned on, it starts with the last settings used.
Z For further information, see the separate manufacturer's instruction manual
and observe the maintenance instructions found in chapter 13.
Z For further information about the use of the boiler see section "Boiler".
Appliances
10
176 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Operating unit The operating unit is divided into two sections:
z Display (touch screen)
z Control buttons
Control buttons The control buttons have the following functions:
Display The display (Fig. 211,1) is designed as a touch screen. Touching the symbols calls
up the relevant function.
Start screen The Start screen appears on the display after the heater is switched on. The Start
screen contains the following information:
Fig. 211 Operating unit for hot-water
heater
1 Display (touch screen)
2 "Menu" button
3 On/Off button
Z When no button is pressed, the operating unit automatically switches to home
position after two minutes.
Z Changes to the settings are saved automatically after 10 seconds.
Pos. in
Fig. 211
Button Function
2 MENU Open adjustment menu
3
Activate heating
Symbol Signification
This symbol appears when the circulating pump is activated
This symbol appears when a switching facility for gas cylinders is ac-
tivated
This symbol appears when a voltage of 240 V is present at the heater
The internal temperature is displayed next to this symbol
The external temperature is displayed next to this symbol if an exter-
nal sensor is fitted
Appliances
10
177Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Adjustment menu The "MENU" button calls up the adjustment menu. The meanings of the individual
symbols are described in the following table.
The values can be increased or reduced via the "+" or "-" symbols.
Resetting the heating to the
factory setting:
Keep the "MENU" button pressed for 15 seconds.
Tool menus The various heater functions can be called up and adjusted via the tool menus. The
arrow symbols are used to change between the menus. The meanings of the indi-
vidual symbols are described in the manufacturer's instruction manual.
Setting the pump speed:
Press the "MENU" button.
Press the " " symbol.
Press the " " symbol.
Page downward using the arrow.
Press the " " symbol.
Press the "+" button until the desired level has been reached.
Use the "OK" button to confirm the entry.
Selecting the operating
mode
The hot-water heater can be operated with the following energy sources:
z Gas operation
z 240 V electrical operation
z Gas and 240 V electrical operation
The operating mode is selected from the operating unit.
Selecting gas operation:
Press the "On" button next to the " " symbol. The gas operation is activated.
Selecting 240 V electrical
operation:
Press the "+" button next to the " " symbol until the desired heat output is
reached.
Symbol Signification
Set the desired temperature of +5 °C to +30 °C
Set the water temperature in the boiler
Set the heat output in electrical operation
Activate the function "Heating in gas operation"
Call up the enabling menu for the tool menus
Z Select the output level during 240 V electrical operation in such a way that it
corresponds to the 240 V connection protection:
Level 1 (1050 W) at 6 A
Level 2 (2100 W) at 10 A
Level 3 (3150 W) at 16 A
Appliances
10
178 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Selecting gas and 240 V
electrical operation:
Select gas operation and 240 V electrical operation on the operating unit.
When the heater is turned on, it starts with the last set operating mode.
Switching on the heater:
Press " " button. The Start screen appears in the display. The heater starts
automatically.
Switching the heater off:
Press " " button. The heater is turned off.
Switch for water pump The switch for the water pump is located under the driver's seat.
Switching on:
Press the upper part of the rocker switch: The water pump is switched on.
Switching off:
Press the lower part of the rocker switch " ": The water pump is switched
off.
Alde heat exchanger
The heat exchanger can be used to heat the living area of the vehicle during travel
without operating the hot-water heater in the living area.
The heat exchanger is connected to the vehicle engine's cooling circuit and thus
has the same function as the vehicle heater.
Heat output is set with the living area's heating regulator.
The heat exchanger stopcock is located directly on the exchanger.
Turning on:
Set stopcock handle (Fig. 212,1) parallel to the pipe.
Z If gas and 240 V electrical operation is selected and if the vehicle is connected
to the 240 V power supply, then the hot-water heater at first only operates in
240 V electric operation. Only if the heat output is insufficient does the gas oper-
ation also automatically switch on.
Z The gas operation is only possible when the regulator tap on the gas bottle and
the gas isolator tap are opened.
Z 240 V electrical operation is only possible when the vehicle is connected to the
240 V power supply.
Z Switching on and off applies only for IVECO vehicles.
Z The heat exchanger only works when the vehicle engine is running.
Z If the heat exchanger is not being used (as in the summer), the heat exchanger
on the stopcock should be shut off.
Fig. 212 Alde heat exchanger
Appliances
10
179Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Shutting off: Set drain cock handle (Fig. 212,1) at a right angle to the pipe.
Alde auxiliary circulating
pump
The auxiliary circulating pump (Fig. 213,1) can be used to heat the vehicle engine
when parked.
The auxiliary circulating pump is connected to the vehicle engine's cooling circuit
and thus functions as an engine heater.
The auxiliary circulating pump switch (Fig. 214,2) is located next to the hot-water
heater operating unit. The yellow indicator lamp (Fig. 214,1) illuminates when the
pump is operated.
Setting the rotational speed
of the circulating pump
Setting the output:
Set the adjusting screw at the pump to Level 2.
To ventilate the pump set the adjusting screw to Level 5.
240 V circulating pump Depending on the equipment, the hot-water heater has an additional 240 V circu-
lating pump.
If the vehicle is connected to the 240 V power supply, then it is possible to switch
to the higher output of the 240 V circulating pump.
The switch for switching between the 12 V circulating pump and the 240 V circu-
lating pump is located on the hot-water heater operating unit.
10.2.5 Diesel heater Webasto
Depending on the model, the vehicle is fitted with a diesel heater.
Z The auxiliary circulating pump works only if the heat exchanger has been
installed and started, and the hot-water heater is running.
Fig. 213 Auxiliary circulating pump Fig. 214 Operating switch for auxiliary cir-
culating pump
Z Level 2 = Normal level
Z Level 5 = Ventilation
Z A slight odour may occur the first few times when you use a new heater.
Z In the case of continuous operation at low output levels, we recommend that
the heater be operated at full load for 15 minutes once a month in order to burn
any deposits in the burner.
Appliances
10
180 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Operating modes The heater has three operating modes:
z Summer operation
z Winter operation, heating without water heating
z Winter operation, heating with water heating
It is only possible to heat the vehicle in the "Winter" operating mode. With the
"Summer" operating mode only water in the boiler is heated. It is not possible to
heat the vehicle in this operating mode.
Summer operation (only
hot water)
The heater is used to provide hot drinking water. The water is heated and kept at
temperatures of 40 °C or 70 °C. The hot air fan for heating the interior is not acti-
vated. If the water temperature drops below a specific value, combustion is started
again. The indicator (Fig. 215,7) at the operating control lights up green as long as
the unit is switched on.
Switching on:
Set the mode selector (Fig. 215,9) to Summer operation, water temperature
40 °C (Fig. 215,2) or 70 °C (Fig. 215,3).
The output indicator (Fig. 215,7) lights up green and the display at the mode
selector (Fig. 215,9) lights up red.
Z Interior heating and/or hot water heating while travelling is possible and per-
mitted.
Z When travelling under cold ambient conditions the diesel heating has to be
operated in the "Winter operation, heating with water heating" mode in order
to protect the water lines against frost.
Z If there is any risk of frost, always empty the boiler.
Z For further information about the use of the boiler see Section "Boiler".
Z Further information can be obtained in the manufacturer's instruction manual.
Fig. 215 Webasto diesel heater panel
1 Off
2 Summer operation, water temperature 40°
3 Summer operation, water temperature 70°
4 Winter operation, heating without water heating
5 Winter operation, heating with water heating
6 Interior temperature selector
7 Output indicator / fault indicator (green/red)
8 Frost protection mode
9 Mode selector
10 Boiler draining
70°C
40°C
SUMMER
WINTER
OFF
ON / STATUS
1
2 3 4 5 6
7
10 8
9
Z The boiler has to be filled with water.
Appliances
10
181Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Switching off: Set the mode selector (Fig. 215,9) to "Off" (Fig. 215,1).
Winter operation (heating
without water heating)
The desired interior temperature can be set at the temperature selector (5 to 35 °C).
When the selected interior temperature has been reached, the heater regulates to
this value.
Switching on:
Set the interior temperature selector (Fig. 215,6) to the desired thermostat set-
ting for the interior temperature.
Set the mode selector (Fig. 215,9) to Winter operation, heating without water
heating (Fig. 215,4).
The output indicator (Fig. 215,7) lights up green and the displays at the mode
selector (Fig. 215,9) and interior temperature selector light up red.
Switching off: Set the mode selector (Fig. 215,9) to "Off" (Fig. 215,1).
Winter operation (heating
with water heating)
The heater is used to heat the interior and to provide hot drinking water. The
output is reduced step-by-step by the heater until the interior temperature has
been reached. If the interior temperature has been reached, but the water temper-
ature is still too low, the main fan switches off and the water is heated further until
the temperature of 70 °C has been reached.
Switching on: Set the interior temperature selector (Fig. 215,6) to the desired thermostat set-
ting for the interior temperature.
Set the mode selector (Fig. 215,9) to Winter operation, heating with water
heating (Fig. 215,4).
The output indicator (Fig. 215,7) lights up green and the displays at the mode
selector (Fig. 215,9) and interior temperature selector light up red.
Switching off:
Set the mode selector (Fig. 215,9) to "Off" (Fig. 215,1).
Monitor function: No water If the boiler does not contain any water and Winter operation, heating with water
heating is selected, a warning is emitted at the operating element. The green LED
next to Winter operation, heating with water heating (Fig. 215,4) begins to flash.
Set the mode selector (Fig. 215,9) to Winter operation, heating without water
heating (Fig. 215,4).
If necessary, fill water into the boiler.
Z If the boiler is filled, the water is also heated automatically.
Z Depending on the heater output and duration, the water can reach a tempera-
ture of 80 °C.
Z The boiler has to be filled with water.
Z Depending on the heater output and duration, the water can reach a tempera-
ture of 80 °C.
Appliances
10
182 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
10.2.6 Arizona auxiliary heat exchanger
The auxiliary heat exchanger is built into the bench seat.
The auxiliary heat exchanger may be used to provide the vehicle's living area with
additional heat during the journey.
The auxiliary heat exchanger is integrated into the heat circulation of the base
vehicle and is therefore only in operation when the vehicle engine is running.
Switching on:
Turn the control knob (Fig. 216,1) of the flow control to the desired position. The
water circulation is open.
Turn the fan switch (Fig. 216,2) for the circulation fan in a clockwise direction.
Switching off:
Turn the fan switch (Fig. 216,2) to " ".
Turn the control knob (Fig. 216,1) of the flow control to its initial position.
X Do not operate the auxiliary heat exchanger at petrol stations. Danger of
explosion!
Z The fan on the auxiliary heat exchanger can be used for ventilation.
Z The heat output is continuously adjusted.
Fig. 216 Operating controls for auxiliary
heat exchanger
1
2
Appliances
10
183Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
10.2.7 Independent vehicle heater
The inside and the engine can be heated with the independent vehicle heater. The
heating of the engine can be switched off.
The independent vehicle heater can be turned on and off manually or with a timer.
The time for the heating to start can be exactly preselected from 1 minute to
24 hours. It is possible to program three switching on times, of which only one can
be activated. The maximum permitted operation time is 60 minutes.
Switching on manually:
Press the button (Fig. 217,7). The heating mode is displayed by the symbol
(Fig. 217,9). The fan will only be switched on when there is a coolant tempera-
ture of 30 °C.
Switching off manually:
Press the button (Fig. 217,7). The symbol (Fig. 217,9) goes off.
Switching on the engine
heating:
Press the lower part of the switch (Fig. 217,4). Engine is preheated. The fan is
switched on immediately.
Switching off the engine
heating:
Press the upper part of the switch (Fig. 217,4). Engine stays cold.
Setting the time:
Press the button (Fig. 217,2). The time setting is displayed by the symbol
(Fig. 217,8).
Set the time with the buttons (Fig. 217,3 and 6).
Programming heating start:
Press the button (Fig. 217,5).
Set the switching on time within ten seconds, with the buttons (Fig. 217,3 and
6).
Selecting programmed
switching on time:
Keep pressing button (Fig. 217,5) until the selected programme number
(Fig. 217,1) appears in the display.
X Do not operate the independent vehicle heater in closed spaces. Danger of
suffocation!
X Do not operate the independent vehicle heater at petrol stations. Danger of
explosion!
Fig. 217 Operating unit for independent
vehicle heater
Appliances
10
184 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
10.2.8 Heater for waste water tank and waste water pipes (winter
comfort package)
In order to prevent waste water fittings freezing up, the waste water tank and the
waste water pipes can be electrically heated.
When the heater is turned on, temperature sensors monitor the temperature of the
waste water tank and the waste water pipes. If the temperature falls below 5 °C, the
heating elements are switched on and the waste water tank and waste water pipes
are heated. If the temperature rises above a certain level, the heating elements are
switched off again.
The control unit (Fig. 218) is installed in the wardrobe. The control lamps on the
control unit have the following meanings:
z The indicator lamp (Fig. 218,2) lights up in green: Regulation in operation.
z Indicator lamp (Fig. 218,1) lights up in red: Waste water tank is heated.
z Indicator lamp (Fig. 218,3) lights up in red: Waste water pipes are heated.
To turn it on and off, use the reserve switch for the waste water tank heater on the
panel.
Z Take the battery consumption into account! Operation of the heating for the
waste water and waste water pipes is only possible to a limited extent without
an external power supply.
Fig. 218 Control unit
HORN
1 2 3
Appliances
10
185Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
10.2.9 Electrical floor warming unit
The regulator for the electrical floor warming unit is located in the wardrobe.
Operating levels The electrical floor warming unit has four operating levels:
z 0 "Off"
z 20 V "Low heating level"
z 22 V "Medium heating level"
z 24 V "High heating level"
Switching on: Connect the vehicle to the 240 V power supply (see section 9.12.1).
Turn the control knob (Fig. 219,2) to the required heating level.
Switching off:
Turn control knob (Fig. 219,2) to "0" position.
After switching off, the floor remains warm for a while, due to residual heat.
If the regulator is overloaded, the overload protection is actuated. The pin
(Fig. 219,1) jumps out.
Switching on overload
protection:
Press the pin (Fig. 219,1) on the overload protection when the regulator is
cooled.
X On models with electrical floor warming unit, never drill holes in the floor or
screw in any screws. Careful with sharp objects. There is danger of a power
cut or a short circuit due to damage to a heater wire.
Z Do not cover the regulator. Danger of overheating!
Z The electrical floor warming unit only operates if the vehicle is connected to the
240 V power supply.
Z The output of the electrical floor warming unit alone is not sufficient to heat the
living area.
Fig. 219 Regulator for electrical floor
warming unit
1
2
Appliances
10
186 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
10.3 Air conditioning unit
10.3.1 Air conditioning unit Truma
The remote control (Fig. 221) and the receiver (Fig. 220) for the air conditioning
unit are located in the kitchen area.
To execute the individual switching commands, always point the remote control in
the direction of the receiver.
Switching on:
Connect the vehicle to the 240 V power supply. The air conditioning unit is
ready to operate.
Switch on the remote control with the switch (Fig. 221,7). The green indicator
lamp (Fig. 220,1) indicates cooling mode.
Set the desired operating mode with the key (Fig. 221,8).
z "FAN": Only ventilation without cooling.
z "COMFORT": Cooling. The fan output and the room temperature can be set
separately. The green indicator lamp in the receiver indicates the com-
pressor is in operation and therefore cooling mode.
Set the desired fan output and room temperature with the keys (Fig. 221,3 and
4) if necessary. The arrow (Fig. 221,9) indicates the selected setting mode.
If the temperature set on the remote control is reached, the green indicator lamp
goes out, the compressor is switched off and the circulation fan continues to run.
Z The air conditioning unit is only installed in vehicles with a double floor.
Z The air conditioning unit only runs if the vehicle is connected to a 240 V power
supply.
Z The external 240 V power supply must be protected by a fuse of at least 3 A. It is
otherwise not possible to operate the air conditioning unit properly.
Fig. 220 Receiver Fig. 221 Remote control
Z An additional key switch (Fig. 220,2) is on the receiver, which can be used to
switch the air conditioning unit off or on without remote control. If the air con-
ditioning unit is switched on by means of this key switch, the operating mode
set last on the remote control is automatically selected.
Appliances
10
187Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Switching off: To switch off, press the key (Fig. 221,7) on the remote control again.
Timer The air conditioning unit can be switched on or off automatically from the current
time up to 15 hours in advance with the integrated timer. Pre-programming up to
a certain time is not possible.
To program, switch on the air conditioning unit with the key (Fig. 221,7) on the
remote control.
Set the desired operating mode and room temperature with the keys
(Fig. 221,8, 3 and 4).
Use the key (Fig. 221,5) to select the desired function (Fig. 221,1):
z "ON": Switching on
z "OFF": Switching off
Use the keys (Fig. 221,4) to select the desired switching time (1 to 15 hours). The
arrow (Fig. 221,2) flashes and indicates the setting mode.
If "ON" (switch on) was selected, the air conditioning unit must be switched off
again with the remote control after the setting process. The indicator lamp in
the receiver flashes and confirms the programming.
The indicator lamp in the receiver flashes and confirms the programming if
"OFF" (switch off) was selected. Do not switch off the air conditioning unit with
the remote control.
Z Condensation arises at the evaporator during cooling operation.
Position the vehicle so that it is horizontal. This allows any water which has con-
densated to drain. Observe the separate instruction manual for the air condi-
tioning unit.
Z To counteract possible germ formation in the condensation, operate the air
conditioning unit approx. 5 to 10 minutes in the positions "FAN" and "HIGH" to
dry the evaporator.
Z To go easy on the batteries in the remote control, the infrared transmitter can
be covered by hand and the remote control then switched off after the "OFF"
programming. In this way no signal is transferred to the receiver and the pro-
gramming is retained.
Z The key (Fig. 221,6) is used to send the settings of the remote control repeatedly
to the receiver.
Z Further information can be obtained in the manufacturer's instruction manual.
Appliances
10
188 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
10.3.2 Air conditioning unit (Teleco)
The air conditioning unit is located on the roof of the vehicle. The remote control
(Fig. 224) for the air conditioning unit is located in the kitchen area.
Switching on:
Connect the vehicle to the 240 V power supply. The air conditioning unit is
ready to operate. The red LED (Fig. 223,2) lights up.
Switch on the remote control at the switch (Fig. 224,5).
Set the desired operating mode using the button (Fig. 224,1).
The green indicator lamp (Fig. 223,3) indicates cooling operation, the red indi-
cator lamp (Fig. 223,4) heating operation.
z "COOLING"
z "AUTOMATIC"
z "HEATING"
If necessary, use the buttons (Fig. 224,3 and 4) to set the desired fan output and
room temperature.
Switching off:
To switch off press the button (Fig. 224,5) on the remote control again.
Fig. 222 Roof view Fig. 223 Interior view
Fig. 224 Remote control
1
2
3
4
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
Appliances
10
189Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
10.4 Boiler
10.4.1 Models with waste gas vent on the right-hand side of the vehicle
10.4.2 Truma Combi boiler
The boiler is integrated in the heater system and operates on gas. The boiler is
switched on by turning the rotary switch (Fig. 225,2) on the operating unit
(Fig. 225).
In winter operation "Heater and boiler" (Fig. 225,3) the water is automatically
heated up when the heater is switched on. If the heater switches off after the
required room temperature has been reached, the boiler will continue to heat up
until the set water temperature has been reached.
In summer operation (Fig. 225,1) only the water in the boiler is heated up to either
40 °C or 60 °C. The water is heated to 60 °C in approx. 25 minutes. The yellow indi-
cator lamp (Fig. 225,4) illuminates during the boiler heating-up period.
The power supply for the appliance cannot be interrupted by means of the 12 V
main switch. When there is a fault, the red indicator lamp (Fig. 225,4) on the oper-
ating unit illuminates (see Chapter 16).
X Never let gas escape unburned due to danger of explosion.
X Never run the boiler in gas operation when refuelling, on ferries or in the
garage. Danger of explosion!
X Never operate the boiler in gas operation in closed spaces (e.g. garages).
Danger of poisoning and suffocation!
X The water in the boiler can be heated up to 65 °C. Risk of scalding!
Z Never use boiler when empty.
Z If the boiler is not being used, empty it if there is any risk of frost.
Z Only operate the boiler with the maximum temperature setting if you require a
large quantity of warm water. This protects the boiler against the build-up of
limescale.
Z Dethleffs recommends that water from the boiler is not used as drinking water.
X If the awning is put up and the boiler is running in gas operation, exhaust
gases from the boiler can escape into the awning area. Danger of suffocation!
Make sure the area is sufficiently ventilated.
Fig. 225 Operating unit for heater/boiler
1 Summer operation water temperature
40 °C or 60 °C
2 Rotary switch
3 Winter operation "Heater and boiler"
4 Indicator lamp yellow/red:
Lit yellow = "Boiler heating-up phase"
Flashing/lit red = "Fault"
1
2
3
4
5
Combi
1
2
3
4
Appliances
10
190 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Safety/drainage valve The boiler is equipped with a safety/drainage valve (Fig. 226). The safety/drainage
valve prevents water in the boiler from freezing, when there is frost and the heater
is not switched on.
If there is a danger of frost (at approx. 3 °C ambient temperature), the water is
drained intermittently at overpressure via a drain neck.
The safety/drainage valve does not close again until the ambient temperature lies
within the frost-proof range (approx. 7 °C ambient temperature).
Winter operation In the "Heater and boiler" switch setting in winter operation, the boiler is already
switched on.
Summer operation In summer operation the water can be heated up to 40 °C or 60 °C.
Switching on:
Open the regulator tap on the gas bottle and the gas isolator tap "Heater/
boiler".
Set the rotary switch (Fig. 225,2) on the operating unit (Fig. 225) to "Summer
operation" (Fig. 225,1).
The yellow indicator lamp (Fig. 225,4) is lit during the heating-up phase. When the
set water temperature is reached, the period of heating up is finished and the
yellow indicator lamp fades.
Switching off:
Set the rotary switch (Fig. 225,2) on the operating unit (Fig. 225) to " ".
Close the gas isolator tap "Heater/Boiler" and the main regulator tap on the gas
bottle.
Z If the vehicle will not be used for a longer period of time, open the safety/drai-
nage valve and empty the boiler.
Z The water pump and the water fittings are not protected against freezing by the
safety/drainage valve.
Z The drainage neck (Fig. 226,3) of the safety/drainage valve has to be free of dirt
(e.g. leaves, ice) at all times.
Z The safety/drainage valve can also be opened manually.
Fig. 226 Safety/drainage valve of the
boiler - Operation position
3
Appliances
10
191Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Filling/emptying the boiler The boiler can be supplied with water from the water tank.
Filling the boiler with water:
Switch on 12 V power supply on the panel.
Close the safety/drainage valve. To do so turn the knob (Fig. 226,1) cross-wise
to the safety/drainage valve and press in the pushbutton (Fig. 226,2).
Set all the water taps to "Hot" and open them. The water pump is turned on. The
hot water pipes are filled with water.
Keep the taps open until the water flowing out of the taps has no bubbles in it.
This is the only way to ensure that the boiler is full of water.
Close all water taps.
Emptying the boiler:
Set the rotary switch (Fig. 225,2) on the operating unit (Fig. 225) to " ".
Open the safety/drainage valve. To do so turn the knob (Fig. 226,1) lengthwise
to the safety/drainage valve. The pushbutton (Fig. 226,2) jumps out. The boiler
is drained to the outside by the drainage neck (Fig. 226,3) of the safety/drainage
valve.
Check whether the water has been drained completely from the boiler (approx.
10 litres).
10.4.3 Trumatic C boiler
The boiler is integrated into the heater and is operated with gas (gas operation) or
with gas and/or electricity (gas and 240 V electrical operation). The boiler is
switched on by turning the rotary switch (Fig. 227,2) on the operating unit
(Fig. 227). The type of energy is pre-selected (gas and 240 V electrical operation)
with the energy selector switch (Fig. 229).
In winter operation "Heater and boiler" (Fig. 227,3) the water is automatically
heated up when the heater is switched on. If the heater switches off after the
required room temperature has been reached, the boiler will continue to heat up
until the set water temperature has been reached.
In summer operation (Fig. 227,1) only the water in the boiler is heated up to either
40 °C or 60 °C. The water is heated to 60 °C in approx. one hour. The yellow indicator
lamp illuminates during the boiler heating-up period.
The voltage supply for the unit and the safety/drainage valve cannot be inter-
rupted by the 12 V main switch. Depending on the model, the red indicator lamp
lights up on the operating unit for Trumatic C heater/boiler when a fault occurs (see
chapter 16).
Z Further information can be obtained from the separate instruction manual
"Boiler".
Fig. 227 Operating unit for heater/boiler
1 Summer operation water temperature
40 °C or 60 °C
2 Rotary switch
3 Winter operation "Heater and boiler"
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
1
2
3
Appliances
10
192 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Safety/drainage valve The boiler is equipped with a safety/drainage valve (Fig. 228). The safety/drainage
valve prevents water in the boiler from freezing, when there is frost and the heater
is not switched on.
If there is a danger of frost (at approx. 3 °C ambient temperature), the water is
drained intermittently at overpressure via a drain neck.
The safety/drainage valve does not close again until the ambient temperature lies
within the frost-proof range (approx. 7 °C ambient temperature).
Variant: Boiler with gas
operation
The boiler is operated exclusively with gas.
Winter operation In the "heater and boiler" switch setting in winter operation, the boiler is already
switched on.
Summer operation In summer operation the water can be heated up to 40 °C or 60 °C.
Switching on:
Open the regulator tap on the gas bottle and the gas isolator tap "Heater/
boiler".
Set the rotary switch (Fig. 227,2) on the operating unit (Fig. 227) to "Summer
operation" (Fig. 227,1).
The yellow indicator lamp is illuminated during the heating up period. When the
set water temperature is reached, the period of heating up is finished and the
yellow indicator lamp fades.
Switching off:
Set the rotary switch (Fig. 227,2) on the operating unit (Fig. 227) to " ".
Close the gas isolator tap "Heater/boiler" and the regulator tap on the gas
bottle.
Z When the safety/drainage valve is closed a small electrical power flows which
puts an extra load on the living area battery. Therefore, a daily check of the bat-
tery voltage panel is recommended. If the battery voltage drops to below 10.8 V
the function of the safety/drainage valve can no longer be guaranteed.
Z If the vehicle will not be used for a longer period of time, open the safety/drai-
nage valve and empty the boiler.
Z The water pump and the water fittings are not protected against freezing by the
safety/drainage valve.
Z The drainage neck (Fig. 228,3) of the safety/drainage valve has to be free of dirt
(e.g. leaves, ice) at all times.
Z The safety/drainage valve can also be opened manually.
Fig. 228 Safety/drainage valve of the
boiler - Operation position
3
Appliances
10
193Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Variant: Boiler with gas and
240 V electrical operation
The boiler can be operated with different types of energy:
z Gas operation (Fig. 229,3)
z 240 V electrical operation with the output levels 900 W (Fig. 229,2) or 1800 W
(Fig. 229,1)
z Gas and 240 V electrical operation (mixed operation) with the output levels
900 W (Fig. 229,4) or 1800 W (Fig. 229,5)
The combination gas operation and 240 V electrical operation reduces the heating-
up time (only possible when the boiler on the operating unit (Fig. 227) is set to
winter operation).
When 240 V electrical operation is selected, the yellow indicator lamp illuminates
(Fig. 229,6).
Filling/emptying the boiler The boiler can be supplied with water from the water tank.
Filling the boiler with water:
Switch on 12 V power supply on the panel.
Check whether the rotary switch (Fig. 228,1) is in the "Operation" position and
is latched in.
Press the pushbutton (Fig. 228,2). The drainage valve is closed.
Set all the water taps to "Hot" and open them. The water pump is turned on. The
warm water pipes are filled with water.
Keep the taps open until the water flowing out of the taps has no bubbles in it.
This is the only way to ensure that the boiler is full of water.
Close all water taps.
Z 240 V electrical operation is only possible when the vehicle is connected to the
240 V power supply.
Z Select the output level for 240 V electrical operation so that it corresponds to
the fuse protection of the 240 V connection (900 W for 3.9 A fuse, 1800 W for
7.8 A fuse).
Z When the boiler on the operating unit is set to summer operation and the
energy selector switch is set to mixed operation, the boiler still runs only in 240
V operation. The gas burner is not switched on.
Fig. 229 Energy selector switch for
heater/boiler
1 240 V electrical operation (1800 W)
2 240 V electrical operation (900 W)
3 Gas operation
4 Gas and 240 V electrical operation
(900 W)
5 Gas and 240 V electrical operation
(1800 W)
6 Yellow indicator lamp "240 V electrical
operation"
1
230V~
Trumatic C EH
ruma
2
3
4
5
6
Appliances
10
194 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Emptying the boiler: Set the rotary switch (Fig. 227,2) on the operating unit (Fig. 227) to " ".
To do so turn the rotary switch by 180° until it latches in. The pushbutton jumps
out. The boiler is drained to the outside using the drainage neck.
Check whether the water has been drained completely from the boiler
(approx. 12.5 litres).
10.4.4 Alde boiler
Safety/drainage valve The boiler is equipped with a safety/drainage valve (Fig. 230). The safety/drainage
valve prevents water in the boiler from freezing, when there is frost and the heater
is not switched on.
If there is a danger of frost (at approx. 3 °C ambient temperature), the water is
drained intermittently at overpressure via a drain neck.
The safety/drainage valve does not close again until the ambient temperature lies
within the frost-proof range (approx. 7 °C ambient temperature).
Switching the boiler on/off The boiler is integrated in the hot-water heater. A separate operation is not pos-
sible. For operating the hot-water heater, see section 10.2.4.
Z Because of the suction effect, a part of the water supply can be also drained
from the lines and the water tank. The water system is however not completely
emptied.
Z Further information can be obtained from the separate instruction manual
"Boiler".
Z When the safety/drainage valve is closed a small electrical power flows which
puts an extra load on the living area battery. Therefore, a daily check of the bat-
tery voltage panel is recommended. If the battery voltage drops to below 10.8 V
the function of the safety/drainage valve can no longer be guaranteed.
Z If the vehicle will not be used for a longer period of time, open the safety/drai-
nage valve and empty the boiler.
Z The water pump and the water fittings are not protected against freezing by the
safety/drainage valve.
Z The drainage neck (Fig. 230,3) of the safety/drainage valve has to be free of dirt
(e.g. leaves, ice) at all times.
Z The safety/drainage valve can also be opened manually.
Fig. 230 Safety/drainage valve of the
boiler - Operation position
3
Appliances
10
195Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Filling/emptying the boiler The boiler can be supplied with water from the water tank.
Filling the boiler with water:
Switch on 12 V power supply on the panel.
Check whether the rotary switch (Fig. 230,1) is in the "Operation" position and
is latched in.
Press the pushbutton (Fig. 230,2). The drainage valve is closed.
Set all the water taps to "Hot" and open them. The water pump is turned on. The
warm water pipes are filled with water.
Keep the taps open until the water flowing out of the taps has no bubbles in it.
This is the only way to ensure that the boiler is full of water.
Close all water taps.
Emptying the boiler:
Switch off boiler.
Open all water taps and set to the central position.
To do so turn the rotary switch by 180° until it latches in. The pushbutton jumps
out. The boiler is drained to the outside using the drainage neck.
Check whether the water has been drained completely from the boiler (approx.
12.5 litres).
10.4.5 Boiler Webasto
The boiler is integrated in the heater and operates on diesel fuel.
In Winter operation, heating with water preparation the water in the boiler is auto-
matically heated up as well when the heater is switched on. If the heater switches
off after the required room temperature has been reached, the boiler will continue
to heat up until the set water temperature has been reached.
In Summer operation only the water in the boiler is heated up to either 40 °C or
70 °C.
Z Further information can be obtained in the manufacturer's instruction manual.
Z For information on the operating panel see Chapter "Heater"
Z If there is any risk of frost, always empty the boiler.
Appliances
10
196 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Filling/emptying the boiler
Filling the boiler with water:
Fill the boiler with water at an ambient temperature of at least 6 °C or select
Summer operation 40 °C / 70 °C or Winter operation, heating with water
heating.
This ensures that the electrical safety/drainage valve does not open.
Set all the water taps to "Hot" and open them. The water pump is turned on. The
hot water pipes are filled with water.
Keep the taps open until the water flowing out of the taps has no bubbles in it.
This is the only way to ensure that the boiler is full of water.
Close all water taps.
Frost Various functions protect the water supply system against frost.
z If there is any risk of frost or when parking the vehicle in storage for a longer
period, drain the water manually.
z The boiler is drained automatically if you forget to drain it manually.
z If you do not want to drain the water supply system automatically when the
interior is not heated, frost protection mode can be selected.
Draining the boiler manually
Interrupting the power connection for the water pumps of the vehicle.
Open all the hot water taps in the vehicle (set mixer taps or single-lever faucets
to "hot").
Hold the mode selector (Fig. 215,9) for at least 5 seconds in the boiler draining
position (Fig. 215,10). The electrical safety/drainage valve is opened for approx.
90 minutes. During the draining process all the green symbols at the operating
element as well as the red display at the mode selector flash.
Z Fill the tank solely with drinking water and avoid soiling or dirt in the complete
water supply system.
Z Both draining the water from the boiler as well as frost protection mode protect
the heater and the boiler against frost. Due to installation variations it is not pos-
sible to protect all water lines in the vehicle against freezing. When the vehicle
is stored select a location that is well protected against low temperatures, or
drain the complete water from the system, including all lines and hoses.
Z In order to check whether the water was drained completely from the boiler,
collect the water in a vessel (approx. 10 litres).
Z Any water from the vehicle must be drained at a suitable disposal point pro-
vided to this purpose.
Z The draining process can be aborted by setting the mode selector (Fig. 215,9)
once more to boiler draining (Fig. 215,10) for at least 5 seconds and then
releasing it
Appliances
10
197Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Draining the boiler
automatically
The electrical safety/drainage valve is opened electrically. If the temperature at
the electrical safety/drainage valve lies under 6 °C, automatic draining of the
water from the boiler can be carried out.
This function is activated when:
the unit is switched off.
in Winter operation, heating without water heating, no heating operation takes
places for a certain period.
the battery output is too low.
there is a fault.
During the draining process all the green symbols at the operating element as well
as the red display at the mode selector flash.
Frost protection mode This operating mode is a safety-specific feature only for the heater. The water
circuits inside and outside of the vehicle are not protected against freezing.
The heater functions as in Winter operation, heating with water heating – how-
ever with lower air and water temperature values.
Set the mode selector (Fig. 215,9) to frost protection mode (Fig. 215,8). The
output indicator (Fig. 215,7) lights up green and the display at the mode
selector (Fig. 215,9) lights up red.
Z The 12 V power supply has to be connected.
Z The draining process can be aborted by setting the mode selector (Fig. 215,9)
once more to boiler draining (Fig. 215,10) for at least 5 seconds and then
releasing it
Z The outlet of the electrical safety/drainage valve has to be clean at all times (free
of soiling, ice, leaves, etc.).
Z If there is a risk of frost, the vehicle should be parked in a frost-proof location or
the water be drained.
Z Diesel fuel and electricity are consumed in frost-protection mode. Therefore
ensure that the tank contains sufficient diesel fuel and that the battery is
charged. Check the states regularly.
Appliances
10
198 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
10.5 Cooker
10.5.1 Gas cooker
The vehicle kitchen block is fitted with a two- or three-burner gas cooker. The
cooker is equipped with an electronic ignition depending on a model.
Depending on the model, the operating controls for the gas cooker are found on
the operating panel or directly on the gas cooker.
X Never let gas escape unburned due to danger of explosion.
X Before using the cooker make sure that there is sufficient ventilation. Open
windows or the skylight.
X Do not use gas cooker or gas oven for heating.
X Always protect your hands with cooking gloves or potholders when han-
dling hot pots, pans and similar items. There is a risk of injury.
X During activation and operation of the gas cooker, no flammable objects or
highly inflammable objects such as dishcloths, napkins etc. must be near the
gas cooker. Fire hazard!
X The process of ignition must be visible from above and must not be covered
by cooking pans placed on the cooker.
X Depending on the model, the gas cooker lid is held closed by a spring. When
closing there is danger of getting injured!
Z Do not use the glass gas cooker lid as a hob.
Z Do not close the gas cooker lid while the gas cooker is in operation.
Z Do not apply pressure on the gas cooker lid when it is closed.
Z Do not place hot cooking pans on the gas cooker lid.
Z Keep the gas cooker lid open after cooking until the burners are cool. Otherwise
the glass plate could shatter.
Z Do not place hot objects such as cooking pots on the sink cover. The plastic can
deform.
Z Only use pots and pans whose diameter is appropriate for the gas cooker
burners.
Z When the flame goes out, the thermocouple automatically cuts the gas supply.
Z Further information can be obtained from the separate instruction manual "Gas
cooker".
Appliances
10
199Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Switching on: Open the regulator tap on the gas bottle and the gas isolator tap "Cooker".
Open the gas cooker lid.
Turn the control knob (Fig. 231,1, Fig. 232,1 or Fig. 233,1) on the burner you
wish to use to the ignition position (large flame).
Press down the control knob and hold it down.
If the gas cooker disposes of automatic ignition: Spark is created automatically
when the control knob is pressed.
If an ignition button (Fig. 232,2) is present:
Create a spark by pushing the ignition button.
If an ignition button is not present:
Ignite the burner with a gas lighter, a match or with other suitable means of
lighting.
Once the flame is burning, the control knob must be held down for 10 to
15 seconds, until the thermocouple automatically keeps the gas supply open.
Release the control knob and turn to the desired setting.
If ignition is unsuccessful, repeat the entire procedure.
Switching off:
Turn the control knob to the 0-position. The flame fades.
Close the gas isolator tap "Cooker" and the regulator tap on the gas bottle.
Fig. 231 Operating controls for gas
cooker (variant 1)
Fig. 232 Operating controls for gas
cooker (variant 2)
Fig. 233 Operating controls for gas
cooker (variant 3)
Fig. 234 Operating controls for gas
cooker (variant 4)
1
1 2
OFF
OFF
OFF
LO
LO
LO
HI
LITE
HI
LITE
HI
LITE
Appliances
10
200 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
10.5.2 Gas oven (Spinflo)
Switching on: Open the regulator tap on the gas bottle and the gas isolator tap "Oven".
Fully open the oven flap (Fig. 235,3).
Lightly press control knob (Fig. 235,2) and set to " " (oven) or " " (grill).
Press the control knob (Fig. 235,2) and hold it down for 5 to 10 seconds. Gas will
stream into the burner.
Press the ignition switch (Fig. 235,1) repeatedly until there is a flame.
When the flame burns, hold the control knob down for 10 to 15 seconds, until
the thermocouple keeps the gas supply automatically open.
Release the control knob and turn to the desired setting.
Switching off:
Turn the control knob (Fig. 235,2) to " ". The flame fades.
Close the gas isolator tap "Oven" and the regulator tap on the gas bottle.
X Always keep ventilation apertures at the gas oven open.
X There must be no flammable objects near the gas oven when it is being lit.
X The oven flap must remain open when it is being lit.
X If ignition has not taken place, repeat the entire procedure. If necessary,
check if there is gas and/or current in the gas oven.
X If the gas oven still does not work, close the gas isolator tap and notify your
service centre.
X If the burner flame is accidentally extinguished, switch off the over and leave
the burner off for at least 1 minute. Only then ignite it again.
X When grilling pull out the heat protector and leave the flap completely open.
Z Before using the gas oven for the first time run it for 30 minutes at maximum
temperature without any contents.
Z When the flame fades, the thermocouple automatically cuts the gas supply.
Z Further information can be obtained from the separate instruction manual "Gas
oven".
Fig. 235 Gas oven (Spinflo)
Appliances
10
201Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
10.5.3 Gas oven (Dometic)
The oven is equipped with electronic ignition.
Switching on: Open the regulator tap on the gas bottle and the gas isolator tap "Oven".
Gently press the control knob (Fig. 236,1) and turn left to any position.
Press the control knob and hold it down for 5 to 10 seconds. Ignition will take
place automatically.
Release the control knob and turn to the desired setting.
Switching off:
Turn the control knob (Fig. 236,1) to " ". The flame fades.
Close the gas isolator tap "Oven" and the regulator tap on the gas bottle.
X Always keep ventilation apertures at the gas oven open.
X There must be no flammable objects near the gas oven when it is being lit.
X If ignition has not taken place, repeat the entire procedure. If necessary,
check if there is gas and/or current in the gas oven.
X If the gas oven still does not work, close the gas isolator tap and notify your
service centre.
X If the burner flame is accidentally extinguished, turn the control knob to " "
and leave the burner off for at least 1 minute. Only then ignite it again.
Z Depending on the model the gas oven may come equipped with a grill.
Z Before using the gas oven for the first time run it for 30 minutes at maximum
temperature without any contents.
Z When the flame fades, the thermocouple automatically cuts the gas supply.
Z Further information can be obtained from the separate instruction manual "Gas
oven".
Fig. 236 Gas oven (Dometic)
Appliances
10
202 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
10.5.4 Microwave oven
Switching on: Open the door and place foodstuffs into the cooking area.
Close the door. A clicking noise can be heard when it engages.
Select the output on the control knob (Fig. 237,1).
Select the cooking time with the control knob (Fig. 237,2). Cooking begins.
The end of the cooking process is signaled by a signal tone. The microwave oven
will switch off automatically.
Switching off:
Open the door and remove foodstuffs.
X Only qualified personnel may repair the microwave oven. Improper repairs
can cause major risks to the user.
X The protection device against the escape of microwave energy should never
be removed.
X Use the microwave oven only if it has been properly installed.
X Only use the microwave oven when the door seal is free of damage.
X Never leave the microwave oven unattended when it is in operation.
X If there is smoke, keep the microwave oven closed, switch it off and interrupt
the power supply.
Z Operate the microwave oven only with the rotary plate and the rotary cross in
place.
Z Use only crockery suitable for microwave use.
Z The microwave oven only functions with a correct 240 V power supply. In the
case of fluctuations of the voltage or of voltage below 240 V, the microwave
oven switches itself off completely. Therefore, do not switch on additional 240 V
appliances when the microwave oven is in operation. Particularly in southern
countries it happens that the line voltage is described as having 240 V but it
really does not amount to this value. So it may happen that the microwave oven
cannot be operated in these countries.
Z Further information can be obtained from the separate instruction manual
"Microwave oven".
Fig. 237 Operating control for the micro-
wave oven
Appliances
10
203Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
10.5.5 Extractor hood
The cooker is equipped with an extractor hood with two-level fan and two-level
lighting. Depending on the model the cooking steam is filtered and circulated, or
extracted directly outwards.
Switching extractor hood on/
off:
Use the switch (Fig. 238,1) to turn the extractor hood on and off.
Switching lighting on/off:
Use the switch (Fig. 238,2) to turn the cooker lamps on and off.
10.6 Coffee machine
A coffee machine is installed in the kitchen area.
Fig. 238 Extractor hood Fig. 239 Extractor hood (alternative)
1 2
Fig. 240 Coffee machine
Z The battery for the LCD display may only be replaced by an authorised cus-
tomer service.
Z Further information can be obtained from the separate "Coffee machine"
instruction manual.
Appliances
10
204 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
10.7 Refrigerator
During the journey, only operate the refrigerator via the 12 V power supply. At high
ambient temperatures the refrigerator is unable to reach its full cooling power. At
high external temperatures, the full cooling power of the cooling unit is only guar-
anteed if the refrigerator is ventilated sufficiently. In order to achieve a better ven-
tilation the refrigerator ventilation grill can be removed.
10.7.1 Refrigerator ventilation grill
Dometic
Removal:
Turn screw (Fig. 241,1 or Fig. 242,1) one quarter turn using a coin.
Remove refrigerator ventilation grill.
Thetford
Removal:
Move the locking device (Fig. 243,1) to the middle.
Remove refrigerator ventilation grill.
Z When leaving the vehicle, always mount the refrigerator ventilation grill. Other-
wise water can enter during rain.
Fig. 241 Refrigerator ventilation grill
(Dometic small)
Fig. 242 Refrigerator ventilation grill
(Dometic large)
1
Dometic
Fig. 243 Refrigerator ventilation grill
(Thetford)
Fig. 244 Refrigerator ventilation grill
(Thetford large)
1 2
1
2
Appliances
10
205Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
10.7.2 Operation (Dometic 8 series)
Operating modes The refrigerator has 2 operating modes:
z Gas operation
z Electrical operation (240 V AC or 12 V DC)
The operating mode is set with the operating controls on the refrigerator panel.
Gas operation
Switching on:
Open the regulator tap on the gas bottle and the gas isolator tap "Refrigerator".
Set the energy selector switch (Fig. 245,1) to " ".
Press the control knob (Fig. 245,2), turn it to the highest level and hold it down.
Wait until gas gets into the burner.
Press the gas ignition button (Fig. 245,3) and keep it pressed. Ignition will take
place automatically.
Keep gas ignition button (Fig. 245,3) pressed down until the flame indicator
(Fig. 245,4) becomes green and then release it.
Keep the control knob (Fig. 245,2) pressed for another 10 to 15 seconds, then
release it.
Adjust the refrigerating temperature with the control knob.
Switching off:
Set energy selector switch to " ". Refrigerator is switched off.
Close the gas isolator tap "Refrigerator" and the regulator tap on the gas bottle.
Z Select only one energy source.
X Never let gas escape unburned due to danger of explosion.
X It is not permitted to operate the refrigerator with car gas.
Fig. 245 Operating controls for the refrig-
erator (Dometic 8 series)
1 Energy selector switch
2 Control knob for setting the tempera-
ture
3 Gas ignition button
4 Flame indicator
41 2 3
Appliances
10
206 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Electrical operation
The refrigerator can be operated with the following voltages:
z 240 V AC
z 12 V DC
Switching the 240 V operation
on:
Set the energy selector switch (Fig. 245,1) to " ".
Use the control knob (Fig. 245,2) to adjust the refrigerating temperature.
Switching the 240 V operation
off:
Set energy selector switch to " ". Refrigerator is switched off.
Switching the 12 V operation
on:
Set the energy selector switch (Fig. 245,1) to " ".
Use the control knob (Fig. 245,2) to adjust the refrigerating temperature.
Switching the 12 V operation
off:
Set energy selector switch to " ". Refrigerator is switched off.
When operated with 12 V, the refrigerator draws power only from the starter bat-
tery of the vehicle. The starter battery only supplies the refrigerator with 12 V when
the vehicle engine is running. When the vehicle engine is not running, the refriger-
ator is cut off from the power supply in the living area. For this reason, change over
to gas operation during prolonged driving breaks.
Z Close the gas isolator tap "Refrigerator" when the refrigerator is operated elec-
trically.
Z Further information can be obtained in the device manufacturer's instruction
manual.
Appliances
10
207Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
10.7.3 Operation (Dometic 8 series with manual power selection MES)
Operating modes The refrigerator has 2 operating modes:
z Gas operation
z Electrical operation (240 V AC or 12 V DC)
The operating mode is set with the operating controls on the refrigerator panel.
Gas operation
Switching on:
Open the regulator tap on the gas bottle and the gas isolator tap "Refrigerator".
Press the on/off switch/energy selector switch (Fig. 246,1) down for 2 seconds
in order to switch on the appliance. The LED of the operating mode chosen
most recently lights up.
If appropriate press the on/off switch/energy selector switch (Fig. 246,1) until
the gas operating indicator " " lights up. Gas supply is open. Ignition will take
place automatically. A ticking sound can be heard until ignition has been com-
pleted successfully.
Use switch (Fig. 246,6) to adjust refrigerating temperature.
Switching off:
Press down the on/off switch/energy selector switch for 2 seconds. Refrigerator
is switched off.
Close the gas isolator tap "Refrigerator" and the regulator tap on the gas bottle.
Z Select only one energy source.
Z Even when the 12 V power supply is switched off, a small electrical power flows
which puts an extra load on the living area battery. Always switch off the refrig-
erator for a temporary lay-up.
X Never let gas escape unburned due to danger of explosion.
Fig. 246 Operating controls for the refrigerator (Dometic 8 series with MES)
1 On/off switch/energy selector switch
2 Display-LED "open door" (only for central locking system of the refrigerator door)
3 Display-LED "fault"
4 Operating indicators
5 Display-LED "temperature range"
6 Switch for temperature setting
Mode
Dometic
1 2 43 5 6
Appliances
10
208 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Electrical operation
The refrigerator can be operated with the following voltages:
z 240 V AC
z 12 V DC
Switching the 240 V operation
on:
Press the on/off switch/energy selector switch (Fig. 246,1) down for 2 seconds
in order to switch on the appliance. The LED of the operating mode chosen
most recently lights up.
If appropriate press the on/off switch/energy selector switch (Fig. 246,1) several
times until the operating indicator 240 V " " lights up.
Use switch (Fig. 246,6) to adjust refrigerating temperature.
Switching the 240 V operation
off:
Press down the on/off switch/energy selector switch for 2 seconds. Refrigerator
is switched off.
Switching the 12 V operation
on:
Press the on/off switch/energy selector switch (Fig. 246,1) down for 2 seconds
in order to switch on the appliance. The LED of the operating mode chosen
most recently lights up.
If appropriate press the on/off switch/energy selector switch (Fig. 246,1) several
times until the operating indicator 12 V " " lights up.
Use switch (Fig. 246,6) to adjust refrigerating temperature.
Switching the 12 V operation
off:
Press down the on/off switch/energy selector switch for 2 seconds. Refrigerator
is switched off.
When operated with 12 V, the refrigerator draws power only from the starter bat-
tery of the vehicle. The starter battery only supplies the refrigerator with 12 V when
the vehicle engine is running. When the vehicle engine is not running, the refriger-
ator is cut off from the power supply in the living area. For this reason, change over
to gas operation during prolonged driving breaks.
Z Close the gas isolator tap "Refrigerator" when the refrigerator is operated elec-
trically.
Z Further information can be obtained from the separate instruction manual
"Refrigerator".
Appliances
10
209Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
10.7.4 Operation (Dometic 8 series with automatic power selection)
Operating modes
The refrigerator is equipped with automatic power selection (AES). If automatic
operation (AU) is selected, the AES automatically selects the optimum energy
source and regulates the refrigerator operation. Manual intervention to select the
type of power is possible but not required.
The AES selects from the following types of power:
z Solar installation 12 V
z 240 V AC
z 12 V DC
z Gas
Choosing the available energy source highest on the list.
In the case of a fault, the LED display fault will flash " " (Fig. 247,3).
240 V operation If the 240 V power supply is connected, this energy source is selected as the first pri-
ority by the AES.
12 V operation 12 V operation is only selected by the AES if the vehicle's engine is running and the
alternator supplies sufficient 12 V operating power.
Fig. 247 Operating controls for the refrigerator (Dometic 8 series with AES)
1 On/off switch/energy selector switch
2 Display-LED "open door" (only for central locking system of the refrigerator door)
3 Display-LED "fault"
4 Operating indicator
5 Display-LED "temperature range"
6 Switch for temperature setting
Mode
Dometic
1 2 43 5 6
Z Even when the 12 V power supply is switched off, a small electrical power flows
which puts an extra load on the living area battery. Always switch off the refrig-
erator for a temporary lay-up.
Appliances
10
210 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Gas operation
If the 240 V power supply is not connected and the vehicle's engine is not running
the AES selects the gas supply. When selecting gas operation the ignition fuse is
opened automatically so gas can get into the burner. At the same time the elec-
tronic ignition is activated. If the gas flame is extinguished, e.g. by blast of wind, the
ignition is activated immediately and re-ignites the gas. In the case of a fault in gas
operation the text "GAS" flashes in the operating indicator (Fig. 247,4).
Change-over between
energy sources
When changing over between the different power sources there are forced delays
built in the AES. This means, that after a change-over to a new energy source the
refrigerator can not be operated immediately. When changing over from 12 V oper-
ation to gas operation, a 15-minute delay is built in the AES. This prevents a change-
over to gas operation when the vehicle is stopped briefly and the engine is
switched off (e.g. stop to fill tank).
Refrigerating temperature
control
When turned on the first time the refrigerator automatically selects the middle
thermostat position. This position can be adjusted manually by using the switch for
temperature setting (Fig. 247,6). The indicator LEDs (Fig. 247,5) show the selected
thermostat position. The refrigerating temperature for the three types of energy is
set with the switch. It takes a few hours till the refrigerator reaches its normal oper-
ating temperature. When changing over the operating mode the thermostat set-
ting will be maintained. The refrigerating temperature is retained regardless of the
type of power being used.
X Never let gas escape unburned due to danger of explosion.
Z Open the regulator tap on the gas bottle and the gas isolator tap "Refrigerator".
X Open flames are prohibited at petrol stations. If the stop takes longer than
15 minutes, the refrigerator has to be turned off at the energy selector
switch.
Appliances
10
211Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Manual operation
Switching on:
Open the regulator tap on the gas bottle and the gas isolator tap "Refrigerator".
Press the on/off switch/energy selector switch (Fig. 247,1) down for 2 seconds
in order to switch on the appliance. The operating mode selected most recently
is shown in the operating indicator (Fig. 247,4).
Select the energy type with the on/off switch/energy selector switch
(Fig. 247,1).
Set the refrigerating temperature on the switch for temperature setting
(Fig. 247,6). The indicator LEDs (Fig. 247,5) show the selected thermostat posi-
tion.
When operated with 12 V, the refrigerator draws power only from the living area
battery.
Switching off:
Press down the on/off switch/energy selector switch (Fig. 247,1) for 2 seconds.
All displays close.
Close the gas isolator tap "Refrigerator" and the regulator tap on the gas bottle.
10.7.5 Operation (Thetford)
Operating modes The refrigerator has 2 operating modes:
z Gas operation
z Electrical operation (240 V AC or 12 V DC)
The operating mode is set with the button (Fig. 248,4) on the refrigerator panel.
Refrigerating temperature
control
When turned on the refrigerator automatically selects the thermostat position
selected last. This position can be adjusted manually by using the button
(Fig. 248,1). The bars on the display (Fig. 248,3) indicate the selected thermostat
position. The refrigerating temperature for the three types of energy is set with the
button. It takes a few hours till the refrigerator reaches its normal operating tem-
perature. When changing over the operating mode the thermostat setting will be
maintained. The refrigerating temperature is retained regardless of the type of
power being used.
Z If the refrigerator is manually set to "12 V", it will constantly consume current.
Therefore, switch over to gas operation when the vehicle engine is not running,
and the vehicle is not connected to the 240 V power supply.
Z Further information can be obtained from the separate instruction manual
"Refrigerator".
Z The refrigerator starts when it is switched on with the setting selected last.
Z The display lights up for about 10 seconds as soon as a button is pressed.
Z In the event of a malfunction, the display flashes in second clock pulses and an
error code is displayed (see section 16.6.2).
Z Select only one energy source.
Z Even when the 12 V power supply is switched off, a small electrical power flows
which puts an extra load on the living area battery. Always switch off the refrig-
erator for a temporary lay-up.
Appliances
10
212 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Gas operation
Switching on: Open the regulator tap on the gas bottle and the gas isolator tap "Refrigerator".
Press the button (Fig. 248,2). The display (Fig. 248,3) lights up in blue and the
current settings are displayed.
Press the button (Fig. 248,4). The current setting of the operating mode appears
on the display. To change the setting, press the button repeatedly until the gas
operating mode " " appears on the display. Gas supply is open. Ignition will
take place automatically. A ticking sound can be heard until ignition has been
completed successfully.
Press the button (Fig. 248,1). The current thermostat setting appears on the dis-
play. To change the setting, press the button repeatedly until the desired set-
ting appears on the display.
Switching off:
Press the button (Fig. 248,2). The display (Fig. 248,3) is no longer lit up. Refriger-
ator is switched off.
Close the gas isolator tap "Refrigerator" and the regulator tap on the gas bottle.
Electrical operation
The refrigerator can be operated with the following voltages:
z 240 V AC
z 12 V DC
Switching the 240 V operation
on:
Press the button (Fig. 248,2).
Press the button (Fig. 248,4) repeatedly until the 240 V operating mode " "
appears on the display.
Press the button (Fig. 248,1) repeatedly until the desired thermostat setting
appears on the display.
Switching the 240 V operation
off:
Press the button (Fig. 248,2). The display is no longer lit up. Refrigerator is
switched off.
X Never let gas escape unburned due to danger of explosion.
X It is not permitted to operate the refrigerator with car gas.
Fig. 248 Operating controls for the refrig-
erator (Thetford without SES)
1 Button for thermostat
2 On/Off button
3 Display
4 Button for operating mode
THETF
RD
1 2 3 4
Z Close the gas isolator tap "Refrigerator" when the refrigerator is operated elec-
trically.
Appliances
10
213Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Switching 12 V operation on: Press the button (Fig. 248,2).
Press the button (Fig. 248,4) repeatedly until the 12 V operating mode " "
appears on the display.
Press the button (Fig. 248,1) repeatedly until the desired thermostat setting
appears on the display.
Switching 12 V operation off:
Press the button (Fig. 248,2). The display is no longer lit up. Refrigerator is
switched off.
When operated with 12 V, the refrigerator draws power only from the starter bat-
tery of the vehicle. The starter battery only supplies the refrigerator with 12 V when
the vehicle engine is running. When the vehicle engine is not running, the refriger-
ator is cut off from the power supply in the living area. For this reason, change over
to gas operation during prolonged driving breaks.
10.7.6 Operation (Webasto)
Operating modes The refrigerator is only operated with 12 VDC.
Switching on:
Turn the temperature controller (Fig. 249,1) to the right. The unit is switched on.
Switching off:
Set the temperature controller (Fig. 249,1) to "0".
Adjusting the temperature:
Set the temperature with the temperature controller (Fig. 249,1).
z min. (1) = lowest cooling power
z max. (7) = highest cooling power
Z Further information can be obtained from the separate instruction manual
"Refrigerator".
Fig. 249 Operating controls in the refrig-
erator
1
Z The temperature in the refrigerator depends on the ambient temperature (loca-
tion), how often the door is opened and how full it is. If necessary, adjust the
temperature controller.
Z Further information can be obtained in the manufacturer's instruction manual.
Appliances
10
214 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
10.7.7 Refrigerator door locking mechanism
With some models, the refrigerator has a separate freezer compartment. The spec-
ifications in this section correspondingly also apply to the door of the freezer com-
partment.
There are two positions for locking the refrigerator door in place:
z Closed refrigerator door during travel and when the refrigerator is in operation
z Slightly opened refrigerator door as a ventilation position when the refrigerator
is switched off
Dometic 8 series
Opening:
Press the release button (Fig. 250,1) and open the refrigerator door.
Closing:
Close the refrigerator door. The lock hook engages audibly.
When the vehicle has been positioned, the lock hook can be fixed. The refrigerator
door can now be opened without having to press the release button.
Fixing the lock hook:
Press the fixture (Fig. 251,1) upwards. The lock hook (Fig. 251,2) is pressed
upwards and has no function.
Z During the journey the refrigerator door must always be closed and locked in
the closed position.
Z Lock the refrigerator door in ventilation position when the refrigerator is
switched off. This prevents mould forming.
Fig. 250 Release button of the refriger-
ator door (Dometic 8 series)
Fig. 251 Lock hook fixture
1
Appliances
10
215Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Unlocking the lock hook: Push the lock hook (Fig. 251,2) down. The lock hook functions again.
Locking in the ventilation
position:
Open the refrigerator door.
Press down the unlocking device (Fig. 252,2).
Push locking device (Fig. 252,1) forwards (Fig. 253).
If the refrigerator door is closed now, a gap will remain between the refrigerator
door and the refrigerator.
Thetford
Opening:
Open the refrigerator door at the handle (Fig. 254,2). The lock (Fig. 254,1) is
released automatically.
Closing:
Fully close the refrigerator door. Ensure that the lock is engaged.
Locking in the ventilation
position:
Slightly open refrigerator door/freezer compartment door.
Open the lock (Fig. 255,2) and snap it into the locking catch (Fig. 255,1). The
refrigerator door will then stay slightly open.
Fig. 252 Locking device in normal posi-
tion
Fig. 253 Locking device in ventilation
position
Fig. 254 Lock of refrigerator door, closed
(Thetford)
Fig. 255 Refrigerator door in ventilation
position (Thetford)
1
2
2
1
Appliances
10
216 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Sanitary fittings
11
217Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
11Sanitary fittings
Chapter overview
This chapter contains instructions regarding the sanitary fittings of the vehicle.
The instructions address the following topics:
z water tank
z waste water tank
z complete water system
z toilet compartment
z toilet
11.1 Water supply, general
The vehicle is equipped with a fitted water tank. An electric water pump pumps the
water to the individual water taps. Opening a water tap automatically switches on
the water pump and pumps water to the tap.
The waste water tank collects the waste water. The water level in the water and
waste water tanks can be checked on the panel.
X Fill water tank from supply systems that have been verified to provide
drinking water quality.
X Only use such hoses or containers when filling that have been approved for
use with drinking water.
X Thoroughly rinse filling hose or container with drinking water before use
(2 to 3 times capacity).
X Empty filling hose or container completely after use and close openings of
the filling hose or container.
X Water left standing in the water tank or in the water pipes becomes undrink-
able after a short period. Therefore, before each use of the vehicle, thor-
oughly clean the water pipes and the water tank. After each use of the
vehicle completely empty the water tank and the water pipes.
X In the case of lay-ups lasting more than a week disinfect the water system
before using the vehicle.
Z If the vehicle is not used for several days or if it is not heated when there is a risk
of frost, empty the entire water system. Leave the water taps on in central posi-
tion. Leave the safety/drainage valve (if there is one) and all drain cocks open.
Frost damage to appliances, frost damage to the vehicle and deposits in water-
carrying components can be avoided in this way.
Z The water pump will overheat without water and can get damaged. Never
operate water pump when the water tank is empty.
Z Before using the water fittings, the 12 V power supply on the panel must be
switched on. Otherwise the water pump will not work.
Z Two different types of pump are used as water pumps depending on the model:
Submerged pumps or pressurised water pumps.
Sanitary fittings
11
218 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Positions of the water
pumps
The submerged pumps are located in the water tank.
The pressurised water pumps (Fig. 256,1) are mounted on the outside of the water
tank.
11.2 Switch for water pump (winter comfort package or special
equipment)
The switch for the water pump is installed under the driver's seat.
At IVECO vehicles the water pump can be switched off with this switch.
At all other vehicles the water pump can be switched off via the panel.
This prevents the water pump from starting if the water system is empty and the
water taps are opened. Otherwise, the water pump will run hot and discharge the
living area battery.
Z In case of submerged pumps with ventilation or a ventilated non-return valve,
a fine water jet is emitted between the pump cover and base of the connector
when the pump is not submerged completely. This bubbling effect is the actual
ventilation of the pump and thus harmless.
Z The pumps were designed to be operated for max. 20 minutes at a time. Depen-
ding on the interval, a longer break must be taken. If this is not complied with,
consequential damage can occur.
Fig. 256 Pressurised water pump
Sanitary fittings
11
219Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
11.3 Water tank
11.3.1 Drinking water filler neck with cap
The drinking water filler neck is on the right or left side of the vehicle, depending
on the model.
In order to prevent confusion, the drinking water tank is closed with a blue cover.
Opening:
Open the cover flap (Fig. 257,1) of the drinking water filler neck.
Insert key into locking cylinder (Fig. 257,2) and turn a quarter turn in an anti-
clockwise direction.
Remove cap.
Fill the water tank with drinking water.
Closing:
Place the cap on the drinking water filler neck.
Turn key one quarter turn in a clockwise direction.
Remove the key.
Check that the cap sits firmly on the drinking water filler neck.
Close the cover flap.
11.3.2 Filling with water
To fill the water tank with drinking water, proceed as follows:
Open drinking water filler neck (Fig. 257).
Fill the water tank with drinking water. Use a water hose, a water canister with
a funnel or similar for filling.
Close drinking water filler neck.
X The cap for the drinking water filler neck and for the fuel filler neck are very
similar. Before filling the tank, always check the label.
Fig. 257 Cap for the drinking water filler
neck
1
2
X When filling the water tank, observe the maximum permissible gross weight
of the vehicle. Luggage must be reduced accordingly when the water tank is
full.
Sanitary fittings
11
220 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
11.3.3 Draining water
Models with double floor A hose line can be connected to the water drain neck under the vehicle floor.
The drain cock (Fig. 258,1) is located in the double floor. The drain cock is labelled
by the word "Frischwasser" ("Fresh water").
To empty the water tank, proceed as follows:
Unlock and remove the cap (Fig. 259,2) from the water drain neck (Fig. 259,1) by
turning it a quarter turn clockwise.
Open the external flap (see Section 7.2).
Mount a suitable hose to the water drain neck (Fig. 259,1) or place an appro-
priate container under the water drain neck.
Open the drain cock (Fig. 258,1). The water drains off.
Close the drain cock.
Close the external flap.
Replace the cap and lock it by turning it a quarter turn anticlockwise.
Models without double
floor
All models without double floor have no drain cock.
In these models, the water is drained through a stopper in the water tank.
Fig. 258 Drain cock in double floor
Frischwasser
Fig. 259 Water drain neck and waste
water drain neck
Sanitary fittings
11
221Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
To empty the water tank, proceed as follows:
Remove the stopper (Fig. 260,1 or Fig. 261,1) from the drainage opening
(Fig. 260,2) by pulling or unscrewing it.
The water drains off.
Insert or screw in the stopper.
Screw the cap onto the water tank.
11.4 Waste water tank
11.4.1 Waste water tank (models with double floor)
With the models with a double floor, the waste water tank is heated by the hot air
of the living area heater. This protects the waste water tank from frost when the
living area heater is in operation.
Depending on the model, the waste water tap for waste water disposal is located
on the left or right hand side of the vehicle.
Fig. 260 Stopper Fig. 261 Stopper
1
2
Z In case of frost add so much anti-freeze (such as kitchen salt) to the waste water
tank so that the waste water cannot freeze.
Z For models with an double floor: If the living area heater is out of order, the
waste water tank no longer is sufficiently protected against frost.
Z Never pour boiling water directly into the sink outlet. Boiling water could cause
deformation and leaks in the waste water pipe system.
Z Only empty the waste water tank at disposal stations, camping sites or caravan
sites especially provided for this purpose.
Fig. 262 Waste water tap Fig. 263 Waste water drain neck
Sanitary fittings
11
222 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
The waste water tap (Fig. 262,2) is fixed in the double floor. The waste water tap is
labelled with the word "Abwasser" (waste water).
A hose line can be connected to the waste water drain neck (Fig. 263,3).
Emptying:
Unlock and remove the cap (Fig. 263,4) from the waste water drain neck
(Fig. 263,3) by turning it a quarter turn in a clockwise direction.
Open the external flap (see section 7.2).
Mount suitable hose to the waste water drain neck or place appropriate con-
tainer under the waste water drain neck.
Open the waste water tap (Fig. 262,2). The waste water will run out.
Close the waste water tap.
Close the external flap.
Replace the cap and lock it by turning it a quarter turn in an anticlockwise direc-
tion.
11.4.2 Waste water tank (models without double floor)
Depending on the model, the waste water tap for waste water disposal is located
on the left or right hand side of the vehicle.
The square bolt for opening the waste water tap is directly accessible under the
vehicle floor.
Emptying:
Place key (Fig. 264,2) onto the square bolt (Fig. 264,1).
In order to open the waste water tap, turn the square bolt a quarter turn.
Completely empty waste water tank.
To close the waste water tap, turn the square bolt back as far as it will go.
11.4.3 Siphon (odour seal)
Fig. 264 Operation of the waste water tap
Z For models without double floor, remove the siphon base if there is a risk of
frost. This protects the siphon from freezing up.
Z If the siphon base is removed and the vehicle is used: Place a suitable tank under
the siphon to collect the waste water (not applicable for models with double
floors).
Z For motorhomes that have had "winter comfort package" special equipment
installed in the factory, the waste water pipes are electrically heated. When the
temperature drops below 5 °C, the frost protection equipment turns on auto-
matically.
Sanitary fittings
11
223Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
In order to prevent odours occurring in the waste water system, the vehicle -
depending on the model - has been equipped with siphons (Fig. 265,1). The
siphons are installed in the waste water pipes.
Clean the siphons every two years at the latest. To do so, unscrew and remove the
bottom cover (Fig. 265,2).
11.5 Filling the water system
Position the vehicle horizontally.
Switch on 12 V power supply on the panel.
If necessary, switch on the water pump on the panel.
Clean or disinfect water system.
Fig. 265 Odour seal
X When filling the water tank, observe the maximum permissible gross weight
of the vehicle. Luggage must be reduced accordingly when the water tank is
full.
Z The water pump will overheat without water and can get damaged. Never
operate water pump when the water tank is empty.
Z The Truma system and the Alde system (heater/boiler) each have an electric
safety/drainage valve and, depending on the model, one or two drain cocks for
emptying.
Z The water quantity can be monitored on the panel while the water tank is filled.
Fig. 266 Drain cock
Sanitary fittings
11
224 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Close the safety/drainage valve. To do so, turn the rotary switch to the "Opera-
tion" position until it latches in and press in the pushbutton (see Sections 10.4.2
and 11.4.3).
If the temperature is below 7 °C, the safety/drainage valve cannot be closed.
Therefore switch on the living area heater and wait until the temperature of the
safety/drainage valve exceeds 7 °C.
Close all drain cocks. Position the rocking lever (Fig. 266,1) horizontally.
If needed, set the stopper into the drainage opening of the water tank or screw
it in.
Close all water taps.
Fill the water tank with drinking water.
Set all the water taps to "Hot" and open them. The water pump is turned on. The
warm water pipes are filled with water.
Keep the taps open until the water flowing out of the taps has no bubbles in it.
This is the only way to ensure that the boiler is full of water.
Set all water taps to "Cold" and leave them open. This will fill the cold water
pipes with water.
Keep the taps open until the water flowing out of the taps has no bubbles in it.
Close all water taps.
Check that the cap on the water tank is not leaking.
11.6 Emptying the water system
Z If the vehicle is not used for several days or if it is not heated when there is a risk
of frost, empty the entire water system. Leave the water taps on in central posi-
tion. Leave the safety/drainage valve (if there is one) and all drain cocks open.
Frost damage to appliances, frost damage to the vehicle and deposits in water-
carrying components can be avoided in this way.
Z If the water pump can be turned off from the panel, always turn off the water
pump from the panel before you empty the water system. Otherwise the water
pump runs until it overheats or the battery is empty.
Z The Truma system and the Alde system (heater/boiler) each have an electric
safety/drainage valve and, depending on the model, one or two drain cocks for
emptying.
Sanitary fittings
11
225Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
To empty and ventilate the water system, proceed as follows. This prevents frost
damage and deposits:
Position the vehicle horizontally.
If necessary, switch off the water pump on the panel.
Switch off the 12 V power supply on the panel.
Shut off the boiler (see section 10.4).
Open all drain cocks. To do so, set the rocking lever (Fig. 267,1) in a vertical posi-
tion.
Open the safety/drainage valve. To do so turn the rotary switch by 180° until it
latches in. The pushbutton jumps out. The boiler is drained to the outside using
the drainage neck (see Sections 10.4.2 or 11.4.3).
For models with water drainage in the water tank:
Unscrew the cap of the water tank.
Open the water tank drain (see section 11.3.3).
For models with an double floor: Remove the cap from the waste water drain
neck and open the drain cock.
Open all water taps and set to the central position.
Hang the shower handset up in the shower position.
After fully emptying the system, drive the vehicle a few kilometres so the
remaining water can run out of the tank.
Allow the pressure pump to run for approx. 1 minute to dry it.
Empty the waste water tank. Take note of the environmental tips in this chapter.
Empty Thetford cassette. Take note of the environmental tips in this chapter.
Clean the water tank and then rinse it out thoroughly.
Let the water system dry for as long as possible.
After emptying, leave all water taps on in the central position.
Leave all drain cocks open.
Fig. 267 Drain cock
Sanitary fittings
11
226 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
11.7 Toilet compartment
The switches for the toilet compartment lighting are installed in different places in
the toilet compartment depending on the model.
For example, the light switch (Fig. 268,1) of the toilet compartment is located under
the bathroom cabinet.
Z Do not transport any loads in the shower tray. The shower tray or other items of
equipment in the toilet compartment can be damaged.
Z For ventilation purposes during or after a shower, and for drying wet clothing,
close the toilet compartment door and open the window or the toilet compart-
ment skylight. This improves the air circulation.
Z Close the shower curtain completely when showering, so that no water is able
to enter the area between the wash room wall and the shower tray.
Z After taking a shower, rinse soap residue from the shower tray, otherwise cracks
can appear in the shower tray over time.
Z After using the shower, wipe it dry to prevent moisture from collecting.
Z Further information about cleaning the toilet compartment can be found in the
section 12.2.
Fig. 268 Light switch
Sanitary fittings
11
227Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
11.7.1 Pull-out toilet compartment
Depending on the model, the vehicle is fitted with a pull-out toilet compartment.
The toilet compartment can be modified in just a few manual actions so that a fully-
equipped sanitary room is available for washing etc.
Extending:
Open the wardrobe doors on both sides of the toilet compartment (Fig. 269).
Rotate the spring latches (Fig. 269,2) through half a turn on both sides. The wing
of the locking lever must be at the highest point of the bevelled sleeve
(Fig. 270,1).
Pull out the toilet compartment as far as possible by the handles (Fig. 269,1)
without tilting it.
Turn the spring latches on both sides back half a turn and allow to engage
(Fig. 270,2).
Close the wardrobe doors again.
Pushing in:
Open the wardrobe doors on both sides of the toilet compartment (Fig. 269).
Rotate the spring latches (Fig. 269,2) through half a turn on both sides. The wing
of the locking lever must be at the highest point of the bevelled sleeve
(Fig. 270,1).
Push in the toilet compartment as far as possible by the handles (Fig. 269,1)
without tilting it.
Turn the spring latches on both sides back half a turn and allow to engage
(Fig. 270,2)
11.7.2 Vario toilet
Depending on the model, the vehicle is fitted with a Vario toilet. A Vario toilet can
be changed with few maneuvers so that when the shower is in use, the toilet is
available in its own enclosed cubicle. This protects the toilet area from water spray.
Fig. 269 Toilet compartment, pushed in Fig. 270 Toilet compartment locking
1
2
1
2
Z Only remove the inner part of the toilet door when it is closed.
Z Depending on the model, the Vario toilet is installed reverse to the one shown
here. The conversion is then also done reverse to the Vario toilet shown.
Sanitary fittings
11
228 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Converting into a shower
cubicle
Push the latch (Fig. 271,1) right on the edge of the wash basin and lightly pull
the wash basin. The wash basin moves forwards with the rear wall.
Turn the wash basin and the rear wall (Fig. 272,1) in the direction indicated.
Enter the toilet compartment and close the toilet door (Fig. 272,2) from the
inside and lock.
Put the latch (Fig. 273,1) of the toilet door in a vertical position and open the
inner part of the toilet door.
Turn the inner part of the toilet door in the direction indicated and push against
the rear wall of the wash basin.
The shower compartment is completely set up and can be used.
Conversion to toilet
compartment
Turn the inner part of the toilet door and to close, place the latch (Fig. 273,1) in
a horizontal position.
Return the wash basin and the rear wall to the initial position and lock.
Fig. 271 Vario toilet, locking the shower
wall
Fig. 272 Vario toilet
1
Fig. 273 Vario toilet, toilet door
1
Sanitary fittings
11
229Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
11.7.3 Variable wash basin
Depending on the model, the vehicle is fitted with a moveable wash basin. The
wash basin can be pushed into the shower area in order to increase the toilet com-
partment with a few steps.
Increasing the toilet
compartment:
Open the shower area partition completely.
Turn the lock button (Fig. 274,1) to the left.
Push the wash basin into the shower area.
Turn the lock button (Fig. 274,1) to the right to lock the wash basin.
Reducing the toilet
compartment:
Turn the lock button (Fig. 274,1) to the left.
Push the wash basin into the bath area.
Turn the lock button (Fig. 274,1) to the right to lock the wash basin.
11.8 Toilet
Fig. 274 Variable wash basin
1
Z If there is any risk of frost and the vehicle is not heated, empty the sewage tank
(cassette).
Z Do not sit on the lid of the toilet. The lid is not designed to bear the weight of a
person and could break.
Z Use a suitable chemical for this toilet. The ventilation will merely remove the
odour but not germs and gases. Germs and gases will have a detrimental effect
on the sealing rubbers.
Z Further information can be obtained in the manufacturer's instruction manual.
Z Only empty the sewage tank (cassette) at disposal stations, at camping sites or
caravan sites, that are especially provided for this purpose.
Sanitary fittings
11
230 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
11.8.1 Swivel toilet (Thetford)
The flushing of the Thetford toilet is fed directly from the water system of the
vehicle or from its own water tank, which is integrated in the toilet.
Filling the water tank:
Open the fresh water filler neck for the toilet (Fig. 275,1) above the flap for the
Thetford cassette and swivel downwards.
Fill the water tank with fresh water. Use a water hose, a water canister with a
funnel or similar for filling.
Close the fresh water filler neck.
The toilet bowl can be moved into the optimal position.
The operating unit is located close to the toilet bowl.
Fig. 275 Fresh water filler neck for toilet
1
Fig. 276 Thetford toilet bowl, swivelling
Sanitary fittings
11
231Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Flushing: Before flushing open the sliding trap of the Thetford toilet. To do this, push the
slide lever (Fig. 276,1 or Fig. 277,1) in an anticlockwise direction.
For flushing, press the blue flush button (Fig. 276,1 or Fig. 277,1).
After flushing close the sliding trap. To do this push the slide lever in a clockwise
direction.
The indicator lamp (Fig. 276,2 or Fig. 277,2) goes on whenever the Thetford cas-
sette has to be emptied.
Emptying the water tank:
Open the sliding trap. To do this, turn the slide lever in an anticlockwise direc-
tion.
Press the flush button until water ceases to flow into the bowl.
Close the sliding trap. To do this push the slide lever in a clockwise direction.
Empty Thetford cassette.
Emptying the Thetford
cassette:
Push the slide lever (Fig. 276,1 or Fig. 277,1) in a clockwise direction. The sliding
trap is closed. To empty, the sliding trap in the Thetford toilet must be closed.
Remove the Thetford cassette and empty it as described in sections 11.8.4 and
11.8.5.
Fig. 277 Flush button/indicator lamp
Thetford toilet
Sanitary fittings
11
232 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
11.8.2 Toilet with fixed seat
The flushing of the toilet is fed from the water system of the vehicle.
Flushing:
Before flushing open the sliding trap of the Thetford toilet. To do this, turn the
slide lever (Fig. 278,1) in an anticlockwise direction.
For flushing, press the blue flush button (Fig. 278,3).
After flushing close the sliding trap. To do this turn the slide lever (Fig. 278,1) in
a clockwise direction.
The indicator lamp (Fig. 278,2) goes on whenever the Thetford cassette has to be
emptied.
Emptying:
Turn the slide lever (Fig. 278,1) in a clockwise direction. The sliding trap is
closed. To empty, the sliding trap in the Thetford toilet must be closed.
Remove the Thetford cassette and empty it as described in sections 11.8.4 and
11.8.5.
11.8.3 Toilet (Dometic)
The flushing of the toilet is fed directly from the water system of the vehicle or from
its own water tank, which is integrated in the toilet.
Fig. 278 Operating unit Thetford toilet
1
2
3
Fig. 279 Fresh water filler neck for toilet
1 Fresh water filler neck
1
Sanitary fittings
11
233Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Filling the water tank: Open the fresh water filler neck for the toilet (Fig. 279,1) above the flap for the
sewage tank and swivel downwards.
Fill the water tank with fresh water. Use a water hose, a water canister with a
funnel or similar for filling.
Close the fresh water filler neck.
Let some water run into the toilet bowl before using the toilet. In order to do so
press the flush button (Fig. 281,3) on the control and operating unit (Fig. 280,2).
Flushing:
Before flushing open the sliding trap of the toilet. For this pull out the slide lever
(Fig. 280,1).
For flushing, press the flush button (Fig. 281,3).
After flushing close the sliding trap. To do so, push the slide lever back.
The indicator lamp (Fig. 281,2) goes on whenever the sewage tank is filled up to 3/
4.
The indicator lamp (Fig. 281,1) goes on whenever the sewage tank has to be emp-
tied.
Emptying the water tank: Open the sliding trap. For this pull out the slide lever (Fig. 280,1).
Press the flush button until water ceases to flow into the bowl.
Close the sliding trap. To do so, push the slide lever back.
Empty the sewage tank.
Emptying the sewage tank:
Push the slide lever (Fig. 280,1) in. The sliding trap is closed. To empty, the
sliding trap of the toilet must be closed.
Remove the sewage tank and empty it as described in sections 11.8.4 and
11.8.5. The display "Sewage tank removed" (Fig. 281,4) lights up on the control
and operating unit.
Fig. 280 Toilet bowl with control and
operating unit
Fig. 281 Control and operating unit toilet
2
1
Sanitary fittings
11
234 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
11.8.4 Removing the cassette
Depending on the model, the sewage tank (cassette) can be accessed via a special
service flap on the outside of the vehicle or via the rear storage space.
Service flap The sewage tank (cassette) can be accessed via the special service flap.
Open the flap for the cassette on the outside of the vehicle. Insert the key into
the locking cylinder of the push-button lock (Fig. 282,1) and turn a quarter turn.
Remove the key.
Press both push-button locks (Fig. 282,2) simultaneously with your thumb and
open the flap for the cassette.
Pull the retaining clip (Fig. 283,2) forward to unlock the toilet cassette and pull
out the cassette at the handle (Fig. 283,1).
Rear storage space The sewage tank (cassette) can be accessed via the rear storage space.
Open the rear storage space flap (see section 7.2).
If the access to the sewage tank (cassette) is closed (Fig. 284,1): Pull out the
toilet compartment (see section 11.7.1).
Press the release (Fig. 285,2) and pull out the sewage tank (cassette) on the
handle (Fig. 285,1).
Z The sewage tank (cassette) can only be taken out if the sliding trap is closed.
Fig. 282 Flap for the toilet cassette Fig. 283 Thetford cassette
1
2
Fig. 284 Sewage tank access, closed Fig. 285 Sewage tank access, open
1
Sanitary fittings
11
235Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
11.8.5 Emptying the cassette
Take the cassette to a disposal point especially provided for this purpose. As you
do this, point the drainage neck upwards.
If necessary, turn the drainage neck upwards.
Remove the cap of the drainage neck.
Point the cassette with the drainage neck downwards.
For Thetford cassettes: Activate the aeration knob with your thumb. The cas-
sette empties.
Close drainage neck with the cap.
If necessary, return the drainage neck to its original position.
Push the cassette back to its original position.
Ensure that the cassette is secured by the retaining clip.
Lock the flap for the cassette.
Fig. 286 Emptying the Thetford cassette
Sanitary fittings
11
236 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Care
12
237Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
12Care
Chapter overview
This chapter contains instructions regarding the care of the vehicle.
The instructions address the following topics:
z exterior of the vehicle
z interior
z water system
z extractor hood
z toilets
z winter operation
At the end of the chapter there is a checklist of measures you must carry out if you
are not going to use the vehicle for an extended period of time.
The checklist address the following topics:
z temporary lay-up
z winter lay-up
z start-up after a lay-up
12.1 External care
12.1.1 Washing with a high-pressure cleaner
Before cleaning the vehicle with a high-pressure cleaner, observe the operating
instructions of the high-pressure cleaner.
When cleaning with the nozzle for circular jet between the vehicle and the cleaning
nozzle, maintain a minimum distance of approx. 700 mm.
Take into consideration that the jet of water comes out of the cleaning nozzle with
pressure. The vehicle may be damaged by incorrect handling of the high-pressure
cleaner. The temperature of the water should not be above 60 °C. Keep the jet of
water in constant movement during the washing process. Do not direct the water
jet at clearances, built-in electrical parts, plugs, seals, the ventilation grill or the sky-
lights. The vehicle may be damaged or water may enter the interior.
12.1.2 Washing the vehicle
Wash the vehicle only on a washing site intended for this purpose.
Avoid full sunshine. Observe environmental measures.
Only clean external applications and synthetic parts with plenty of warm water,
dish washing liquid and soft cloth.
Wash down the vehicle with plenty of water, a clean sponge or a soft brush. In
the case of stubborn dirt add dish washing liquid to the water.
Painted exterior walls may also be cleaned with a caravan cleaner.
Z Do not clean the tyres with a high-pressure cleaner. The tyres might be dam-
aged.
Z Do not spray external applications (deco-films) directly with the high-pressure
cleaner. The external applications could come off.
Z Never clean the vehicle in the car wash. Water can enter the refrigerator grills,
the waste gas vents, the ventilation of the extractor hoods or the forced venti-
lations. The vehicle could be damaged.
Care
12
238 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Clean surfaces made of glass-fibre reinforced plastic (GRP) only with mild
cleansers. Cleaning agents and polishes for GRP surfaces are available in special-
ised stores.
Add-on parts made of glass-fibre reinforced plastic (GRP) require a regular
follow-up treatment with a polisher. This way these parts will not turn yellow
and the sealing of the surface remains intact.
Treat rubber seals of doors and storage flaps with talc.
Treat locking cylinder of doors and storage flaps with graphite dust.
12.1.3 Windows of acrylic glass
Acrylic glass windows are delicate and require very careful handling.
12.1.4 Underbody
The underbody of the vehicle is partly coated with an age-resistant underbody pro-
tection. Should the underbody protection be damaged, repair immediately. Do not
treat areas coated with underbody protection with spray oil.
12.1.5 Waste water tank
Clean the waste water tank after every use of the vehicle.
Cleaning:
Empty the waste water tank.
Thoroughly rinse out the waste water tank with fresh water.
If possible, clean waste water sensors through the cleaning opening by hand.
Z Never rub acrylic glass windows dry as dust particles might damage the surface!
Z Only clean acrylic glass windows with plenty of warm water, some dish washing
liquid and a soft cloth.
Z Never use glass cleaning agents with chemical, abrasive or alcohol-containing
additives. Premature brittleness of the panes and associated cracks may result
from their use.
Z Avoid contact of cleansing agents used for the body (e.g. tar- or silicone-
removing agents) with acrylic glass.
Z Do not clean vehicle in car wash.
Z Do not attach stickers to the acrylic glass windows.
Z Having cleaned the vehicle rinse acrylic glass with sufficient clear water.
Z Treat rubber seals with glycerin.
Z An acrylic glass cleanser with antistatic effect is suitable for a follow-up treat-
ment. Small scratches can be treated with an acrylic glass polish. These agents
are available at the accessories shop.
Z Only use products approved by the manufacturer. Our authorised dealers and
service centres will be happy to advise you.
Z In the case of models which have an underbody with glass-fibre reinforced
plastic use only care products which are suitable for the material.
Care
12
239Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
12.1.6 Entrance step
If the entrance step is lubricated, coarse particles of dirt can settle on the lubricant
during the journey and cause damage to the operating mechanism of the entrance
step. Therefore, do not lubricate the moving parts of the entrance step.
12.1.7 Driver's cabin insulation mat (model I)
Clean the insulation mat for the driver's cabin with clear, lukewarm water. Remove
heavier soiling with a cloth and some white spirits. Afterwards, immediately rinse
the cleaned area with lukewarm water.
12.2 Interior care
Surface and knobs of furniture, lamps and synthetic parts in the toilet and living
area should be cleaned with water and a wool cloth. A mild cleanser may be
added to the water. If necessary, treat finished surfaces with furniture polish.
Clean upholstery with dry foam specially manufactured for the use on uphol-
stery or with the foam of a mild detergent. Do not wash upholstery, only have
them cleaned. Protect upholstery from direct sunlight so that it does not loose
its colour.
Clean covers made of synthetic leather at least once a week with an absorbent
cloth or sponge and with a mixture of water and mild lather. Wipe off with clear
water, but do not use too much water.
Clean stubborn stains with a mixture of alcohol and water (30% alcohol and
70% water) or with 10% diluted ethanol (10% ethanol and 90% water) and then
with clear water. However marks may remain.
Do not use solvent-based or scouring products, nor undiluted alcohol and/or
acetone.
Z If possible, treat stains immediately.
Z Acrylic glass windows are delicate and require very careful handling (see sec-
tion 12.1.3).
Z Synthetic parts in the toilet and living area are very delicate and should be
treated with care. Do not use solvents, alcohol-containing cleansers or scourers
containing sand. This procedure will help you to avoid brittleness and forma-
tion of cracks.
Z Do not pour any corrosive agents into the drain holes. Never pour boiling water
directly into the drain holes. Corrosive agents and boiling water cause damage
to drainage pipes and siphon traps.
Z Do not use vinegar based products to clean the toilet and water system, or for
decalcification of the water system. Vinegar-based products may cause damage
to seals or parts of the installation. Use standard decalcifying products for decal-
cification.
Z Save water. Mop up all remaining water.
Z Vacuum off carpets and cushions with a suitable brush attachment.
Z For information about the use of maintenance products, our representatives
and service centres will be glad to advise.
Care
12
240 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Wipe off Teflon coverings with an absorbent cloth or sponge and use a mild
water-based household detergent. Alternatively use a mixture of 2 tablespoons
of ammonia with 1 litre of water.
Never rub wet or oily stains. Instead, dab them with an absorbent cloth. Work
from the outside to the inside to prevent spreading the stain. When treating
solid or dried stains, always try to scrape them off with a dull knife or scraper or
remove them off with a soft brush. Afterwards, dab off any residue with a moist
cloth.
Curtains and net curtains should be dry cleaned.
Vacuum clean the carpet, if necessary clean with carpet shampoo.
Clean PVC-floor covering with a mild, soapy cleanser for PVC floors. Do not place
carpet on wet PVC-floor covering. The carpet and the PVC-floor covering may
stick together.
Never clean the sink or the gas cooker with a scourer. Avoid anything which
may cause scratching or grooves.
Clean gas cooker only with a moist cloth. Prevent any water from penetrating
the gas cooker. Water may damage the gas cooker.
Brush insect screens on doors, windows and skylights with a soft brush or
vacuum with the brush attachment of the vacuum cleaner.
Brush blinds with a soft brush or vacuum with the brush attachment of the
vacuum cleaner. Grease or stubborn dirt may be removed with a mild soap at
30 °C (curd soap).
Brush Roman shades with a soft brush or vacuum with the brush attachment of
the vacuum cleaner. Grease or stubborn dirt may be removed with a mild soap
at 30 °C (curd soap).
Unrolled seat belts can be cleaned with warm soapsuds. The seat belt must be
completely dry before being rolled up.
12.3 Water system
12.3.1 Cleaning the water tank
Clean the water tank with a plastic-compatible cleanser from specialised stores.
Observe the manufacturer's instructions.
12.3.2 Cleaning the water pipes
Empty the water system.
Close all drain holes and drain cocks.
Fill mixture of water and cleaning agent into the water tank. Observe the man-
ufacturer's instructions regarding the mixing ratio.
Open the drain cocks one by one.
Leave the drain cocks open until the mixture of water and cleaning agent has
reached the respective drain.
Z Only use suitable cleaning agents as sold by the specialist trade.
Z Collect any emerging mixture of water and cleaning agent for correct disposal.
Care
12
241Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Close the drain cocks.
Set all the water taps to "Hot" and open them.
Leave the drain cocks open until the mixture of water and cleaning agent has
reached the drain.
Set all water taps to "Cold" and open them.
Leave the drain cocks open until the mixture of water and cleaning agent has
reached the drain.
Close all water taps.
Flush the toilet several times.
Allow the cleaning agent to act in accordance with the manufacturer's instruc-
tions.
Empty the water system. Collect the mixture of water and cleaning agent for
correct disposal.
For rinsing fill the entire water system with drinking water and empty again sev-
eral times over.
12.3.3 Disinfecting the water system
Empty the water system.
Close all drain holes and drain cocks.
Fill mixture of water and disinfectant into the water tank. Observe the manufac-
turer's instructions regarding the mixing ratio.
Open the drain cocks one by one.
Leave the drain cocks open until the mixture of water and disinfectant has
reached the respective drain.
Close the drain cocks.
Set all the water taps to "Hot" and open them.
Leave the drain cocks open until the mixture of water and disinfectant has
reached the drain.
Set all water taps to "Cold" and open them.
Leave the drain cocks open until the mixture of water and disinfectant has
reached the drain.
Close all water taps.
Flush the toilet several times.
Allow the disinfectant to act in accordance with the manufacturer's instruc-
tions.
Empty the water system. Collect the mixture of water and disinfectant for cor-
rect disposal.
For rinsing fill the entire water system with drinking water and empty again sev-
eral times over.
Z Only use suitable disinfectants as sold by the specialist trade.
Z Collect any emerging mixture of water and disinfectant for correct disposal.
Care
12
242 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
12.4 Extractor hood
Clean the grease filter of the range hood occasionally. How often cleaning is neces-
sary depends on how often the range hood is used. Do not wait to clean the filter
until the performance of the range hood has noticeably decreased.
Cleaning grease filter:
If necessary, remove the lower cover.
Remove the filter.
Wash the filter with warm water and some washing-up liquid.
Let the filter dry completely and re-install it.
If necessary, put the cover back on and secure it with the two screws.
Replacing the charcoal filter:
Remove the lower and the middle cover.
Remove the used charcoal filter.
Insert the new charcoal filter.
Put the covers back on and secure them with the two screws.
12.5 Sink
X Prior to carrying out work on the device, turn off the power supply.
Fig. 287 Wash basin (variant 1) Fig. 288 Wash basin (variant 2)
Fig. 289 Sink
Care
12
243Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
12.5.1 Stainless-steel sink
Removing stubborn soiling: Clean the sink with a common household sponge and cleansing milk.
Rinse out the sink and dry it with household cloths.
Removing greasy and oily
residue:
Saturate a kitchen cloth in some white spirits and rub the sink with it.
Rinse out the sink and dry it with household cloths.
Removing fingerprints:
Clean the sink with a cleaning solution and a leather cleaning cloth.
Rinse out the sink and dry it with household cloths.
12.5.2 Plastic sink
Removing normal soiling: Clean the sink with a conventional cleaning solution or non-scouring house-
hold cleaner.
Removing stubborn soiling:
Apply spot salt or dishwasher salt with a moist sponge and allow it to work in
for several hours.
Remove salt and clean sink with a food-safe plastic cleaner.
Rinse out sink.
Removing lime deposits:
Clean the sink with vinegar or lime remover.
Rinse out sink.
Z Do not use bleaches, products containing chloride or hydrochloric acid, baking
soda or silver polish for cleaning.
Z Do not use scouring milk or rough sponges.
Z Before cleaning test at an inconspicuous point whether the cleanser used is
suitable for the surface.
Z After cleaning the surfaces, wipe thoroughly dry to avoid traces of lime.
Z With brushed stainless-steel surfaces, wipe in the same direction as the polish.
Z Do not use microfibre cloths for cleaning. Fine scratches could be created here.
Z Do not use scouring milk/scouring powder or rough sponges.
Z Before cleaning test at an inconspicuous point whether the cleanser used is
suitable for the surface.
Z After cleaning the surfaces, wipe thoroughly dry to avoid traces of lime.
Care
12
244 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
12.6 Toilets
If the toilet will not be used for a longer period of time, for example for Winter lay
up, the toilet must be cleaned and completely emptied.
12.6.1 Toilet with separate water tank
Emptying the tank: Press the flush button, to active the operating panel.
Open the sliding trap and flush until no more water flows.
Close the sliding trap.
Empty the cassette (Fig. 290,2) at a disposal station authorized for this purpose
and clean it.
Leave the drainage neck (Fig. 290,3) open.
Remove the drain hose (Fig. 290,5) from the holder (Fig. 290,4).
Place a sufficiently large container under the drain hose.
Remove the drain plug (Fig. 290,1) and let the residual water run out.
When no more water flows out, place the drain plug in the drain hose.
Replace the drain hose in the holder.
12.7 Winter care
De-icing salt damages the underbody and the parts open to water spray. We rec-
ommend that you wash the vehicle more frequently during wintertime. Mechan-
ical and surface treated parts and the underside are under particular strain, and
should therefore be cleaned thoroughly.
Fig. 290 Toilet water tank drain hose
Z If there is any risk of frost, always run heater at a minimum of 15 °C. Switch the
circulation fan (if there is one) to automatic. In the case of extreme external tem-
peratures, the furniture flaps and doors should be left slightly open. The
inflowing warm air can help prevent the freezing of water pipes, for example,
and counteract the formation of condensation in the storage spaces.
Z If there is any risk of frost, cover the outside surface of the windows with winter
insulation mats.
Care
12
245Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
12.7.1 Preparations
Check the vehicle for paint and rust damage. Repair damage as necessary.
Make certain that water cannot penetrate the automatic floor ventilation
system and the heater.
Use a wax-based rust inhibitor to protect the metal parts of the underbody.
Use appropriate protection for external painted surfaces.
12.7.2 Winter operation
During winter operation, condensation develops when the vehicle is occupied
under low-temperature conditions. To ensure good interior air quality and avoid
vehicle damage from condensation, sufficient ventilation is essential.
When heating the vehicle, the heater should be at the highest setting and roof
storage cabinets, curtains and blinds should be opened. This ensures optimal
ventilation.
In the morning, lift up all cushions, air out storage boxes and dry any damp
areas.
12.7.3 At the end of the winter season
Thoroughly clean the underbody of the vehicle and the engine. When this is
done, corrosion-inducing anti-freeze agents (salts, alkaline residues) are
removed.
Clean the exterior and use regular car wax to protect metal surfaces.
12.8 Lay-up
12.8.1 Temporary lay-up
Animals (especially mice) can cause great damage to the interior of the vehicle. This
is especially true if the animal remains undisturbed in a parked vehicle.
The animals can get into the vehicle at an opportune moment and hide from view.
To keep damages from animals to a minimum or to avoid them altogether, regu-
larly check the vehicle for damage or animal traces. This is especially important
approx. 24 hours after parking the car in storage.
If animal traces are found, contact your authorised dealer or service centre. If
damage to cables has occurred, they can result in short circuits. The vehicle could
catch fire.
Z If condensation has still developed, just wipe it off.
X If the vehicle has been stationary for a long period (approx. 10 months) have
the braking and gas systems checked by an authorised specialist workshop.
X Take into consideration that water is undrinkable after only a short time.
X Animal damage to cables can lead to short circuits. Fire hazard!
Care
12
246 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Before laying up the vehicle, go through the following checklist:
Activities Done
Base vehicle
Completely fill fuel tank. This prevents corrosion damage within the fuel
tank system
Jack up vehicle so that the wheels do not bear any load, or move vehicle
every 4 weeks. This prevents any pressure points from occurring on tyres
and wheel bearings
Protect the tyres from direct exposure to the sun. Danger of formation of
cracks!
Inflate tyres up to the recommended maximum pressure
Check the spare wheel or tyre repair kit respectively
Always provide for sufficient ventilation in the underbody area
Z Humidity or lack of oxygen e.g. by covering with plastic film
may cause optical irregularities to the underbody.
In addition observe the notes in the operating manual of the base vehicle
Body
All vents should be sealed with the appropriate caps and all other open-
ings (apart from forced ventilations) should also be sealed. This prevents
animals (e.g. mice) from gaining entry
Air the interior, all storage compartments accessible from the outside,
and the parking space (e.g. garage) every 3 weeks in order to prevent the
occurrence of condensation and resulting mould formation
Interior
Place upholstery in an upright position for ventilation, and cover
Clean refrigerator
Allow refrigerator and freezer compartment doors to remain slightly
open
Search for traces of animals that have gained entry
Disconnect the flat screen from the mains and, if necessary, remove it
from the vehicle
Gas system
Close regulator tap on the gas bottle
Close all gas isolator taps
Always remove gas bottles from the gas bottle compartment, even if
they are empty
Electrical system
Fully charge living area and starter battery
Z Charge the battery for at least 24 hours before laying up.
Disconnect the living area battery from the 12 V power supply
Care
12
247Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
12.8.2 Winter lay-up
Additional measures are required if laying up the vehicle over winter:
Water system
Empty the entire water system. Leave the water taps on in central posi-
tion. Leave the safety/drainage valve (if available) and all drain cocks
open. Observe the specifications in Chapter 11.
Switch off the safety/drainage valve on the transformer/rectifier. Other-
wise the battery will become discharged too quickly
Z If the safety/drainage valve is switched off, the water system is
no longer protected against frost.
Activities Done
Activities Done
Base vehicle
Clean body and underbody thoroughly and spray with hot wax or pro-
tect with varnish
Fill fuel tank with winter diesel
Check antifreeze in the cooling water
Rectify damage to the paintwork
Inflate tyres up to the recommended maximum pressure
Body
Keep the forced ventilation open
Clean and lubricate the mounted steady legs
Clean and grease all door and flap hinges
Brush oil or glycerine on all locking mechanisms
Rub all rubber seals with talc
Use graphite dust to treat locking cylinders
Interior
Position de-humidifiers
Remove upholstery from the vehicle and store in a dry place
Air the interior at regular intervals
Empty all cabinets and storage compartments, open flaps, doors and
drawers
Thoroughly clean the interior
If there is a risk of frost, do not leave the flat screen in the vehicle
Electrical system
Remove starter and living area batteries and store in a place protected
from frost (see chapter 9)
Water system
Clean the water system using a cleaning agent from a specialised store
Complete vehicle
Arrange the tarpaulins in such a way that the ventilation openings are
not covered, or use porous tarpaulins
Care
12
248 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
12.8.3 Starting up the vehicle after a temporary lay-up or after lay-up
over winter
Go through the following checklist before start-up:
Activities Done
Base vehicle
Check the tyre pressure on all tyres
Check the tyre pressure and condition of the spare wheel or tyre repair kit
respectively
Body
Clean the pivot bearing of the entrance step
Check the functioning of the fitted steady legs
Check that the doors, windows and skylights are working properly
Check the function of all external locks
Remove the cover from the waste gas vent of the heater (if there is one)
Remove the winter cover from the refrigerator grills (if there is one)
Gas system
Put the gas bottles in the gas bottle compartment, tie down and connect
to the gas pressure regulator
Electrical system
Connect to 240 V power supply using the external socket
Fully charge living area and starter battery
Z Charge the battery for at least 24 hours after lay-up.
Connect the living area battery with the 12 V power supply (see
chapter 9)
Check that the electrical system are working, e.g. interior light, socket
and all installed electrical appliances
Water system
Disinfect water pipes and water tank
Check the functionality of the operating lever for the waste water tank
Close safety/drainage valve, drain cocks and water taps
Check the safety/drainage valve, water taps, drain cocks and water dis-
tributors for leaks
Appliances
Check the function of the refrigerator
Change heating fluid of the hot-water heater every 2 years
Check the function of the heater/boiler
Check the function of the gas cooker
Check the function of the air conditioning unit
Maintenance
13
249Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
13Maintenance
Chapter overview
This chapter contains instructions about inspection and maintenance work con-
cerning the vehicle.
The maintenance instructions address the following topics:
z Alde hot-water heater
z independent vehicle heater
z air conditioning unit
z replacing bulbs and fluorescent tubes
z AL-KO rear axle
At the end of the chapter you will find important instructions on how to obtain
spare parts.
13.1 Inspection work
Like any technical appliance, the vehicle must be inspected at regular intervals.
This inspection work must be carried out by qualified personnel.
Special technical knowledge, which cannot be taught within the framework of this
instruction manual, is required for these tasks. Personnel with this technical knowl-
edge are available for assistance at all authorised dealers and service centres. Their
experience and regular technical instruction by the factory as well as equipment
and tools guarantee expert and up-to-date inspection of the vehicle.
The service centre in charge will confirm the work performed.
Have chassis inspections confirmed in the chassis manufacturer's customer service
booklet.
13.2 Maintenance work
As with every machine, this vehicle requires maintenance. The extent and fre-
quency of the maintenance work required depend on conditions of operation and
use. More difficult operating conditions make it necessary to service the vehicle
more often.
Have the base vehicle and the appliances serviced at the intervals specified in the
corresponding instruction manuals.
Z Observe the inspections indicated by the manufacturer and have them carried
out at the specified intervals. The value of the vehicle is thus preserved.
Z The confirmation of the inspection work carried out serves as valid proof in the
event of damage and guarantee claims.
Maintenance
13
250 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
13.3 Alde hot-water heater
13.3.1 Checking the fluid level
Switch off the hot-water heater and allow it to cool down.
Check if the fluid level is between the marks "MIN" (Fig. 291,3) and "MAX"
(Fig. 291,2) on the compensator reservoir (Fig. 291).
The heating fluid has to be renewed every 2 years.
13.3.2 Topping up heating fluid
Position the vehicle horizontally. This prevents the formation of bubbles.
Switch off the hot-water heater and allow it to cool down.
Unscrew or pull off the panel.
Open the rotary lid (Fig. 291,1) on the compensator reservoir.
Slowly remove cover with circulating pump upwards.
Z Check the level of the heating fluid at the compensator reservoir every 2 years.
Z During or after the first operating hours of the hot-water heater, the filling level
may fall below the minimum mark. If this is the case, top up the heating fluid.
Z We recommend to bleed the heating system after the initial heater operation
and to check the glycol content.
Z Have heating fluid changed by an authorised dealer or a service centre at inter-
vals of approximately two years as corrosion-protection wears off after some
time.
Z Top up heating system with a water-glycol mixture (60 : 40) only. This mixture
offers frost protection up to approx. -25 °C. When topping up hot-water heaters
that are connected to the engine's cooling circuit, please observe the instruc-
tions in the instruction manuals of the manufacturers.
Z Further information can be obtained in the manufacturer's instruction manual.
Fig. 291 Compensator reservoir hot-
water heater
Z The heating fluid has to be renewed every 2 years.
Maintenance
13
251Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Check anti-freeze with an anti-freeze hydrometer. The frost protection content
must be 40 % or correspond to a frost protection of -25 °C.
Fill water frost protection mixture slowly into the compensator reservoir.
13.3.3 Bleeding the heating system
The bleeding valves are built in nearby the radiators.
Switch off the hot-water heater and allow it to cool down.
Open bleeding valve (Fig. 292,1) and leave open until no more air escapes.
Close bleeding valve.
Repeat this procedure at all bleeding valves.
Check to see if the hot-water heater warms up.
13.4 Diesel heater Webasto
13.4.1 Disinfection
Use a sodium hypochlorite solution (NaOCl), dilution 5%, 30 °C to 40 ºC (e.g. Cer-
tisil®, Puriclean) for disinfection.
Drain the water completely and close all the water taps.
Fill the complete water supply system with NaOCl.
Z The optimum fluid level is reached when the fluid in the compensator reservoir
is 1 cm above the "MIN" mark.
Fig. 292 Bleeding valve of hot-water
heater
Z A lot of repair and maintenance work on the heater require specialist knowl-
edge and special tools. Incorrect setting or maintenance can result in damage
to the heater or to accidents with serious damage.
Z During or after the first operating hours of the hot-water heater, the filling level
may fall below the minimum mark. If this is the case, top up the heating fluid.
Z Further information can be obtained in the manufacturer's instruction manual.
Z Clean and disinfect the water supply system at least once a year.
Maintenance
13
252 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Set the mode selector (Fig. 215,9) to Summer operation, water temperature
40 °C (Fig. 215,2).
Open the water taps in the kitchen, bath, shower, etc. one after the other (set
mixer taps or single-lever faucets to "hot") until the air has been emitted com-
pletely from the water lines and NaOCl flows out of the water taps.
Leave the unit on for 1-2 hours.
Drain the NaOCl completely.
Rinse the water lines once to twice using the same methods. It is not necessary
to leave the unit on for 1 to 2 hours.
Drain the water completely.
13.4.2 Decalcification
Regular decalcification depending on the respective water quality is advisable in
order not to limit the water quality and the efficiency of the heater.
Use common household products such as a wine vinegar-water mixture in a ratio
of 1:2 for decalcification.
Drain the water completely and close all the water taps.
Fill the complete water supply system with the wine vinegar-water mixture.
Set the mode selector (Fig. 215,9) to Summer operation, water temperature
40 °C (Fig. 215,2).
Open the water taps in the kitchen, bath, shower, etc. one after the other (set
mixer taps or single-lever faucets to "hot") until the air has been emitted com-
pletely from the water lines and NaOCl flows out of the water taps.
Leave the unit on for 1-2 hours.
Check whether the incrustations have dissolved completely in the vinegar
water. If not, leave the heater on for a further 30 minutes
Drain the vinegar water completely.
Rinse the water lines with drinking water until you cannot smell any vinegar
odour.
13.4.3 Fuses
The Webasto diesel heater has 3 fuses: 5A, 15A and 15A. Each fuse has to be con-
nected to the corresponding line (observe the colour).
z 5A: red-blue line
z 15A: red-black line
z 15A: red line
Z Before replacing a fuse ensure that the diesel heating is switched off.
X Incorrect wiring of the fuses not complying to specifications can result in fire.
Maintenance
13
253Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
13.5 Independent vehicle heater
Use the independent vehicle heater for 10 minutes at least once a month with a
cold engine and smallest fan settings.
Before the heating season starts, have the independent vehicle heater checked by
an authorised specialist workshop.
13.6 Air conditioning unit
13.6.1 Air conditioning unit (Truma)
A lint filter (Fig. 293,1) for the air circulation suction system is at the front of the air
conditioning unit. The lint filter must be cleaned at regular intervals, at least twice a
year however, and replaced if necessary.
The condensation drain is under the floor of the vehicle. Keep the drain hose free
from dirt, leaves or similar to allow the condensation to be drained.
X Prior to carrying out work on the device, turn off the power supply.
Z Never operate the air conditioning unit without a lint filter. Without a lint filter,
the vaporiser becomes dirty and the capacity of the air conditioning unit is con-
sequently impaired.
Z Condensation can enter the vehicle if the condensation drain is clogged up.
Keep the condensation drain free from dirt, leaves and similar.
Fig. 293 Air conditioning unit (Truma)
Maintenance
13
254 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
13.6.2 Air conditioning unit (Teleco)
A lint filter (Fig. 294,1) for the air circulation suction system is located at the rear of
the air conditioning unit. The lint filter must be cleaned at regular intervals, at least
twice a year however, and replaced if necessary.
Pull the lint filter out of the air conditioning unit, clean it or replace it if necessary.
The condensation drain is under the floor of the vehicle. Keep the drain hose free
from dirt, leaves or similar to allow the condensation to be drained.
13.7 Replacing bulbs and fluorescent tubes
Fig. 294 Lint filter air conditioning unit
1
X Bulbs and light fittings can be extremely hot. Therefore, allow lights to cool
down before changing bulbs.
X Shut off the power supply on the safety cut-out in the 240 V fuse box before
changing bulbs.
X Store bulbs in a safe place inaccessible to children.
X Do not use any bulb that has been dropped or which shows scratches in its
glass. The bulb might burst.
X Lights can get very hot. When the light is switched on, there must always be
a safety distance of 30 cm between light and flammable objects. Fire hazard!
Z A new bulb should not be touched with the fingers. Use a cloth when installing
the new bulb.
Z Only use bulbs of the same type and with the correct wattage.
Z If LEDs in lights are defect, contact an authorised dealer or service centre.
Maintenance
13
255Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
13.7.1 Halogen spotlight
Changing bulbs: Loosen the fixing screws (Fig. 295,2).
Remove the lamp glass cover (Fig. 295,1) carefully.
Remove halogen bulb.
Put in a new halogen bulb.
Reassemble the lamp in the reverse order.
13.7.2 Room lamp
Changing bulbs: Unscrew the cap (Fig. 296,1).
Remove cover (Fig. 296,2).
Press the light covering (Fig. 296,3) lightly together and remove it.
Remove the fluorescent tube.
Insert a new fluorescent tube.
Reassemble the lamp in the reverse order.
Fig. 295 Halogen spotlight (movable)
1
2
2
Fig. 296 Room lamp
Maintenance
13
256 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
13.7.3 Living area lamp
Changing bulbs: Remove the screw (Fig. 297,1) and take off the cover (Fig. 297,2).
Press the glass together gently and remove from the housing.
Remove the fluorescent tube.
Insert a new fluorescent tube.
Reassemble the lamp in the reverse order.
13.7.4 Range hood light
Changing bulbs: Remove the lower and the middle cover.
Remove the halogen bulb carefully from the holder.
Put in a new halogen bulb.
Put the covers back on and secure them with the two screws.
13.7.5 Wardrobe lights with LED
The LED of the wardrobe light is supplied with power by 3 batteries of the type AA/
LR6/R6 ("Mignon").
Fig. 297 Living area lamp
21
Z Use only batteries of the same type.
Fig. 298 Wardrobe light with LED, battery
compartment closed
Fig. 299 Wardrobe light with LED, battery
compartment opened
Maintenance
13
257Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Changing the batteries: Push the cover (Fig. 298,1) in the direction of the arrow.
Take the batteries (Fig. 299,2) out of the battery holder.
Insert new batteries (Fig. 299,2) of the same type, observing the correct polarity
(+/-).
Push the cover (Fig. 299,1) back on.
13.7.6 Garage light
Changing bulbs: Push the light covering (Fig. 300,1) up slightly and remove it.
Remove bulb.
Put in a new bulb.
Reassemble the lamp in the reverse order.
13.7.7 Refrigerator light
Changing bulbs: Switch off the refrigerator at the external switch.
Grip under the light covering (Fig. 301,1) from behind and raise the light cov-
ering approximately 3 mm.
Remove the light covering to the side.
Remove bulb.
Put in a new bulb.
Reassemble the lamp in the reverse order.
Fig. 300 Garage light
Fig. 301 Refrigerator light
Maintenance
13
258 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
13.7.8 Light in the elevating roof
Changing the battery: Remove the light.
Open the battery compartment (Fig. 302,1) and remove the batteries.
Insert new batteries and close the battery compartment (Fig. 302,1).
Mount the light in the elevating roof.
13.8 AL-KO rear axle
Fiat vehicles with AL-KO
rear axle without
pneumatic spring
In addition to the regulations and notes in the operator manual of the basic vehicle
as well as in the maintenance manual, the rear axles must be relubricated after
20,000 km, or at least every 12 months.
The lubricator nipples (Fig. 303, arrow) are situated on the underside of the axle
tube.
Fig. 302 Light in the elevating roof
1
Z The rear axles must not bear any load while they are being lubricated.
Z Use one of the following types of grease for lubrication:
Costrac GL 1501 by the firm Klüber
Cardex 3746 SP by the firm CONDA
Z If the vehicle is equipped with a maintenance-free torsion bar spring axle or a
rear axle with pneumatic cushioning, the two lubricator nipples are left out.
Fig. 303 AL-KO rear axle
Maintenance
13
259Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
13.9 Vehicle identification plate
The vehicle identification plate (Fig. 304) with the serial number is fitted on the B
column on the front passenger side (models T and A) or in the entrance area
(models I).
Do not remove the vehicle identification plate. The vehicle identification plate:
z Identifies the vehicle
z Helps with the procurement of spare parts
z Together with the vehicle documents identifies the vehicle owner
13.10 Warning and information stickers
There are warning and information stickers on and inside the vehicle. Warning and
information stickers are for the sake of safety and must not be removed.
Fig. 304 Vehicle identification plate
1 Type
2 Maximum permissible gross weight of
the vehicle with trailer
3 Manufacturer of the unit (add-on unit)
4 Manufacturer's code and chassis
number
5 EG type approval number
6 Permissible rear axle load (for tandem
axle)
7 Permissible axle load rear
8 Permissible axle load front
9 Maximum permissible gross weight of
the vehicle
10 Serial number
Fig. 305 Cover for chassis number (Fiat
base vehicle)
Z Always include the serial number with all inquiries for the customer service
office.
Z For vehicles on a Fiat chassis, the chassis number is located behind a cover
(Fig. 305,1) in the entrance on the front passenger's side.
1
Z Replacement stickers can be obtained from an authorised dealer or a service
centre.
Maintenance
13
260 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Spare parts
14
261Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
14Spare parts
Chapter overview
This chapter contains important instructions on how to obtain spare parts.
14.1 Spare parts
For safety reasons, spare parts for pieces of equipment must correspond with man-
ufacturer's instructions and be permitted by the manufacturer as a spare part.
These spare parts may only be fitted by the manufacturer or an authorised spe-
cialist workshop. The authorised dealers and service centres are available for any
spare parts requirement.
Here are some suggestions of important spare parts:
z Fuses
z V-belt
z Windscreen blades
z Bulbs
z Water pump (submerged pump)
When ordering spare parts, please indicate the serial number and the vehicle type
to the authorised dealer or service centre.
The vehicle described in this instruction manual is built and equipped to factory
standards. Special equipment is offered depending on its purpose or use. When fit-
ting special equipment check if such equipment has to be entered in the vehicle
documents. Observe the max. permissible gross weight. The authorised dealer or
service centre will be happy to advise you.
X Every alteration of the original condition of the vehicle can alter road behav-
iour and jeopardize road safety.
X The special equipment and original spare parts recommended by
Dethleffs have been specially developed and supplied for your vehicle. These
products are available at the authorised dealers or service centres. The
authorised dealers and service centres are informed about admissible tech-
nical details and carry out the required work correctly.
X The use of accessories, parts and fittings not supplied by Dethleffs may cause
damage to the vehicle and jeopardize road safety. Even if an expert's report,
a general type approval or a design certification exists, there is no guarantee
for the proper quality of the product.
X No liability can be assumed for damage caused by products which have not
been released by Dethleffs. This also applies to impermissible alterations to
the vehicle.
Spare parts
14
262 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Wheels and tyres
15
263Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
15Wheels and tyres
Chapter overview
This chapter contains instructions regarding the tyres of the vehicle.
The instructions address the following topics:
z tyre selection
z handling of tyres
z changing wheels
z spare wheel support
z tyre pressure
At the end of the chapter there is a table you can use to find the correct tyre pres-
sure for your vehicle.
15.1 General
Observe: Check the tyres regularly (every 2 weeks) for equal tread wear, tread depth and
external damage.
Replace tyres at the latest, when the minimum depth of tread stipulated by law
is reached.
Always use tyres of the same model, same brand and same style (summer and
winter tyres).
Only use tyres approved for the wheel rim type fitted. The permitted rim and
tyre sizes are quoted in the vehicle documents and the authorised dealer or
service centre will always be glad to give you advice.
Run-in new tyres for approx. 100 km (60 miles) at low speed since only then do
they reach full strength.
X Check tyre pressure before a journey or every 2 weeks. Wrong tyre pressure
causes excessive wear and can lead to damage or even to tyre burst. You can
lose control of the vehicle.
Z Only check the tyre pressure on cold tyres.
Z Tubeless tyres have been installed on the vehicle. Never install tubes in these
tyres.
Z Read the instruction manual for the base vehicle.
Z Depending on the base vehicle and model the vehicles are equipped with only
one tyre repair kit as standard.
Z In the case of a puncture, pull over to the side of the road. Make vehicle safe with
a hazard warning triangle. Switch on the warning lights.
Z Tyres on vehicles with tandem axles may wear faster.
Z Tyres must not be older than 6 years as the material will become brittle over
time. The four-digit DOT number on the tyre flank indicates the date of manu-
facture. The first two digits designate the week, the last two digits the year of
manufacture.
Example: Week 15, year of manufacture 2009.
Wheels and tyres
15
264 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Check regularly that the wheel nuts or wheel bolts are firmly seated. Re-tighten
the wheel nuts or wheel bolts of a changed wheel cross-wise (Fig. 306) after
50 km (30 miles).
When using new or newly painted rims, re-tighten the wheel nuts or wheel
bolts once again after approx. 1,000 to 5,000 km (600 miles to 3,000 miles).
For lay-ups or long periods of inactivity, keep the tyres and tyre bearings free
from pressure points:
Jack up the vehicle so that the wheels do not bear any load, or move the vehicle
every 4 weeks in such a way that the position of the wheels is changed.
Replace the spare wheel or tyre repair kit respectively regularly.
15.2 Tyre selection
The tyre sizes approved for the vehicle are given in the vehicle documents or can
be obtained from the authorised dealers or service centres. Each tyre must fit the
vehicle on which it will be driven. This applies to the external dimensions (diameter,
width), which are indicated with the standardised size designations. In addition,
the tyres must meet the requirements of the vehicle with regard to weight and
speed.
Weight refers to the maximum permissible axle load which can be distributed on
two tyres. The maximum load-carrying capacity of a tyre is indicated by its load
index (= LI, load index code).
The axle geometry of a vehicle, such as wheel camber and track, is also important
for tyre selection. The maximum permissible speed for a tyre (with full load-car-
rying capacity) is indicated by the speed index (= SI). Together, load index and
speed index form the operating code of a tyre. This is an official component of the
complete, standardised dimensions description which appears on every tyre. The
information on the tyres must correspond to the specifications which appear in the
vehicle papers.
Fig. 306 Tighten the wheel nuts or wheel
bolts cross-wise
X A wrong tyre can damage the tyres during the journey and even cause it to
burst.
Z If tyres that are not approved for the vehicle are used, then the type approval
for the vehicle and subsequently the insurance coverage can lapse. The author-
ised dealer or service centre will be happy to advise you.
Wheels and tyres
15
265Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
15.3 Tyre specifications
15.4 Handling of tyres
Drive over kerbs at an obtuse angle. Otherwise the flanks of the tyres may get
pinched. Driving over a kerb at a sharp angle can damage the tyre and result in
it getting ruptured.
Drive over high manhole covers at a slow speed. Otherwise the tyres may get
pinched. Driving over a high manhole cover at high speed can damage the tyre
and result in it getting ruptured.
Check the shock absorbers regularly. Driving with poor shock absorbers signif-
icantly increases wear.
If the tread wear is uneven, have the toe-in and the wheel camber checked.
Driving with an incorrectly set toe-in or a one-sided wheel camber leads to a sig-
nificant increase in wear.
Avoid block brakings. Block braking gives the tyres "brake plates" of varying
strength. This reduces driving comfort. It might even make the tyres unservice-
able.
Do not clean the tyres with a high-pressure cleaner. The tyres can suffer serious
damage within just a few seconds and rupture as a result.
Drive in such a way as to protect your tyres. Avoid braking sharply, revving up
too strongly and long journeys on poor roads.
Description Explanation
215/70 R 15C 109/107 Q
215 Tyre width in mm
70 Height-to-width proportion in percent
R Tyre design (R = radial)
15 Rim diameter in inches
C Commercial (transporter)
109 Load index code for single tyres
107 Load index code for twin tyres
Q Speed index (Q = 160 km/h)
Wheels and tyres
15
266 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
15.5 Changing wheels
15.5.1 General instructions
15.5.2 Tightening torque
X The vehicle must be on level, firm ground, secure from slipping.
X Go into first gear. In the case of automatic transmission, change gear to "P"
position.
X Before jacking up the vehicle firmly apply the handbrake.
X Prevent the vehicle from rolling away by blocking the opposite wheel with
the wheel chocks.
X Under no circumstances jack the vehicle with the fitted supports.
X If a trailer is connected: Detach the trailer before lifting the vehicle.
X Position the vehicle jack underneath the axle, not under any circumstances
on the bodywork.
X Never overload the vehicle jack. The maximum permissible load is specified
on the vehicle jack's identification plate.
X Use the vehicle jack only for lifting the vehicle briefly while changing the tyre.
X Do not start the motor while the vehicle is jacked up.
X Whilst the vehicle is in a jacked up position, persons must not lie down under
it.
Z Do not damage the thread of the thread bolts when changing the wheel.
Z Tighten the wheel nuts or wheel bolts cross-wise (Fig. 306).
Z When changing wheels (e.g. alloy wheel rims or wheels with winter tyres), use
the correct wheel bolts of the correct length and shape. The firm seating of the
wheels and the function of the braking system depend on this.
Z Wheel rims and tyres not permitted for use with the vehicle can jeopardize road
safety.
Z Do not replace wheels cross-wise.
Z Protect the vehicle according to the national regulations, e.g. with a hazard
warning triangle.
Z Before changing the wheel, check the wheel rim and tyre size, the max. tyre load
and the speed index on the tyres. Only use the wheel rim and tyre sizes stated
in the vehicle documents.
Z Further information can be found in the instruction manual of the base vehicle.
Wheel rim Tightening torque
Steel wheel rim 15" 160 Nm
Steel wheel rim 16" 180 Nm
Alloy wheel rim 15" 130 Nm
Alloy wheel rim 16" 160 Nm
Wheels and tyres
15
267Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
15.6 Spare wheel support
The spare wheel is found on the underside of the vehicle in a basket which can be
opened from the outside.
Removing the spare wheel:
Pull out splint (Fig. 307,4).
Press the clip (Fig. 307,5) against the spare wheel and unhook the holder
(Fig. 307,3).
Move the clip down.
Undo the nut (Fig. 307,2) and remove the spare wheel (Fig. 307,1).
15.7 Tyre pressure
The payload and the durability of tyres is directly dependent on the tyre pressure.
Air is a volatile medium. It is unavoidable that it will escape from tyres.
As a rule of thumb it can be assumed that a filled tyre loses pressure at a rate of
0.1 bar every two months. To prevent the tyres becoming damaged or burst, check
the tyre pressure regularly.
Z For models with a Fiat base vehicle, there is no spare wheel. For these vehicles,
a tyre repair kit is included for inflating the flat tyre with foam.
X Due to its weight and fitted position, the spare wheel can be raised or low-
ered by a very strong person only. Always get a second person to assist.
Fig. 307 Spare wheel support (Iveco)
X Tyres overheat if the tyre pressure is too low. This can cause serious tyre
damage.
X Check tyre pressure before a journey or every 2 weeks. Wrong tyre pressure
causes excessive wear and can lead to damage or even to tyre burst. You can
lose control of the vehicle.
X Use only valves that are approved for the specified tyre pressure.
Z Only check the tyre pressure on cold tyres.
Z The information on pressure levels is valid for cold tyres and loaded vehicles.
Z Pressure in hot tyres is higher than in cold tyres. Therefore, check the pressure
when the tyres are cold.
Wheels and tyres
15
268 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
The vehicles are constantly brought up to the newest technical standards. It is pos-
sible that new tyre sizes are not yet included in this table. If this is the case, the
Dethleffs dealer will be happy to provide the newest values.
Tyre pressure table (depending on the axle loads)
Z Tyre pressures in bar.
Z The valve used must be approved for the air pressure. We recommend the use
of a metal valve for pressures greater than 4.75 bar.
Z For the maximum permissible axle loads for your vehicle please refer to specific
documentation.
Z When a replacement is needed, Dethleffs recommends "Camping" tyres.
Axle loads [kg]
Tyre size Air pres-
sure [bar]
1500 1650 1700 1750 1850 1900
215/70 R15 C
(109/107R)
front 3.1 3.5 3.7 3.75 4.0 4.1
rear 3.1 3.5 3.7 3.75 4.0 4.1
215/70 R15 CP
(109R)
front 3.25 3.6 3.75 3.9 4.25 4.4
rear 3.75 4.25 4.4 4.5 4.9 5.0
225/70 R15 C
(112/110R)
front 3.0 3.1 3.25 3.4 3.6 3.75
rear 3.0 3.1 3.25 3.4 3.6 3.75
215/75 R16 C
(116/114R)
front 3.0 3.1 3.25 3.5 3.7 3.8
rear 3.0 3.1 3.25 3.5 3.7 3.8
225/75 R16 C
(116/114N)
front 3.0 3.0 3.0 3.25 3.3 3.4
rear 3.0 3.0 3.0 3.25 3.3 3.4
225/75 R16 CP
(116R)
front 3.0 3.0 3.0 3.25 3.3 3.4
rear 3.0 3.3 3.5 3.6 3.9 4.0
Axle loads [kg]
Tyre size Air pres-
sure [bar]
1950 2000 2100 2200 2300 2400
215/70 R15 C
(109/107R)
front 4.25 4.5
rear 4.25 4.5
215/70 R15 CP
(109R)
front 4.5 4.75
rear 5.25 5.5
225/70 R15 C
(112/110R)
front 3.9 4.0
rear 3.9 4.0
215/75 R16 C
(116/114R)
front 3.9 4.0 4.25 4.5 4.75 5.0
rear 3.9 4.0 4.25 4.5 4.75 5.0
225/75 R16 C
(116/114N)
front 3.5 3.75 4.0 4.25 4.5 4.75
rear 3.5 3.75 4.0 4.25 4.5 4.75
225/75 R16 CP
(116R)
front 3.5 3.75 4.0 4.25 4.5 4.75
rear 4.1 4.25 4.5 4.75 5.0 5.25
Troubleshooting
16
269Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
16Troubleshooting
Chapter overview
This chapter contains instructions about possible faults in your vehicle.
The faults are listed with their possible causes and corresponding remedies.
The instructions address the following topics:
z braking system
z electrical system
z gas system
z gas cooker
z gas oven
z microwave oven
z heater
z boiler
z refrigerator
z air conditioning unit
z water supply
z toilet
z body
The specified faults can be remedied with relative ease and without a great deal of
specialised knowledge. In the event that the remedies detailed in this instruction
manual should not be successful, an authorised specialist workshop must find and
eliminate the cause of the fault.
16.1 Braking system
16.2 Electrical system
X Have defects on the braking system immediately remedied by an authorised
specialist workshop.
Z When the living area battery is changed, only use batteries of the same type.
Z See chapter 9 for changing the fuses.
Fault Cause Remedy
Road light system does no
longer work correctly
Bulb is defective Replace bulb. Note volts
and watts specifications
Fuse on the transformer/
rectifier is defective
Replace fuse on the trans-
former/rectifier
Interior lighting does not
work
Bulb is defective Replace bulb. Note volts
and watts specifications
Fuse on the transformer/
rectifier is defective
Replace fuse on the trans-
former/rectifier
The electrically operated
entrance step cannot be
moved in or out
Fuse on the transformer/
rectifier is defective
Replace fuse on the trans-
former/rectifier
Troubleshooting
16
270 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
No 240 V power supply de-
spite connection
240 V automatic circuit
breaker has triggered
Switch on the 240 V auto-
matic circuit breaker
Starter or living area bat-
tery is not charged when
operated in 240 V mode
Jumbo flat fuse (40 A) on
the starter or living area
battery is defective
Replace jumbo flat fuse (40
A) on the starter or living
area battery
Charger module in the
transformer/rectifier is de-
fective
Contact customer service
Living area battery is not
charged during vehicle op-
eration
Fuse on terminal D+ of the
alternator is defective
Replace fuse
Disconnector relay in the
transformer/rectifier is de-
fective
Contact customer service
12 V indicator lamp does
not light up
12 V power supply
switched off
Switch 12 V power supply
on
Battery cut-off switch on
the transformer/rectifier is
switched off
Set battery cut-off switch
to on
Starter or living area bat-
tery is not charged
Charge the starter or living
area battery
Disconnector relay in the
transformer/rectifier is de-
fective
Contact customer service
Flat fuse (2 A) in the living
area battery is defective
Replace flat fuse (2 A) in
the living area battery
No display on the panel 12 V power supply
switched off
Switch 12 V power supply
on
Living area battery discon-
nected from the 12 V pow-
er supply
Connect the living area
battery with the 12 V pow-
er supply
Starter or living area bat-
tery is not charged
Charge the starter or living
area battery
Disconnector relay in the
transformer/rectifier is de-
fective
Contact customer service
12 V power supply does
not work
12 V power supply
switched off
Switch 12 V power supply
on
Living area battery discon-
nected from the 12 V pow-
er supply
Connect the living area
battery with the 12 V pow-
er supply
Living area battery is dis-
charged
Charging the living area
battery
Jumbo flat fuse (40 A) on
the living area battery is
defective
Replace jumbo flat fuse (40
A) on the living area bat-
tery
Disconnector relay in the
transformer/rectifier is de-
fective
Contact customer service
Fault Cause Remedy
Troubleshooting
16
271Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
12 V power supply does
not work in 240 V opera-
tion
12 V power supply
switched off
Switch 12 V power supply
on
Living area battery discon-
nected from the 12 V pow-
er supply
Connect the living area
battery with the 12 V pow-
er supply
Charger module in the
transformer/rectifier is de-
fective
Contact customer service
240 V automatic circuit
breaker has triggered
Contact customer service
Jumbo flat fuse (40 A) on
the living area battery is
defective
Replace jumbo flat fuse (40
A) on the living area bat-
tery
Starter battery is dis-
charged in 12 V operation
Disconnector relay in the
transformer/rectifier is de-
fective
Contact customer service
Living area battery discon-
nected from the 12 V pow-
er supply
Connect the living area
battery with the 12 V pow-
er supply
No voltage is supplied by
the living area battery
Living area battery is dis-
charged
Charge living area battery
immediately
Z Total discharge
damages the
battery.
If the vehicle is to be laid
up for a long period, fully
charge the living area bat-
tery beforehand
No output voltage at the
converter ("Power Status"
LED shows a fault)
Input voltage too high
(rapid flashing)
Check input voltage
Input voltage too low
(slow flashing)
Recharge battery
Check cables and connec-
tions
Thermal overload (periodi-
cal flashing)
Switch off converter and
appliances, and switch
back on again after approx.
5 to 10 minutes
Improve ventilation
Short circuit, incorrect po-
larity or excessive continu-
ous load (continuous
lighting)
Switch off the converter
and remove the appliance.
If no fault occurs after
switching back on without
an appliance, it is the appli-
ance that is defective. If the
fault still occurs, contact
customer service.
Fault Cause Remedy
Troubleshooting
16
272 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
16.3 Gas system
Extractor hood does not
work
240 V automatic circuit
breaker is switched off
Switch on the 240 V auto-
matic circuit breaker
12 V supply device
switched off
Switch on 12 V supply de-
vice on the panel
Power pack is defective Contact customer service
Fuse (15 A) on the 240 V
fuse box is defective
Replace fuse (15 A)
Fuse (15 A) at the trans-
former/rectifier is defective
Replace fuse (15 A)
Extractor hood defective Contact customer service
Air conditioning unit can-
not be switched on or off
240 V automatic circuit
breaker has triggered
Switch on the 240 V auto-
matic circuit breaker
Remote control battery is
empty
Change remote control
battery
X In case of a defect of the gas system (gas odour, high gas consumption) there
is danger of explosion! Close regulator tap on the gas bottle immediately.
Open doors and windows and ventilate well.
X If the gas system is defective: Do not smoke; do not ignite any open flames,
and do not operate electric switches (light switches etc.).
X Have the defective gas system repaired by an authorised specialist work-
shop.
Fault Cause Remedy
No gas Gas bottle is empty Change gas bottle
Gas isolator tap closed Open the gas isolator tap
Regulator tap on the gas
bottle is closed
Open regulator tap on the
gas bottle
External temperature is too
low (-42 °C for propane
gas, 0 °C for butane gas)
Wait for higher external
temperatures
Built-in appliance is defec-
tive
Contact customer service
Fault Cause Remedy
Troubleshooting
16
273Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
16.4 Cooker
16.4.1 Gas cooker/gas oven
16.4.2 Microwave oven
16.5 Heater/boiler
In the event of a defect contact the nearest customer service workshop of the rele-
vant appliance manufacturer. The list of addresses is enclosed with the accompa-
nying appliance documentation. Only authorised qualified personnel may repair
the appliance.
Fault Cause Remedy
Ignition fuse does not op-
erate (flame does not burn
after the control knobs are
released)
Heat-up time is too short Keep control knob pressed
for approx. 15 to
20 seconds after ignition
Ignition fuse is defective Contact customer service
Flame extinguishes when
being reduced to its mini-
mum setting
Thermocouple sensor is in-
correctly set
Correctly reset thermocou-
ple sensor (do not bend).
The sensor tip should pro-
trude by 5 mm beyond the
burner. The sensor neck
should not be more than
3 mm away from the burn-
er ring; if necessary, con-
tact customer service
X Only qualified personnel may repair the microwave oven. Improper repairs
can cause major risks to the user.
Fault Cause Remedy
Microwave oven does not
cut in
Fuse is defective Replace fuse
Door of the microwave
oven is not properly closed
Remove foreign bodies
stuck in the door of the mi-
crowave oven and close
door properly
Troubleshooting
16
274 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
16.5.1 Heater/boiler Truma
Fault Cause Remedy
Heater does not ignite Temperature sensor on op-
erating unit or remote sen-
sor defective
Pull out plug on operating
unit. The heating then
works without thermostat.
Contact the customer serv-
ice as soon as possible
Red indicator lamp "Fault"
illuminates
Air in the gas pipe system Switch off and on again.
After two futile ignition at-
tempts, wait for
10 minutes before trying
again
Lack of gas Open regulator tap and
gas isolator tap
Connect a full gas bottle
Defect of a safety element Contact customer service
Red indicator lamp "Fault"
is flashing
Operating voltage too low Charge or replace the liv-
ing area battery (or have it
charged or replaced)
Green indicator lamp be-
hind knob is not lit
Fuse on the transformer/
rectifier is defective
Replace fuse on the trans-
former/rectifier
Fuse in the electronic con-
trol unit has been trig-
gered
Contact customer service
Living area battery defec-
tive
Charge or replace the liv-
ing area battery (or have it
charged or replaced)
Yellow indicator lamp on
the energy selector switch
does not illuminate
No supply voltage Check 240 V connection
and fuses
Overheating switch was
triggered
Press overheating switch
Boiler empties, safety/
drainage valve has opened
Internal temperature be-
low 7 °C
Heat inside
Safety/drainage valve sep-
arated from battery supply
Cancel battery separation.
In order to do this switch
on the battery cut-off
switch on the transformer/
rectifier or deactivate the
battery separation via the
panel
Operating voltage below
10.8 V
Charge or replace the liv-
ing area battery (or have it
charged or replaced)
Fuse is defective Replace fuse on the trans-
former/rectifier
Troubleshooting
16
275Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
16.5.2 Alde heater/boiler
Safety/drainage valve does
not close when switching
on
Safety/drainage valve sep-
arated from battery supply
Cancel battery separation.
In order to do this switch
on the battery cut-off
switch on the transformer/
rectifier or deactivate the
battery separation via the
panel
Operating voltage below
10.8 V
Charge living area battery
(or have it charged)
Fuse is defective Replace fuse on the trans-
former/rectifier
Red and green indicator
lamps are not lit
Fuse is defective Replace fuse on the trans-
former/rectifier
Fan wheel runs noisily or
not steadily
Fan wheel is soiled Contact Truma service de-
partment
Z If a fault occurs in the system, the cause is shown on the display.
Fault Cause Remedy
Heater does not ignite with
gas operation
Lack of gas Open regulator tap and
gas isolator tap
Connect a full gas bottle
Heater does not ignite Battery voltage too low Charge battery. If the bat-
tery voltage rises above
11 V, the heater is switched
on automatically
Heater does not ignite at
240 V electrical operation
No 240 V power supply Switch on the 240 V auto-
matic circuit breaker
Connect 240 V power sup-
ply
Heater switches off Overheating Allow the heater to cool.
To reset the display, inter-
rupt the 12 V power supply
to the heater and switch it
back on again
Heater running, but no
heat at the convectors
Circulating pump does not
work
Switch on room thermo-
stat
Contact customer service
Heater and circulating
pump running, but no heat
at the convectors
Air in the heating system Bleed hot-water heater
Fault Cause Remedy
Troubleshooting
16
276 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
16.5.3 Heater/Boiler Webasto
If a fault occurs, a fault message is output at the operating element/fault message
indicator through flash pulses. 5 rapid GREEN flashes are followed by the indication
of the fault message through a series of long RED flash pulses. This sequence is
repeated until the heater is switched off. The following table lists the number of
RED flash pulses and their meaning. Afterwards a sequence of 5 rapid GREEN flash
pulses is shown again.
Z If a fault occurs, first check whether the fuses and plug connections are in a
good state and connected properly. If this does not eliminate the fault, the
heater has to be checked by Webasto-trained personnel.
Z Number of red flash pulses 0 to 15: Heater switches off automatically.
17 red flash pulses: No switching off, but the flash pulses indicate a fault.
Number of RED flash
pulses
Meaning Remedy
00 No communication be-
tween operating element
and heater or operating el-
ement fault
Check fuses and wire har-
ness
Contact the Webasto Serv-
ice Center
01 No start (after 2 attempts
to start)
Check the fuel supply and
reset the heater (switch off
for at least 30 seconds)
02 Flame interruption
Renewed start not success-
ful
Check the fuel supply and
reset the heater (switch off
for at least 30 seconds)
03 Undervoltage or overvolt-
age
Charge the battery or con-
nect to a different power
supply (direct current, 12
V), reset the heater (switch
off for at least 5 seconds)
04 Fuel pump interruption /
short-circuit / overheating
Check the fuel pump cable
and plug. Check for over-
heating (see Faults 06 and
07), reset the heater
(switch off for at least 5
seconds)
05 Heating fan motor fault: In-
terruption / short-circuit /
fan speed not within per-
missible range / fan
blocked
Ensure that the heating air
fan can move freely, re-
move any interfering or
blocking object, reset the
heater (switch off for at
least 5 seconds)
06 Overheating or exceeded
value of water tempera-
ture sensor
Check the water level, re-
set the heater (switch off
for at least 5 seconds), or
select Winter operation,
heating without water
heating
07 Overheating Ensure that the heating air
can flow freely, and that air
inlets and outlets are not
blocked. Reset the heater
(switch off for at least
5 seconds)
Troubleshooting
16
277Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
08 Overheating of control
unit of the heater
Ensure that cooling air can
circulate freely, reset the
heater (switch off for at
least 5 seconds)
09 Combustion air motor
fault: Interruption / short-
circuit / overload / block-
ing
Ensure that the cooling air
fan can move freely, re-
move and interfering or
blocking objects. Check
the 15 A fuse (red line).
10 Control unit fault / heater
blocked
Put the heater back into
operation and restart the
heater.
Contact the Webasto Serv-
ice Center
11 Interior temperature sen-
sor interruption or short-
circuit
Check the cable routing,
avoid pinching or breaks,
check the plugged connec-
tion behind the operating
element. Reset the heater
(switch off for at least
5 seconds)
12 Heating air temperature
sensor interruption / short-
circuit
Reset the heater (switch
off for at least 5 seconds)
Contact the Webasto Serv-
ice Center
13 Water temperature sensor
interruption / short-circuit
See Fault message 12
14 Glow plug / flame detector
interruption / short-circuit
See Fault message 12
15 Premature flame recogni-
tion
See Fault message 12
17 Electrical safety/drainage
valve interruption or short-
circuit
See Fault message 12
Number of RED flash
pulses
Meaning Remedy
Troubleshooting
16
278 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
16.6 Refrigerator
In the event of a defect contact the nearest customer service workshop of the rele-
vant appliance manufacturer. The list of addresses is enclosed with the accompa-
nying appliance documentation. Only authorised qualified personnel may repair
the appliance.
16.6.1 Dometic refrigerator without AES
Fault Cause Remedy
Refrigerator does not
switch on when operating
in 240 V mode
No 240 V power supply Connect 240 V power sup-
ply
240 V automatic circuit
breaker has triggered
Switch on the 240 V auto-
matic circuit breaker
240 V operating voltage
too low
Have the 240 V power sup-
ply checked by an author-
ised specialist workshop
Refrigerator does not
switch on when operating
in 12 V mode
Jumbo flat fuse (40 A) in
the starter battery is defec-
tive
Replace jumbo flat fuse
(40 A) in the starter battery
Flat fuse (2 A) in the starter
battery is defective
Replace flat fuse (2 A) in
the starter battery
Disconnector relay in the
transformer/rectifier is de-
fective
Contact customer service
12 V operating voltage too
low
Have the 12 V power sup-
ply checked by an author-
ised specialist workshop
Refrigerator does not
switch on when operating
in gas mode
The "GAS" operating indi-
cator flashes yellow
Lack of gas Open regulator tap and
gas isolator tap
Connect a full gas bottle
Air in the gas pipe Repeat ignition 3 or
4 times
Cobwebs or burnt residue
in the burning chamber
Remove the ventilation
grill on the outside of the
vehicle and clean the burn-
ing chamber
Troubleshooting
16
279Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
16.6.2 Thetford refrigerator without SES (error diagnostics)
Error code Cause Remedy
1 The 240 V power supply is
75 % under the required oper-
ating voltage
Contact customer service
2 The 12 V power supply is 75 %
under the required operating
voltage
Contact customer service
3 The refrigerator is operated at
240 V, even though no 240 V
mode has been selected
Contact customer service
4 The refrigerator is operated at
12 V, even though no 12 V
mode has been selected
Contact customer service
5 The refrigerator is operated in
gas operation mode even
though gas operation mode
has not been selected
Contact customer service
6 The gas valve has been identi-
fied as open even though it
should be closed
Contact customer service
7 The gas valve has been identi-
fied as closed even though it
should be open
Contact customer service
8 The 240 V power supply is
20 % under the required oper-
ating voltage
Check 240 V power supply
9 The gas supply has been cut
off. The flame has not been ig-
nited within 30 seconds in gas
operation mode
z Check the gas supply
z Repeat ignition 3 to 4 times
z Contact customer service
10 The refrigerator is set to 12 V
mode and the vehicle engine
is not running
Start the vehicle engine or se-
lect a different energy source
11 The refrigerator is set to "AU-
TO" mode and no energy
source is available
Provide an energy source and
reset the refrigerator. Switch
the refrigerator off and on
again for this purpose
12 Contact customer service
13 The temperature sensor is de-
fective
Check whether the plug is in-
serted properly above the fin
inside the refrigerator. If so:
Contact customer service
14 The connection between oper-
ating controls and control de-
vice is interrupted
Contact customer service
Troubleshooting
16
280 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
16.6.3 Dometic 8 series with MES
Z In the case of a fault the LED display fault will always light up " ".
Fault Cause Remedy
LED " " flashes No 240 V power supply Connect 240 V power sup-
ply
240 V automatic circuit
breaker has triggered
Switch on the 240 V auto-
matic circuit breaker
240 V operating voltage
too low
Have the 240 V power sup-
ply checked by an author-
ised specialist workshop
LED " " flashes Fuse on the transformer/
rectifier is defective
Replace fuse on the trans-
former/rectifier
Disconnector relay in the
transformer/rectifier is de-
fective
Contact customer service
12 V operating voltage too
low
Have the 12 V power sup-
ply checked by an author-
ised specialist workshop
LED " " flashes
Lack of gas Open regulator tap and
gas isolator tap
Connect a full gas bottle
Cobwebs or burnt residue
in the burning chamber
Remove the ventilation
grill on the outside of the
vehicle and clean the burn-
ing chamber
LEDs for display of the
temperature range flash
Temperature sensor defec-
tive
Contact customer service
LED " " and LEDs for dis-
play of the temperature
range flash
240 V heater element de-
fective
Contact customer service
LED " " and LEDs for dis-
play of the temperature
range flash
12 V heater element defec-
tive
Contact customer service
Troubleshooting
16
281Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
16.6.4 Dometic 8 series with AES
16.7 Air conditioning unit
Z In the case of a fault the LED display fault will always light up " ".
Fault Cause Remedy
Text "240 V" flashes No 240 V power supply Connect 240 V power sup-
ply
240 V automatic circuit
breaker has triggered
Switch on the 240 V auto-
matic circuit breaker
240 V operating voltage
too low
Have the 240 V power sup-
ply checked by an author-
ised specialist workshop
Text "12 V" flashes Fuse on the transformer/
rectifier is defective
Replace fuse on the trans-
former/rectifier
Disconnector relay in the
transformer/rectifier is de-
fective
Contact customer service
12 V operating voltage too
low
Have the 12 V power sup-
ply checked by an author-
ised specialist workshop
Text "GAS" flashes Lack of gas Open regulator tap and
gas isolator tap
Connect a full gas bottle
Cobwebs or burnt residue
in the burning chamber
Remove the ventilation
grill on the outside of the
vehicle and clean the burn-
ing chamber
LEDs for display of the
temperature range flash
Temperature sensor defec-
tive
Contact customer service
Text "HE1" flashes 240 V heater element de-
fective
Contact customer service
Text "HE2" flashes 12 V heater element defec-
tive
Contact customer service
Fault Cause Remedy
Air conditioning unit does
not cool
No 240 V power supply Connect 240 V power sup-
ply
Fuse is defective Check fuse and replace if
necessary
Temperature below 16 °C
Temperature has been set
incorrectly
Adjust the temperature
Air filter contaminated Replace air filter
Troubleshooting
16
282 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
16.8 Water supply
Fault Cause Remedy
Leakage water inside the
vehicle
A leak has occurred Identify leak, re-connect
water pipes
No water Water tank is empty Replenish drinking water
Drain cock not closed Close drain cock
12 V power supply
switched off
Switch 12 V power supply
on
Fuse of the water pump is
defective
Replace fuse on the trans-
former/rectifier
Water pump defective Exchange water pump
(have it exchanged)
Water pipe snapped off Straighten water pipe or
replace
Transformer/rectifier de-
fective
Contact customer service
Water pump switched off
on panel
Switch water pump on
Toilet has no flush water Water tank is empty Replenish drinking water
Fuse for toilet is defective Replace fuse
Display for water and
waste water indicates a
wrong value
Measuring probe in the
waste water or water tank
is soiled
Clean water/waste water
tank
Measuring probe is defec-
tive
Replace measuring probe
Waste water tank cannot
be emptied
Drain cock is clogged Open the cleaning cap on
the waste water tank and
drain the waste water.
Rinse the waste water tank
well
Drain on the single lever
mixer tap is clogged
Perlator calcified Unclip the perlator, de-cal-
cify in vinegar water (only
for products made from
metal)
Water jets on the shower
nozzle clogged
Water jets calcified De-calcify shower nozzle in
vinegar water (only for
products made from met-
al) or rub off soft nozzle
burling
Water drains from the
shower tray slowly or does
not drain at all
The vehicle is not in a hori-
zontal position
Position the vehicle hori-
zontally
Milkiness of the water Tank filled with dirty water Clean water tank mechani-
cally and chemically; then
disinfect and rinse copi-
ously with drinking water
Residues in the water tank
or water system
Clean water system me-
chanically and chemically;
then disinfect and rinse co-
piously with drinking wa-
ter
Troubleshooting
16
283Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
16.9 Body
Any change in the taste or
odour of the water
Tank filled with dirty water Clean water system me-
chanically and chemically;
then disinfect and rinse co-
piously with drinking wa-
ter
Fuel filled into the water
tank by mistake
Contact a specialist work-
shop
Microbiological deposits in
the water system
Clean water system me-
chanically and chemically;
then disinfect and rinse co-
piously with drinking wa-
ter
Deposits in the water tank
and/or water-carrying
components
Water excessively long in
the water tank and in wa-
ter-carrying components
Clean water system me-
chanically and chemically;
then disinfect and rinse co-
piously with drinking wa-
ter
Fault Cause Remedy
Flap hinges/door hinges
are difficult to operate
Flap/door hinges are not
sufficiently lubricated
Lubricate flap hinges/door
hinges with acid-free and
resin-free grease
Hinges/joints in the bath-
room unit/toilet compart-
ment are difficult to
operate/make a grating
noise
Hinges/joints are not suffi-
ciently lubricated
Lubricate hinges/joints
with solvent-free and acid-
free grease
Z Spray cans often
contain solvents
Storage compartment
hinges are difficult to oper-
ate/make a grating noise
Storage compartment
hinges are not sufficiently
lubricated
Lubricate storage com-
partment hinges with acid-
free and resin-free grease
Front bonnet swivel sys-
tem is difficult to operate
Front bonnet swivel sys-
tem is not (sufficiently) lu-
bricated
Lubricate front bonnet
swivel system with acid-
free and resin-free grease
Heki skylight difficult to
operate
Threaded spindle not lubri-
cated
Lubricate threaded spindle
Threaded spindle defective Have threaded spindle re-
placed
Z The authorised dealers and service centres are available for any spare parts
requirement.
Fault Cause Remedy
Troubleshooting
16
284 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Special equipment
17
285Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
17Special equipment
17.1 Weight details for special equipment
Weight details for Dethleffs special equipment are listed in the table below. If these
objects are either carried in or on the vehicle and are not part of the standard
equipment, they must be taken into consideration when calculating the payload.
All weight details are approximate.
Observe the max. permissible gross weight.
X The use of accessories, parts and fittings not supplied by Dethleffs may cause
damage to the vehicle and jeopardize road safety. Even if an expert's report,
a general type approval or a design certification exists, there is no guarantee
for the proper quality of the product.
X Every alteration of the original condition of the vehicle can alter road behav-
iour and jeopardize road safety.
X No liability can be assumed for damage caused by products which have not
been released by Dethleffs. This also applies to impermissible alterations to
the vehicle.
Item designation Surplus weight (kg)
Waste water tank, insulated 2
Overcab bed, foldable 2
Alcove window, hinged 2
Caravan coupling 26-46
Hinged window, driver's cabin 8
External shower 1
Outside kitchen 10
Outside storage compartment (lowered rear) 59-63
Outside storage compartment (storage compartment) 3
Automatic transmission 17-32
Car radio and CD 2
Oven 14
Chassis package (driver's cabin air conditioning unit, air-
bags)
23-27
Skylight (clear glass) 1
Skylight (Midi-Heki) 10
Roof rail 10
Roof racks 15-20
"Kissenschlacht" (pillow fight) decoration package 1
Swivel console, seat 20
Extractor hood 2-5
Duo switching facility (incl. gas bottle) 26
Entrance step, electrical 2
Driver's cabin carpet 3
Driver's cabin door 17
Bike rack for 3 bicycles 9
Special equipment
17
286 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Bike rack for 4 bicycles 10
Roman shades, driver's cabin 3
Fire extinguisher 6 kg 8
Flat screen 4-6
Floor warming unit, electrical 9
External gas socket 1
Holder for flat screen 3-5
Lift-tilt skylight (Heki 3) 12-15
Trumatic C 6002 heater, electric kit 2
Insect screen door 3
Insulation mat for driver's cabin window 2
Air conditioning unit 32-40
Refrigerator, separate freezer compartment 7-20
Awning 300 cm 21
Awning 350 cm 25-35
Awning 400 cm 27-40
Awning 450 cm 32
Awning 500 cm 36
Awning 600 cm 40
Microwave oven 15
Motorcycle rack/bike rack 40
Navigation system (with cables) 9
Guest bed 3-5
Pilot seats 20
Crossbeam, roof rail 7
Radio preparation 4
Wheel trims 4
Smoke alarm 1
Reversing camera, incl. monitor and cables 5-10
Diesel particulate filter 10
Satellite unit 15-24
Switch for water pump 1
Coil springs, front, reinforced 5
Service flap 3-8
Safety kit 5
Seat covers in the driver's cabin and living area 3
Solar installation 15
Voltage transformer, air conditioning unit 3
Supports (2 pieces) 6-10
Item designation Surplus weight (kg)
Special equipment
17
287Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Chain-stitch rug, laid loosely 6-9
Table leg, free-standing 5
Sill 8
Panelling, inside 2
Awning light 1
Alde hot-water heater 30-50
Hazard warning triangle and first-aid kit 2
Alde heat exchanger 2-5
Winter covering for the refrigerator grating 1
Winter comfort package (depending on equipment) 15-75
Auxiliary battery 27
Additional heater, driver's cabin (independent vehicle
heater)
7
Auxiliary lamps, inside 2
Additional pump for the Alde heater 1
Auxiliary heat exchanger (Arizona) 3
Item designation Surplus weight (kg)
Special equipment
17
288 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Helpful notes
18
289Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
18Helpful notes
Chapter overview
This chapter contains helpful tips for your journey.
The instructions address the following topics:
z traffic rules in Germany
z Road assistance in European countries
z Traffic rules in European countries
z Gas supply in European countries
z Toll regulations in European countries
z Safe ways to spend the night during travel
z Camping in winter
At the end of the chapter there is a checklist containing the most important equip-
ment for your trip.
18.1 Dethleffs travel tips on the iPhone
18.2 The most important information for motorhomes
18.2.1 Traffic rules in Germany
Z The information provided in this chapter is also available as an iPhone app. For
further information please refer to the Dethleffs Web site and the Apple App
Store.
Z Use the adjacent QR-Code to directly access the down-
load option for the Dethleffs app in the Apple App Store.
Vehicles up to
2.8 t
1)
Vehicles from
2.8 to 3.5 t
1)
Vehicles over
3.5 t
1)
Maximum speed
Within built-up areas 50 km/h 50 km/h 50 km/h
Outside built-up areas 100 km/h 100 km/h 80 km/h/
100 km/h
2)
Motorway Recommended speed: 130 km/h 80 km/h/
100 km/h
3)
Helpful notes
18
290 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Specifications without guarantee
18.2.2 Traffic rules in foreign countries
Information about the traffic rules is particularly important, since the respective
country's laws apply in case of accidents or damage. For your own safety always
observe the following points when travelling abroad:
z Have your green insurance card on you.
z Take an "Accident report" form from your insurance with you.
z Always have the police record the accident.
z Do not sign documents that you have not read and understood completely.
18.2.3 Parking
Overtaking for-
bidden
For vehicles ex-
ceeding 3.5 t
1)
Not applicable Not applicable Applicable
Travelling pro-
hibited
For vehicles ex-
ceeding 3.5 t
1)
Not applicable Not applicable Applicable
Travelling with-
out minimum
distance prohib-
ited
Not applicable Not applicable Applicable
when vehicle
travelling
ahead ex-
ceeds 3.5 t
1)
1)
Maximum permissible gross weight
2)
On roads for motor vehicles, for motorhomes with a maximum permissible gross weight
of between 3.5 t and 7.5 t
3)
For motorhomes with a maximum permissible gross weight of between 3.5 t and 7.5 t
Vehicles up to
2.8 t
1)
Vehicles from
2.8 to 3.5 t
1)
Vehicles over
3.5 t
1)
Z The vehicle driver is required to inform himself as to the traffic rules of the coun-
tries in which he plans to travel before beginning the trip. Information is avail-
able, for example, from the automobile clubs or the country representatives.
Z In some European countries warning vests must be worn when exiting the
vehicle outside of towns in the case of vehicle failures or accidents.
Z Within built-up areas vehicles with a maximum permissible gross weight
exceeding 2.8 t have to be made visible with an own light source at the front
and rear on the roadway side. A reflecting parking warning sign (size 423 x
423 mm) may be used instead. The parking warning sign may only be mounted
while the vehicle is stopped. The upper edge of the parking warning sign may
not be located at more than 1200 mm. Reflectors and licence plates may not be
covered by the parking warning sign.
Helpful notes
18
291Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Specifications without guarantee
Parking vehicles in public are-
as
Vehicles up to
2.8 t
1)
1)
Maximum permissible gross weight
Vehicles from
2.8 to 3.5 t
1)
Vehicles over
3.5 t
1)
Basically Allowed if not restricted by traffic signs
On pavements with parking area
markings
Parking
allowed
Parking not allowed
Parking for all
types of vehicles
Parking allowed
Parking on
pavements
Parking
allowed
Parking not allowed
Supplementary
signs:
Only passenger
cars
Parking not allowed
Supplementary
signs:
Only mo-
torhomes
Parking allowed
Supplementary
signs:
Only motor ve-
hicles over
3.5 t
1)
Parking not allowed Parking
allowed
Supplementary
signs:
Only for com-
mercial vehicles
with trailer
Parking not allowed
Supplementary
signs:
Only passenger
cars with trailer
Parking not allowed
Supplementary
signs:
Only for buses
and coaches
Parking not allowed
Stopping vehicles under
darkness
Within built-up areas Not applicable Not applicable Own light
source or
warning sign
Outside built-up areas Own light
source (park-
ing light)
Own light
source (park-
ing light)
Own light
source (park-
ing light)
Helpful notes
18
292 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
18.2.4 Official inspections
Specifications without guarantee
18.2.5 Emergency equipment
Specifications without guarantee
18.3 Help on Europe's roads
Vehicles up to
2.8 t
1)
1)
Maximum permissible gross weight
Vehicles from
2.8 to 3.5 t
1)
Vehicles over
3.5 t
1)
General inspection (HU)
TÜV/DEKRA with exhaust
emission test
First HU after
36 months;
thereafter eve-
ry 24 months
First HU after
36 months;
thereafter eve-
ry 24 months
24 months;
from the
7th year on:
12 months
Inspection of gas system
(through gas specialist)
24 months 24 months 24 months
Vehicles up to
2.8 t
1)
1)
Maximum permissible gross weight
Vehicles from
2.8 to 3.5 t
1)
Vehicles over
3.5 t
1)
The following has to be carried
on the vehicle:
First-aid kit,
hazard warn-
ing triangle
First-aid kit,
hazard warn-
ing triangle
First-aid kit,
hazard warn-
ing triangle,
flashing haz-
ard warning
triangle
Country
German embassy
Emergency
services
Police
Auto club emergency call
Breakdown service
Belgium
Brussels
+32 2 7 87 18 00
100/112
101/112
ADAC Munich +49 89 22 22 22
TCB Brussels +32 2 2 33 22 11
Bulgaria
Sofia
+359 2 91 83 80
112/150
112
ADAC Sofia +30 21 08 93 77 77
UAB Sofia +359 2 935 79 35
1)
Denmark
Copenhagen
+45 35 45 99 00
112
112
ADAC Copenhagen +45 93 17 08/
FDM +45 27 07 07
Germany 112
110
ADAC Munich +49 89 76 76 70
ADAC +49 1802 22 22 22/
22 22 22
1)
Estonia
Tallinn
+372 6 27 53 00
112
112
ADAC Munich +49 89 22 22 22
EAK +372 6 97 91 00
Finland
Helsinki
+358 9 45 85 80
112
112
ADAC Munich +49 89 22 22 22
2)
Autoliitto Helsinki
+358 9 77 47 64 00
Helpful notes
18
293Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
France
Paris
+33 1 53 83 45 00
112
112
ADAC Munich +49 89 22 22 22
ADAC Lyon +33 8 25 80 08 22
Greece
Athens
+30 21 07 28 51 11
112
112
ADAC Athens +30 21 08 93 77 77
ELPA +30 21 06 06 88 00
Great Britain
London
+44 20 78 24 13 00
112
112
ADAC Munich +49 89 22 22 22
AA +44 87 05 44 88 66
Ireland
Dublin
+353 1 2 69 30 11
112
112
ADAC Munich +49 89 22 22 22
AA Dublin +353 1 6 17 99 99
Iceland
Reykjavík
+354 5 30 11 00
112
112
ADAC Munich +49 89 22 22 22
F.I.B +354 4 14 99 99
Italy
Rome
+39 6 49 21 31
112
112
ADAC Munich +49 89 22 22 22
+39 06 4 99 81
Croatia
Zagreb
+385 1 6 30 01 00
112
112
ADAC Zagreb +385 1 3 44 06 66
HAK +385 1 661 19 99
Latvia
Riga
+371 67 08 51 00
112
112
ADAC Munich +49 89 22 22 22
LAMB +371 67 56 62 22
Lithuania
Vilnius
+370 52 10 64 00
112
112
ADAC Munich +49 89 22 22 22
LAS +370 5,210 44 33
Luxembourg
Luxembourg
+ 352 45 34 45-1
112
112
ADAC Munich +49 89 22 22 22
ACL +352 4 50 04 51
Macedonia
Skopje
+389 2 3 09 39 00
194
192
ADAC +381 11 3 33 11 11
AMSM +389 2 318 11 81
Montenegro
Podgorica
+382 20 44 10 00
94
92
ADAC Zagreb +385 1 3 44 06 55
AMSCG +382 20 23 49 99
Netherlands
The Hague
+31 70 3 42 06 00
112
112
ADAC Assen +31 592 39 05 60
ANWB +31 88 2 69 71 47
Norway
Oslo
+47 23 27 54 00
113
112
ADAC Munich +49 89 22 22 22
NAF +47 92 60 85 05
Austria
Vienna
+43 1 7 11 54
112
112
ADAC Munich +49 89 22 22 22
ÖAMTC Wien +43 1 71 19 90
ARBÖ +43 1 23
Country
German embassy
Emergency
services
Police
Auto club emergency call
Breakdown service
Helpful notes
18
294 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Poland
Warsaw
+48 22 5 84 17 00
112
112
ADAC Munich +49 89 22 22 22
PZM +48 22 8 49 93 61
Portugal
Lisbon
+351 21 8 81 02 10
112
112
ADAC Munich +49 89 22 22 22
ACP +351 213 18 01 00
Romania
Bucharest
+40 21 2 02 98 30
112
112
ADAC Munich +49 89 22 22 22
ACR +40 21 3 15 55 10
Russia
Moscow
+7 495 9 37 95 00
03
02
ADAC abroad +1049 89 22 22 22
RAS +7 495 6 29 07 07
Sweden
Stockholm
+46 8 6 70 15 00
112
112
ADAC Munich +49 89 22 22 22
MR +46 8 690 38 00
Switzerland
Bern
+41 31 3 59 41 11
112
112
ADAC Munich +49 89 22 22 22
TCS +41 22 417 27 27
Serbia
Belgrade
+381 11 3 06 43 00
194
192
ADAC Belgrade +381 11 3 33 11 11
AMSS (011) 3 33 11 00
Slovakia
Bratislava
+421 2 59 20 44 00
112
112
ADAC Munich +49 89 22 22 22
SATC +421 2 68 24 92 11
Slovenia
Ljubljana
+386 1 4 79 03 00
112
112
ADAC Zagreb
+385 1 3 44 06 50
AMZS +386 1 5 30 51 00
Spain
Madrid
+34 91 5 57 90 95
112
112
ADAC Barcelona
+34 93 5 08 28 28
RACE +34 9 02 40 45 45
Czech Republic
Prague
+420 2 57 11 31 11
112
112
ADAC Prague +420 2 61 10 43 51
UAMK CR +420 261 104 111
Turkey
Ankara
+90 312 4 55 51 00
112
155
ADAC emergency call from abroad
(0216) 999 1010
+90 216 9 99 10 10
TTOK +90 212 282 81 40
Hungary
Budapest
+36 6 14 88 35 00
112
112
ADAC Munich +49 89 22 22 22
MAK +36 1 3 45 18 00
Cyprus
Nicosia
+357 22 45 11 45
112
112
ADAC Athens
+30 21 08 93 77 77
AA +357 22 31 32 33
1)
In the mobile communication network
Country
German embassy
Emergency
services
Police
Auto club emergency call
Breakdown service
Helpful notes
18
295Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Date 08/2013
Specifications without guarantee
18.4 Speed limits and permissible dimensions
For information, the speed limits (in km/h) and permissible dimensions (in m) of the
countries visited most:
2)
Dialling code to Germany can also be 9 901 49, 9 94 49 or 9 99 49, depending on the
telecommunications provider
X Please always observe the speed limits in the individual countries.
Country Max. dimen-
sions in meters
Gross
weight
Built-
up ar-
eas
Outside
built-up ar-
eas
Motor-
way
Width Leng-
ht
Belgium 2,50 12 Up to 7,5 t
Over 7,5 t
50
50
90/120
1)
60/90
1)
120
90
Bulgaria 2,55 12 Up to 3,5 t
Over 3,5 t
50
50
90
70
130
100
Denmark 2,55 12 Up to 3,5 t
Over 3,5 t
50
50
80/90
1)
70
130
80
Germany 2,55 12 Up to 3,5 t
3,5 t up to
7,5 t
Over 7.5 t
2)
50
50
50
100/130
1) 3)
80
80
130
3)
100
80
Estonia 2,55 12 Up to 3,5 t
Over 3,5 t
50
50
90/110
1) 4)
70
Finland 2,60 12 50
80/100
5)
80/100
5)
France 2,55 12 Up to 3,5 t
Over 3,5 t
50
50
90/110
1) 6) 7)
80/90
1) 6)
130
6) 7)
90
6)
Greece 2,50 12 50
90/110
20)
120/
130
20)
United
Kingdom
2,55 12 48
96/112
1)
112
Ireland 2,50 12 Up to 3,5 t
Over 3,5 t
50
50
80/100
1)
80
120
80
Iceland 2,55 12 50
90
8)
Italy 2,50 12 Up to 3,5 t
Over 3,5 t
50
50
90/110
1) 9)
80
130
9)
100
Croatia 2,55 12 50
90/110
1)
130
Helpful notes
18
296 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Latvia 2,50 12 Up to 7,5 t
Over 7,5 t
50
10)
50
10)
90
11) 20)
/
110
1) 12)
80/
90
1) 11) 13)
Lithuania 2,50 12 Up to 3,5 t
Over 3,5 t
50
50
90
14)
/
100
1) 4)
80
14)
110
4)
90
Luxem-
bourg
2,50 12 Up to 3,5 t
Over 3,5 t
50
50
90
15) 9)
75
9)
130
15) 9)
90
9)
Macedonia 2,50 12 Up to 3,5 t
Over 3,5 t
50
50
80/100
1)
80
Montene-
gro
2,50 12 Up to 3,5 t
Over 3,5 t
50
50
80/100
1)
80
Nether-
lands
2,55
16)
12 Up to 3,5 t
Over 3,5 t
50
50
80/100
1)
80
120
80
Norway 2,55 12,40 Up to 3,5 t
Over 3,5 t
50
50
80/90
1) 20)
80
90
20)
80
Austria 2,55 12 Up to 3,5 t
Over 3,5 t
50
50
100
70
130
17)
80
Poland 2,55 12 Up to 3,5 t
Over 3,5 t
50
18)
50
18)
90/100
1) 19)
70/80
1)
130
80
Portugal 2,50 12 Up to 3,5 t
Over 3,5 t
50
50
90/100
20)
80/90
20)
120
21)
110
21)
Romania 2,50 12 Up to 3,5 t
Over 3,5 t
50
22)
50
80/90
1)
80/90
1)
120
110
Russia 2,50 12 Up to 3,5 t
Over 3,5 t
60
60
90
23)
70
110
23)
90
23)
Sweden 2,60
24
24)
Up to 3,5 t
Over 3,5 t
50
50
70-110
1) 20)
80/90
1)
110
20)
90
Switzer-
land
2,55 12 Up to 3,5 t
Over
3,5 t
25)
50
50
80/100
1)
80/100
1)
120
100
Serbia 2,50 12 Up to 3,5 t
Over 3,5 t
50
50
80/100
1)
80
120
80
Slovakian
Republic
2,55 12 Up to 3,5 t
Over 3,5 t
50
50
90/130
1)
80
130
80
Slovenia 2,55 12 Up to 3,5 t
Over 3,5 t
50
50
90/100
1)
80
130
90
Country Max. dimen-
sions in meters
Gross
weight
Built-
up ar-
eas
Outside
built-up ar-
eas
Motor-
way
Width Leng-
ht
Helpful notes
18
297Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Spain 2,55 12 Up to 3,5 t
Over 3,5 t
50
50
90/100
1)
70/80
1)
120
90
Czech Re-
public
2,50 12 Up to 3,5 t
Over 3,5 t
50
50
90/130
1)
80
130
80
Turkey 2,55 12 Up to 3,5 t
Over 3,5 t
50
50
90
70
1200
70
Hungary 2,55 12 Up to 3,5 t
Over 3,5 t
50
50
90/110
1)
70
130
80
Cyprus 2,55 12 Up to 3,5 t
Over 3,5 t
50
50
90/110
1)
70
130
80
1)
On expressways, on roads with more than one lane in each direction
2)
Vehicles over 7.5 tons max. permissible gross weight require a tachograph
3)
Recommended speed: 130 km/h
4)
Drivers who have had their driver's licence for less than 2 years must not drive faster than
90 km/h
5)
100 km/h with initial registration as from 1/1/95 and unladen weight up to 1,875 kg or as
from 1/1/81 and unladen weight up to 1,800 kg
6)
On wet roads, reduce speed by 10 km/h, and on motorways by 20 km/h
7)
Drivers who have had their driver's licence for less than 3 years may drive on country
roads
up to 80 km/h, on motorways up to 100 km/h and on superhighways up to 110 km/h
8)
On unmade roads (gravel): 80 km/h
9)
In wet conditions, reduce speed by 20 km/h
10)
In residential areas, 20 km/h
11)
Drivers who have had their driver's licence for less than 2 years must not drive faster than
80 km/h
12)
From 1/12 to 1/3, max. 90 km/h
13)
From 1/12 to 1/3, max. 80 km/h
14)
Outside towns on non-paved roads, max. 70 km/h
15)
Drivers who don't have their driver's licence for the full year, must not drive faster than
max. 75 km/h when out of town or 90 km/h on motorways
16)
On main roads 2.55 m, on roads marked "B" 2.20 m
17)
From 10 p.m. (22:00) to 5 a.m. (5:00) 110 km/h applies on the following motorways: A10
("Tauern" motorway), A12 ("Inntal" motorway), A13 ("Brenner" motorway), A14
("Rheintal" motorway)
18)
From 11 p.m. to 5 a.m., max. 60 km/h
19)
On four-lane motorways, max. 110 km/h
20)
According to traffic signs
21)
Drivers who have had their driver's licence for less than one year must not drive faster
than 90 km/h. Corresponding stickers (available from ACP offices) must be affixed in a
clearly visible position on the rear of the vehicle
22)
For motor vehicle drivers with less than 1 year of driving experience, maximum speeds
minus 20 km/h apply
23)
Drivers who have had their driver's licence for less than two years must not drive faster
than 70 km/h
24)
Swedish campsites often require the motorhome to have a closed waste water system
Country Max. dimen-
sions in meters
Gross
weight
Built-
up ar-
eas
Outside
built-up ar-
eas
Motor-
way
Width Leng-
ht
Helpful notes
18
298 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Date 07/2011
Source: ADAC
Specifications without guarantee
18.5 Driving with low beam in European countries
18.6 Sleeping in the vehicle away from camping areas
25)
A heavy goods vehicle supplement must be paid on all roads for all vehicles exceeding
3.5 tons max. permissible weight
Z In many countries driving with low beam is also required during the day. The
regulations differ depending on the country. Information is available, for
example, from the automobile clubs or the country representatives.
Country Sleeping on
roads and
fields
Sleeping on
privately
owned lands
Comments
Yes No Yes No
Belgium X X On highway rest areas
max. 24 hours permitted
On private land, the vehicle may
only be positioned with the per-
mission of the landowner
Bulgaria X X For reasons of safety, we strongly
advise against staying overnight
outside campsites
Denmark X X
Germany X X Staying overnight for one night to
restore driving ability is permit-
ted. Observe regional and local
limitations
Estonia X X Outside closed villages only; next
to farms with farmer's permission
only
Finland X X Possible with the permission of
the land owner
France X X Permission from the local authori-
ties or the owner of the land is re-
quired. Parking and staying
overnight on free areas is prohib-
ited
Greece X X
United King-
dom
X X Staying overnight in some places
with local permission only. Stay-
ing overnight on the side of the
road is not permitted
Ireland X X Staying overnight on a beach or
on the side of some streets and
bridges is not permitted
Helpful notes
18
299Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Italy X X Staying overnight at parking areas
and rest areas is permitted. Ob-
serve the local limitations. Parking
and staying overnight on free are-
as is prohibited
Croatia X X
Latvia X X Outside closed villages only; next
to farms with farmer's permission
only
Lithuania X X Outside closed villages only; next
to farms with farmer's permission
only
Luxembourg X X Not near the Esch-sur-Sûre-See;
max. two tents may be set up
Macedonia X X
Netherlands X X Overnight stays on streets and
squares is allowed in some bor-
oughs
Norway X X Not on land used for farming or
cultivated land; minimum dis-
tance to houses: 150 m
Austria X X Staying overnight for one night to
restore driving ability is permit-
ted, but not in nature reserves.
Observe regional and local limita-
tions. Generally prohibited in the
Tyrol
Poland X X Permission of land owner re-
quired; not on the coast or in na-
ture reserves
Portugal X X
Romania X X
Russia X X
Sweden X X Not on agriculture areas or in the
vicinity of houses. Observe local
restrictions
Switzerland X X One overnight stay at highway
rest areas and in some cantons is
tolerated. Permission from local
authorities required for staying
overnight
Serbia X X
Slovakian Re-
public
X X
Slovenia X X
Spain X X Some regional restrictions apply,
especially on beaches; only with
permission from local authorities
Country Sleeping on
roads and
fields
Sleeping on
privately
owned lands
Comments
Yes No Yes No
Helpful notes
18
300 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Specifications without guarantee
18.7 Gas supply in European countries
General tips Always observe the following information:
z Only go on vacation with completely filled gas bottles.
z Use all of the gas bottles' capacity.
z Take along adapter sets (available in camping supply stores) for filling gas bot-
tles in foreign countries and for connecting a German gas regulator to foreign
gas bottles.
z During the cold time of the year observe filling with propane gas component
(butane does not gasify below 0 °C).
z Use blue bottles from the firm Campingaz (distributed world-wide). Only use
gas bottles with safety valves.
z Buy a so-called self-filler bottle. Like a permanently installed gas tank this 11 kg
bottle can be refilled at any auto gas filling station (directory available from the
ADAC). Inspection at a technical inspectorate is required every 10 years.
z When bottles from other countries are used, check the gas bottle compart-
ments to see if the gas bottles fit into them. Gas bottles from other countries do
not always display the same size as the German Eurogas bottles.
z Follow the EU heating appliance directive. For information, visit www.truma.de
For your information a list of the gas supply is given below for some of the most vis-
ited European countries:
Czech Republic X X
Turkey X X Regional restrictions possible
Hungary X X
Country Sleeping on
roads and
fields
Sleeping on
privately
owned lands
Comments
Yes No Yes No
Country Gas supply Provider Info
phone
Belgium Identical gas bottles Belgian Shell and
Totalfina, Brussels;
Primagaz,
Tessenderlo;
Gasbottling, Gent;
Semnickgas, Ger-
aardsbergen
Exchanging and filling gas bottles
possible
Denmark German 5 and 11 kg gas bottles
are available for exchange at al-
most every campsite.
BP Gas offers Ger-
man gas bottles
Kosan Gas As com-
pany
00 45/
89 48 77
00
Filling station for grey gas bottles
available
Helpful notes
18
301Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Finland Finnish gas bottles available at
NESTE petrol stations and country
shops
Tehokaasu compa-
ny
(www.thokaasu.fi)
Overview of
providers from:
AGA (www.aga.no),
Fax: 00 47/22 02 78
05 Statoil, Fax:
00 47/22 96 22 10
Adapters for Norwegian gas bot-
tles can be purchased from the
AGA company
France Foreign gas bottles cannot be
filled or exchanged
French gas bottles can be used by
means of the Euro connection set
Greece German gas bottles can be filled
using the Euro connection set; ex-
change and filling station mainly
in larger cities only
United King-
dom
German gas bottles cannot be
filled
Calorgas company
(www.calor.co.uk)
British gas bottles can be connect-
ed to German systems using an
adapter (also available from Calor-
gas)
Ireland Gas bottles can be refilled Noel Leaders Shop
company, Tuam
Road, Galway
Calor Kosangas
company, Dublin
and Cork
(01) 50
5000
(021) 66
12 69
Iceland Gas bottles can be refilled Esso, Reykjavík
Yellow Icelandic gas bottles fit
German systems with a rubber
ring placed in the controller con-
nection
Italy Gas supply through Euro filling
and connecting set
Discharging of liquid gas at gas
stations for camping vehicles with
a permanently installed gas tank
is not permissible on tax grounds
Croatia Gas bottles whose inspection lies
less than 5 years back are filled in
INA branches
INA
Adapter can be purchased at INA
Netherlands Identical gas bottles
Exchanging and filling gas bottles
possible
Country Gas supply Provider Info
phone
Helpful notes
18
302 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Norway German gas bottles cannot be
filled
Overview of pro-
vides from: AGA ,
Fax: 00 47/22 02 78
05 Statoil, Fax:
00 47/22 96 22 10
Adapters for Norwegian gas bot-
tles can be purchased from the
AGA company
Deposit gas bottles available
Austria Identical gas bottles
Exchanging and filling gas bottles
possible
Poland Identical gas bottles
Exchanging and filling gas bottles
possible
Portugal Deposit gas bottles available Repsol; Cepsa
Sweden German gas bottles cannot be
filled
Overview of pro-
vides from:
AGA (www.aga.no),
Fax: 00 47/22 02 78
05 Statoil, Fax:
00 47/22 96 22 10
Adapters for Norwegian gas bot-
tles can be purchased from the
AGA company
Switzerland Hiring of a Swiss gas bottle with
pressure regulator possible
Shell Gas,
Switzerland
00 41/
3 27 58
75 55
German gas bottles can be filled
in exceptional cases
Slovenia German gas bottles can be filled Plinarna, Ljubljana;
Plinarna, Maribor;
Internia DD Ljublja-
na, Kozina;
OMV Istrabenz
DOO, Koper
We recommend bringing along
the Euro filling and connecting set
Spain German gas bottles cannot be
filled
Repsol
Cepsa
00 34/
901 10
01 00
00 34/
913 37
75 29
Hiring and filling of Spanish gas
bottles possible when the gas
connection has been adapted
6 kg deposit gas bottles can be
used with adapter
Czech Repub-
lic
German gas bottles can be refilled Agip, Bohemia Gas,
BP, Krainpol, Prima-
plyn Flaga-Plyn
Turkey Sale of 2 and 12 kg gas bottles;
connection possible with adapter
Ipragaz company
(www.iprag-
az.com.tr/tupgaz-
size-en-yakin-bayi)
Country Gas supply Provider Info
phone
Helpful notes
18
303Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Date 07/2011
Specifications without guarantee
18.8 Toll regulations in European countries
Many European countries have introduced a mandatory toll system. The toll regu-
lations and how they are collected vary greatly from country to country. Neverthe-
less, ignorance is no excuse. Penalties can be quite severe.
As is the case with traffic regulations, the vehicle driver is required to be familiar
with the toll formalities before starting out on a trip. For example, in Austria the
vignette does not meet the toll requirements for vehicles that weigh more than
3.5 t. There, a so-called "Go-Box" must be obtained and charged.
Contact your automobile club or the Internet for further information.
Hungary Identical gas bottles Primagaz, Total-
gaz, Shellgas, Mol
Exchanging and filling gas bottles
possible
Norway Norwegian 11 kg gas bottles can
be used with adapter
Overview of pro-
vides from:
AGA (www.aga.no),
Fax: 00 47/22 02 78
05 Statoil, Fax:
00 47/22 96 22 10
Country Gas supply Provider Info
phone
Z Windscreens with solar filters can affect the functioning of automatic toll collec-
tion systems (e.g. Go Box). This must be taken into account when acquiring the
appropriate device (e.g. Split Go Box).
Helpful notes
18
304 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
18.9 Tips on staying overnight safely during travel
Prudent behaviour is the most important protective measure for insuring a safe
night in the motorhome.
The risk of thievery is reduced to a minimum when the following basic rules are
observed:
z Before commencing the journey, close and lock all windows, doors and sky-
lights.
z Secure the driver's cabin doors from the inside against opening from the out-
side using a tension belt or chain which passes through the handholds, arm-
rests etc.
z If present: Switch on or activate anti-theft alarm and special door securing
devices. Warning devices against gas assaults using anaesthetic gas are offered
at camping supply stores.
z During high season do not spend the night at highway rest stops or parking
areas located along typical vacation routes.
z If possible, stay overnight in large, occupied car parks, e.g. near a restaurant.
z Even if it is just for one night, go to a camping site.
z When parking on open space keep emergency routes clear. The way to the
driver's seat should be clear. The ignition key should always be within reach.
z Only take with you those valuables which are absolutely necessary for the
journey. If possible, store valuables in a small safe and not in the immediate
vicinity of windows or doors.
z Always lock up the vehicle.
z Do not use parking stays.
18.10 Tips for winter campers
The following tips will help make your winter camping experience as agreeable as
possible.
z Reserve your parking place in good time. Good winter camping sites are often
booked up early.
z Do not start your trip without winter tyres.
z Bring snow chains.
z Choose your parking place with care. Observe the ground beneath you. Snow
and ice may melt.
z When the vehicle has been positioned, release the handbrake to prevent
freezing.
z No snow walls should be allowed to cover the built-in forced ventilation.
z Keep the built-in forced ventilation free from snow and ice.
z Make sure the air circulation is good. Good air circulation prevents moisture
from collecting and makes it easier to heat the living area.
z Cover the single-paned driver's cabin window with insulation mats to avoid
thermal bridges.
z Follow the instructions in the section "Gas supply in European countries".
z Use a two-bottle system with automatic controller for the gas system, so that
the supply does not run out during the night.
z Only operate the gas system using propane gas.
z Do not use the space behind the heater as a storage compartment.
z Never operate catalytic ovens or infra-red gas radiators in the interior of the
vehicle, since they consume oxygen for burning.
z Lay the 240 V power cable in such a way that the cable cannot be frozen or be
damaged (e.g. during snow removal).
Helpful notes
18
305Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
z When it is snowing heavily, clear the roof of the vehicle of snow regularly. A few
centimetres of powdery snow serves as insulation, but wet snow quickly
becomes a heavy burden.
z Before embarking on the return journey, remove all the snow from the roof to
avoid impeding vehicles behind you with a "snow flag".
18.11 Travel checklists
The following checklists will help that nothing important is left at home although
not everything on the checklists might be necessary.
Z Do not leave checking of documents (e.g. vehicle papers and information) as
well as checking the condition of the vehicle until just before commencing the
trip. Planning and checking documents well in advance will save unnecessary
trouble.
Object Object Object
Kitchen area
Wiping cloth Cleansing agent (de-
tergent)
Salad servers
Mug Dishcloths Chopping board
Turnspit Set of knifes and
forks for grilling
Bowls
Can opener Coffeepot Brush to wash the
dishes
Egg-cup Corkscrew Cloth to wash the
dishes
Ice cube tray Kitchen paper Matches
Lighter Spoons Cups
Bottle opener Knifes Plates
Air-tight storage
boxes
Garbage bags Thermos jug
Breakfast plate Frying pans Pots
Forks Stirring spoons Glasses
Bathroom/sanitary items
Towels Toilet brush Toothbrush glass
Sanitary items Toilet paper
Living area
Dustbin Insect lamp Rain clothes
Road atlas Insect repellent First aid kit
Bath towels Deck of cards Travel guides/park-
ing guide
Bath shoes Broom Rucksack
Batteries Candles Sleeping bags
Bed sheets Dust pan Pencils and paper
Bed linen Coat-hangers Shoes
Laundry bag Clothes brush Shoe polish
Books Pillow Vacuum cleaner
Camping guide Map Flash light
Helpful notes
18
306 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Spare bulbs Medicine Pocket knife
Water bottle Music cassettes Table cloth
Binoculars Neck-supporting pil-
low
Clothes pins
Fire extinguisher Sewing kit Clothesline
Gas bottle Radio
Vehicle/tools
Waste water con-
tainer
Fabric tape Screwdriver
Adapter socket Watering can for
drinking water
Current-measuring
instrument
CEE adapter Cable reel Step
Wire V-belt Wheel chocks
Spare wheel Glue First-aid kit
Spare lamps Universal pliers Vehicle jack
Spare fuses Compressor Hazard warning tri-
angle
Replacement water
pump
Luster terminals Warning sign
Hammer Loops Warning vest
Flat wrench Tube adapter Flashing hazard
warning light
Gas filling adapter Hose clips
Gas tube Snow chains (winter)
Outside
Stay rope Camping table Lock
Bellows Luggage racks String
Camping chairs Grill Tent pegs/tighten-
ing ropes
Documents
List of addresses Registration book Identity card
Registration confir-
mation(s)
Driving licence Passport
Allergy certificate Green insurance
card
Writ of protection
Instruction manuals Vaccination certifi-
cate
Vignette/toll card
Instruction leaflets
for medicines
Credit card Visa
Object Object Object
307Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Index
12 V fuses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .168
For Dometic toilet
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .170
For the starter battery
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .168
For Thetford toilet
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .169
On the living area battery
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .168
12 V indicator lamp
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .161
12 V main switch
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .160, 162
12 V power supply
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .142
Switching on
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .160, 162
Troubleshooting
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .271
240 V automatic circuit breaker
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .170
240 V connection
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62, 166
Power cable
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .166
Troubleshooting
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .270
240 V indicator lamp
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .161, 162
240 V power supply
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .166
A
AC converter
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .147
Troubleshooting
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .271
Access ladder
Overcab bed
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105, 106, 107
Access ladder, bunk bed
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .112, 113
Access ladder, overcab bed
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .101
Access ladder, pull-down bed
. . . . . . . . . . . 104, 108, 111
Accessories, fitting
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22
Adapter cable
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .167
Additional equipment
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32
Add-on parts see special equipment
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22
Air conditioning unit
Maintenance
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .253
Switching off
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .188
Switching on
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .188
Troubleshooting
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .272
Air conditioning unit (Truma)
Maintenance
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .253
Position
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .186
Remote control
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .186
Switching off
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .186
Switching on
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .187
Timer
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .187
Air outlet nozzles, adjustment
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .173
AL-KO rear axle
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .258
Annual inspection
Inspection records
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14
Appliances
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .171
Manuals
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22
Armrest, adjustment
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52
Automatic power selection (AES) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .209
Auxiliary charging unit
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 148
Location
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 148
Auxiliary heat exchanger (Arizona)
Switching off
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 182
Switching on
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 182
Awning
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63
B
Basic equipment
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31
Bath area
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 129
Room division options
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 129
Battery alarm
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 159, 164
Battery cut-off switch
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 150, 153, 156
Battery monitor
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 151, 154, 157
Battery see starter battery and living
area battery
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 143
Battery selector switch
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 150, 153, 156
Battery voltage, displaying
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 158, 162
Battery, wardrobe light, changing
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 256
Beds
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101
See Manual pull-down bed
. . . .104, 105, 106, 107
Before the journey
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29
Bike rack
Load
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38
Travelling with a loaded bike rack
. . . . . . . . . . . . . 38
Blind, cleaning
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 240
Blind, skylight with snap latch
Closing
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86
Opening
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86
Blind, window
Closing
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82
Opening
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82
Boiler (Alde)
Emptying
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 195
Switching off
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 194
Switching on
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 194
Troubleshooting
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 275, 276
Water, filling with
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 195
Boiler (Truma)
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 189, 191
Emptying
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 191, 193
Operating modes
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 189, 191
Safety/drainage valve
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . 190, 192, 194
Summer operation
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 190, 192
Switching off
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 190, 192
Switching on
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 190, 192
Troubleshooting
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 274
Water, filling with
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 191, 193
Winter operation
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 190, 192
Boiler (Webasto)
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 195
Filling with water . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 196
308 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Index
Bonnet
Closing
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57
Opening
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57
Brakes
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50
Check
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50, 269
Braking system, troubleshooting
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .269
Branch block
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54
Breakdown service in Europe
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .292
Bulbs, changing
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .254
Garage light
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .257
Halogen spotlight
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .255
Living area lamp
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .256
Refrigerator light
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .257
Bunk bed
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .112, 113
Access ladder
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .112, 113
Conversion
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .112, 113
Safety net
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109, 112, 113
Butane gas
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25, 132
C
Cable reel
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .166
Camping gas bottles, use
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26, 132
Camping in winter
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .304
Cap, water drain neck
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .220
Capacity of the battery
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .142
Care
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .237
Blind
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .240
Carpet
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .240
Curtains
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .240
Driver's cabin insulation mat
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .239
Entrance step
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .239
External care
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .237
Extractor hood
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .242
Furniture surfaces
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .239
Gas cooker
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .240
High-pressure cleaner, washing with
. . . . . . . . . .237
Hot-water heater
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .250
In the winter
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .244
Insect screen
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .240
Interior care
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .239
Interior synthetic parts
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .239
Lamps
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .239
Net curtains
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .240
PVC floor covering
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .240
Roller insect screen
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .240
Roman shade
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .240
Safety belt
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .240
Sink
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .240
Synthetic leather covers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .239
Teflon coverings
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 240
Temporary lay-up
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 245
Toilets
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 244
Underbody
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 238
Upholstery
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 239
Washing
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 237
Waste water tank
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 238
Water system
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 240
Windows
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 238
Winter lay-up
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 247
Carpet, cleaning
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 240
Central seating group
Extending
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100
Sleeping conversion
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117, 120
Changing wheels
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 266
Tightening torque
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 266
Charging current
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 160
Chassis inspection
Inspection records
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14
Checklist
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .47, 246
Before the journey
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47
For the journey
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 305
Initial start-up after temporary lay-up
. . . . . . . . 248
Road safety
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47
Temporary lay-up
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 246
Winter lay-up
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 247
Children's beds
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . .101, 102, 110, 112, 113
Circulating pump
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 179
Circulating pump, setting the rotational speed
. . . 179
Circulating pump, switch
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 161
Cleaning
Water pipes
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 240
Water tank
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 240
Cleaning see care
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 237
Closed circuit current
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142
Condensation
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74
On the double acrylic glass pane
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75
On the screwed connections in the floor
. . . . . . 74
Condensation water see condensation
. . . . . . . . . . . . 75
Connecting cable see power cable
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166
Conventional load
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32
Conversion door
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .67, 71
Insect screen
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70
Insect screen, closing
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71
Roller insect screen, opening
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71
Roman shade, closing
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71
Roman shade, opening
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71
Window, closing
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71
Window, opening
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71
309Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Index
Conversion door, inside
Locking
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68
Opening
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68
Conversion door, outside
Locking
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68
Opening
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68
Cooker
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .198
Troubleshooting
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .273
Cooling water, refilling
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58
Curtains, cleaning
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .240
D
Danger of suffocation
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22, 74
DEKRA
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .292
Dimensions, permissible
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .295
Discharging current
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .160
Displays
Battery voltage
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .158, 162
Current
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .160
Temperature
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .165
Time
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .165
Waste water tank level
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .159, 164
Water tank level
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .159, 164
Disposal
Household waste
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18
Sewage
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18
Waste water
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18
Dometic toilet
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .232
Flushing
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .233
Indicator lamp
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .233
Water tank, emptying
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .233
Water tank, filling
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .233
Door lock
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68
Doors
Conversion door
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67
Driver's door
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67
Lock
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68
Troubleshooting
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .283
Double floor, load
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37
Drain cock, water
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .220
Drain neck, water
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .220
Drinking water
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27
Drinking water filler neck
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .219
Closing
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .219
Opening
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .219
Driver's cabin insulation mat, care
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .239
Driver's cabin partition
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74
Closing
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74
Opening
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74
Driver's door . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67
Driver's door, inside
Locking
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70
Opening
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70
Driver's door, outside
Locking
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69
Opening
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69
Driver's seat
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52
Adjusting an appropriate seating position
. . . . . 52
Armrest, adjustment
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52
Turning it to driving position
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52
Driving speed
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50
Driving the motorhome
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49
DuoControl switching facility
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 137
During the journey
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49
E
Electrical pull-down bed
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108
Electrical system
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141
240 V connection, troubleshooting
. . . . . . . . . . . 270
Entrance step, troubleshooting
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . 269
Explanation of terms
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142
Lighting, troubleshooting
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 269
Safety instructions
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26
Troubleshooting
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 269
Electrically adjustable external mirrors
. . . . . . . . . . . . 55
Emergency equipment
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 292
Entrance step
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40, 61
Care
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 239
Extending
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41
Indicator lamp
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41
Pulling out
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40
Pushing in
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40
Retracting
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41
Troubleshooting
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 269
Warning tone
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .40, 41
Environmental tips
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18
Exhaust emission test (AU)
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 292
Extending the satellite unit
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 64, 65
Exterior lighting
Checking
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47
Troubleshooting
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 269
External care
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 237
External connection see 240 V connection
. . . . . . . . . 62
External flaps
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72
Flap lock
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72
Holding in position
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72
External gas connection
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 136
310 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Index
External mirrors, electrically adjustable
Adjusting
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55
Mirror heater, switching on
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55
Extractor hood
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .203
Care
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .242
F
Facing seating unit, sleeping conversion
. . . . .118, 119
Family Card
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2
Fault current protection switch
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .166
Filling the tank
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59
Fire
Extinguishing
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21
Response to
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22
Fire prevention
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21
Fire risks, avoidance
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21
First-aid kit
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .292
Fixed bed
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .114
Closing
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .114
Opening
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .114
Fixed table
Moving in a crossways direction
. . . . . . . . . . . 93, 94
Moving in a lengthways direction
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . 93
Flap lock
Closing
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72
Opening
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72
With recessed handle
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72
Flashing hazard warning light
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .292
Flat screen, positioning
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97
Floor warming unit, electrical
Overload protection
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .185
Switching off
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .185
Switching on
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .185
Fluorescent tubes, changing
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .254
Living area lamp
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .256
Room lamp
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .255
Folding mechanism, overcab bed
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .102
Forced ventilation
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22, 74
Front bench seat,
sleeping conversion
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123, 124, 125, 126
Front passenger's seat
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52
Adjusting an appropriate seating position
. . . . . 52
Armrest, adjustment
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52
Turning it to driving position
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52
Front seating group, sleeping conversion
. . . . . . . . .127
Fuel filler neck
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59
Closing
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60
Opening
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59
Furniture flaps, troubleshooting
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .283
Furniture surfaces, cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .239
Fuse box see 240 V automatic circuit breaker
. . . . . 170
Fuses
12 V fuses
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 168
240 V fuse
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166, 170
For the Dometic toilet
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 170
For the starter battery
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 168
For the Thetford toilet
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 169
On the living area battery
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 168
Fuses see 12 V fuses and 240 V fuse
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . 168
G
Garage light
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 257
Gas bottle compartment
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .25, 132
Gas bottles
Changing
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 134
Safety instructions
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .26, 132
Gas connection, external
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 136
Gas consumption
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 133
Gas cooker
Cleaning
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 240
Switching off
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 199
Switching on
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 199
Troubleshooting
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 273
Gas inspection
Inspection records
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14
Gas isolator taps
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135
Symbols
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135, 172
Gas odour
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .25, 131, 272
Gas oven
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200, 201
Switching off
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200, 201
Switching on
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 201
Troubleshooting
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 273
Gas supply in European countries
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 300
Gas system
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131
Checks
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 292
Defect
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .25, 131, 272
General instructions
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25
Safety instructions
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .25, 131
Switching automatics
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 137
Troubleshooting
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 272
Gas tube, check
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .25, 132
Gathered blind
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 85
General instructions
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18
Guarantee
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7
Guarantee conditions
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7
H
Handbrake
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61
Applying . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22
311Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Index
Handling of tyres . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .265
Hazard warning triangle
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .292
Headrests
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53
Heat exchanger (Alde)
Switching off
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .179
Switching on
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .178
Heat exchanger (Arizona)
Switching off
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .182
Switching on
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .182
Heat exchanger, heater, replacement
. . . . . . . . . . . . .171
Heat exchangers, heater, replacement
. . . . . . . . . . . .171
Heater
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .172
Air outlet nozzles, adjustment
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .173
Heat exchangers, replacement
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . .171
Hot air distribution
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .173
Initial start-up
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .172
Troubleshooting
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .273
Heater for the waste water tank and
waste water pipes
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .184
Heater, external mirrors
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55
Heki skylight
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 87
Closing
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 87
Insect screen
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88
Opening
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 87
Roman shade
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 87
Ventilation position
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 87
Help on Europe's roads
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .292
Helpful notes
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .289
High rate of gas consumption
. . . . . . . . . . . 25, 131, 272
High-pressure cleaner, washing with
. . . . . . . . . . . . . .237
Hinged window
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80
Blind
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82
Closing
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 78, 80
Continuous ventilation
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79, 81
Insect screen
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82
Opening
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 78, 80
Hot air distribution
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .173
Hot-air heater
Operating modes
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .173
Switching off
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .174
Switching on
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .174
Troubleshooting
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .274
Hot-water heater
240 V electrical operation, selecting
. . . . . . . . . . 177
Adjustment menu
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 177
Auxiliary circulating pump
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 179
Care
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 250
Fluid level, checking
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 250
Gas and 240 V electrical operation, selecting
. 178
Gas operation, selecting
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 177
Heat exchanger
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 178
Heater, switching off
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 178
Heater, switching on
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 178
Heating fluid, topping up
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 250
Heating system, bleeding
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 251
Maintenance work
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 250
Operating unit
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 176
Rotational speed, circulating pump
. . . . . . . . . . 179
Safety instructions
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 175
Start screen
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 176
Tool menus
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 177
Troubleshooting
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 275, 276
I
Independent vehicle heater
Maintenance
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 253
Programming
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 183
Switching off
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 183
Switching on
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 183
Indicator lamp, 12 V power supply
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 161
Indicator lamp, 240 V power supply
. . . . . . . . . 161, 162
Indicator lamp, toilet
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 231, 232, 233
Information stickers
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 259
Initial start-up
After temporary lay-up
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 248
After winter lay-up
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 248
Inner door, troubleshooting
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 283
Insect screen, cleaning
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 240
Insect screen, conversion door
Closing
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70
Opening
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70
Insect screen, Heki skylight
Closing
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88
Opening
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88
Insect screen, windows
Closing
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82
Opening
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82
Insect screen, wind-up skylight
Closing
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88
Opening
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88
Inspection intervals
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 292
312 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Index
Inspection records
Water ingress test
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9
Inspection work
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .249
Inspections
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .249
Annual inspection
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12
Chassis
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13
Further
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12
Gas inspection
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13
Inspections, official
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .292
Inspection intervals
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .292
Interior care
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .239
Interior lighting
Bulbs, changing
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .254
Troubleshooting
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .269
K
Keys
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29
Kitchen block, central locking system
. . . . . . . . . . 45, 96
Kitchen unit
Central locking system
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45, 96
L
Ladder
Overcab bed
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105, 106, 107
Ladder, bunk bed
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .112, 113
Ladder, overcab bed
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .101
Ladder, pull-down bed
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 104, 108, 111
Ladder, rear
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35
Lamps
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98, 254
Cleaning
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .239
Operating
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98
Lay-up
Temporary
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .245
Winter lay-up
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .247
Leakage water inside the vehicle
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .282
Leakproof guarantee
Inspection plan
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8
Licence categories / Registration
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19
Lift-off table
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96
Conversion to bed foundation
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96
Light in the elevating roof
Changing the batteries
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .258
Light switch
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99
Lighting
Lamps, cleaning
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .239
Troubleshooting
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .269
Lights see bulbs, changing
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .254
Living area battery
Battery alarm
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 159, 164
Charging
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 145
Charging current, displaying
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 160
Discharging
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 144
Discharging current, displaying
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . 160
Fuses
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 168
Instructions
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 143
Position
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 143
Troubleshooting
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 270, 271
Voltage, displaying
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 158, 162
Living area lamp
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 256
Load
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34
Bike rack
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38
Double floor
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37
Rear garage
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37
Rear storage space
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37
Roof rack
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35
Load rack for roof loads
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35
Load see also payload
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34
Lock
Conversion door
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68
Driver's cabin partition
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74
External flap
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72
Low beam
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 298
L-seating group, sleeping conversion
. . . . . . . . . . . . 128
M
Maintenance work
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 249, 261
Air conditioning unit
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 253
Air conditioning unit (Truma)
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 253
AL-KO rear axle
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 258
Hot-water heater
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 250
Independent vehicle heater
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 253
Manual pull-down bed
. . . . . . . . . . . . .104, 105, 106, 107
Mass in ready-to-drive condition
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . .31, 33
Maximum permissible gross weight
. . . . . . . . . . . . 30, 33
Mechanical steady legs
Extending
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62
Length, adjustment
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62
Retracting
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62
Microwave oven
Switching off
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 202
Switching on
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 202
Troubleshooting
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 273
N
Net curtains, cleaning
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 240
No gas . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 272
313Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Index
Nose weight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39
O
Odour seal
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .222
Off-load voltage
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .142
Oil level, checking
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59
Operating modes
Boiler (Truma)
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .189, 191
Hot-air heater
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .173
Refrigerator
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 205, 207, 211, 213
Switching automatics, gas system
. . . . . . . . . . . .138
Oven see gas cooker or gas oven
. . . . . . . 198, 200, 201
Overcab bed
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .101
Access ladder
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101, 105, 106, 107
Folding downwards
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .102
Folding mechanism
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .102
Folding upwards
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .102
Safety net
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101, 104, 105, 106, 107
Overloading
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34
P
Panel (IT 992)
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .157
12 V main switch
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .160
Battery voltage, displaying
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .158
Filling level of the waste water tank,
displaying
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .159
Filling level of the water tank, displaying
. . . . . .159
Switch for water pump
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .161
Panel (IT922)
Switch for circulating pump
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .161
Panel (MP 20-T)
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .161
12 V main switch
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .162
240 V indicator lamp
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .162
Alarms
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .164
Battery displays
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .162
Tank display
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .164
Tank heater switch
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .165
Temperature display
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .165
Time display
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .165
Panel see also displays
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .157
Parking
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .290
Payload
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30
Calculation
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33
Composition
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31
Example calculation
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31, 33
Payload see also load
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30
Permissible gross weight see maximum
permissible gross weight
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30
Permitted mass . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31
Personal equipment
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32
Plug-in light
Plugging in
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98
Removal
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98
Turning
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99
Power cable for the 240 V connection
. . . . . . . . . . . . 166
Propane gas
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .25, 132
Pull-down bed
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102, 110
Access ladder
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 104, 108, 111
Closing
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . 104, 105, 106, 107, 108, 110
Electrical
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108
Manual
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .104, 105, 106, 107
Opening
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 103, 109, 110
Retaining straps, tensioning
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111
Safety guard
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109
Safety net
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108
PVC-floor covering
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41
PVC-floor covering, cleaning
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 240
R
Range hood
Filter, cleaning
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 242
Rear axle load
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39
Rear garage
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37
Rear ladder
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35
Folding downwards
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36
Folding upwards
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36
Rear storage space
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37
Refrigerator
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .63, 204
12 V operation, switching on/off
. . . 206, 208, 213
240 V operation, switching on/off
. . 206, 208, 212
Adjust the temperature
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 213
Change-over between energy sources
. . . . . . . 210
Door lock
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 214
Gas operation
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 210
Gas operation, switching off
. . . . . . . . . . . . 205, 207
Gas operation, switching on
. . . . . . . . . . . . 205, 207
Operating modes
. . . . . . . . . . . . . .205, 207, 211, 213
Operation
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 211
Refrigerating temperature control
. . . . . . . . . . . 210
Switching off
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 213
Switching on
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 213
Troubleshooting
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 278, 279
Ventilation grill, removal
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 204
Refrigerator door locking mechanism
Closing
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 214, 215
Locking in the ventilation position
. . . . . . . . . . . 215
Opening
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 214, 215
Refrigerator light
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 257
314 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Index
Refrigerator ventilation grill, removal . . . . . . . . . . . . .204
Registration
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29
Remote control, air conditioning unit
. . . . . . . . . . . . .188
Remote control, air conditioning unit (Truma)
. . . . .186
Remote control, awning
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63
Rescue card
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21
Risk of frost damage
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27, 217, 224
Road safety
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47
Checklist
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47
Notes for
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23
Roller insect screen, conversion door window
Closing
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71
Opening
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71
Roman shade
Conversion door window
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71
Side pane
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43
Windscreen
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44
Roman shade, cleaning
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .240
Roman shade, driver's cabin
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55
Closing
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 83, 84
Opening
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 83, 84
Roman shade, Heki skylight
Closing
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 87
Opening
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 87
Roman shade, window of conversion door
Closing
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71
Opening
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71
Roman shade, wind-up skylight
Closing
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88
Opening
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88
Roof load
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35
Roof rack, load
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35
Roof rail
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35
Room lamp
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .255
Round seating group, sleeping conversion
. . .121, 122
S
Safety instructions
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21
Cooker
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .198
Electrical system
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26
Fire prevention
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21
Gas bottles
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .132
Gas system
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25, 131
Hot-water heater
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .175
Road safety
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23
Sleeping area partition
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .129
Towing
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24
Water system
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27
Safety net
Overcab bed
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 104, 105, 106, 107
Safety net, bunk bed
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109, 112, 113
Safety net, overcab bed
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101
Safety net, pull-down bed
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108, 111
Safety/drainage valve boiler
. . . . . . . . . . . 190, 192, 194
Sanitary fittings
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 217
Satellite unit
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 64
Seat belts
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50
Adjusting correctly
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51
Cleaning
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 240
Fastening correctly
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51
Seating arrangement
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53
Seating groups
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100
Seats, rotating
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 89
Serial number
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 259
Sewage tank, emptying
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 233
Shower
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 226
Sink
Cleaning
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 242
Sink, cleaning
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 240
Skylight with snap latch
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86
Blind
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86
Closing
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86
Opening
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86
Skylights
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 85
Skylight with snap latch
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86
Sleeper roof
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114
Closing
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115
Opening
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115
Sleeping area partition
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 129
Folding door
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 130
Sliding door
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 129
Sleeping conversion
Central seating group
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116, 117, 120
Facing seating unit
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 118, 119
Front bench seat
. . . . . . . . . . . . . .123, 124, 125, 126
Front seating group
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 127
L-seating group
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 128
Round seating group
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121, 122
Sliding window
Closing
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 76, 77, 78
Opening
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 76, 77, 78
Snow chains
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46
Spare parts
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 261
Spare wheel
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 267
Spare wheel support
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 267
315Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Index
Special equipment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .285
Description
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17
Designation
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17
Safety instructions
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22
Weight details
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .285
Speed limits
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .295
Starter battery
Battery alarm
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .164
Charging
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .145
Fuses
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .168
Troubleshooting
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .270
Voltage, displaying
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .158, 162
Staying overnight
Away from camping areas
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .298
On the road
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .304
Steady legs
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62
Extending
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62
Length, adjustment
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62
Retracting
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62
Supports see steady legs
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62
Suspension table
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90, 92
Conversion to bed foundation
. . . . . . . . . . . . . 91, 92
Extending
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 91, 92
Reducing size
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 91, 92
Switch for water pump
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .218
Switching automatics, gas system
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .137
Swivel table
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 93
Fastening to the floor
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 93
Symbols
For instructions
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17
Gas isolator taps
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .135, 172
Synthetic leather covers, cleaning
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .239
Synthetic parts in the toilet and living areas,
cleaning
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .239
T
Table
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90
Table, fixed
Locking
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 94
Moving in a lengthways direction
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95
Table-top, folding to the side
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95
Tank alarm
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .164
Tank heater, switching on and off
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .165
Tank lid see fuel filler neck
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59
Teflon coverings, cleaning
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .240
Television
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42, 97
Pulling out
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97
Storing
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42
Swiveling
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97
Temperature display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .165
Thetford cassette, retaining clip
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 234
Thetford toilet
Emptying
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 232
Flushing
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 231, 232
Fuse
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 169
Indicator lamp
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 231, 232
Water tank, emptying
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 231
Water tank, filling
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 230
Tightening torque, wheels
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 266
Time, displaying
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 165
Tips
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 289
Toilet
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 229
Care
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 244
Fuse
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 169, 170
Troubleshooting
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 282
Water tank, emptying
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 244
Toilet cassette
Emptying
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 235
Removing
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 234
Unlocking
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 234
Toilet compartment
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 226
Ventilation
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 226
Toilet compartment, pull-out
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 227
Toll regulations in European countries
. . . . . . . . . . . 303
Total discharge
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142
Tow coupling
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39
Mounting
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39
Removing
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39
Towing
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24
General instructions
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39
Safety instructions
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24
Traffic rules in foreign countries
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 290
Traffic rules in Germany
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 289
Transformer/rectifier (EBL 101)
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 152
Functions
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 152, 155
Position
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 153, 156
Transformer/rectifier (EBL 99)
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 148
Functions
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 149
Position
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 149
Transformer/rectifier (EBL220)
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 155
Travel checklists
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 305
Travel cots
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113
Travel cots suitable for children
. . . .101, 102, 110, 112
316 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Index
Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .269
12 V power supply
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .271
240 V connection
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .270
AC converter
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .271
Air conditioning unit
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .272
Battery
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .270
Body
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .283
Boiler (Alde)
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .275, 276
Boiler (Truma)
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .274
Braking system
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .269
Cooker
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .273
Electrical system
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .269
Entrance step
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .269
Extractor hood
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .272
Furniture flaps
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .283
Gas cooker
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .273
Gas oven
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .273
Gas system
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .272
Heater
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .273
Hot-air heater
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .274
Hot-water heater
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .275, 276
Inner door
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .283
Lighting
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .269
Living area battery
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .270
Microwave oven
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .273
Refrigerator
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .278, 279
Starter battery
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .270
Toilet
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .282
Water supply
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .282
TÜV
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .292
TV cabinet
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97
Tyre change see changing wheels
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .266
Tyre specifications
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .265
Tyres
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .263
Excessive wear
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24, 47, 263, 267
General instructions
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .263
Handling
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .265
Identification
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .265
Load-carrying capacity
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .266
Tyre pressure
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .267
Tyre selection
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .264
U
Underbody, maintenance
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .238
Unladen weight
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31
Upholstery, cleaning
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .239
V
Vario toilet
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 227
Converting into a shower cubicle
. . . . . . . . . . . . 228
Converting into toilet compartment
. . . . . . . . . . 228
Vehicle identification plate
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 259
Vehicle manuals and documents
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17
Vehicle, washing
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 237
Ventilation
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74
Toilet compartment
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 226
Volume of waste water, displaying
. . . . . . . . . . 159, 164
Volume of water, displaying
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 159, 164
W
Wardrobe light
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 256
Warning stickers
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 259
Wash basin
Variable
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 229
Washer fluid, filling
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57
Washing with a high-pressure cleaner
. . . . . . . . . . . . 237
Waste gas vent on the right hand side of
the vehicle.
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 172, 189
Waste water tank
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 221, 222
Care
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 238
Cleaning
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 238
Emptying
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 222
Filling level, displaying
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 159, 164
Heater
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 184
Troubleshooting
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 282
Waste water tap
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 221, 222
Water ingress test
Guarantee
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8
Inspection records
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9
Water pipes, cleaning
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 240
Water pump
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 217, 223
Water pump, switch
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 178
Water supply
General
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 217
Troubleshooting
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 282
Water system
Care
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 240
Cleaning
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 240
Disinfect
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 241
Drinking water filler neck
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 219
Emptying
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 224
Filling
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 223
Safety instructions
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27
317Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Index
Water tank
Cleaning
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .240
Draining water
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .220
Filling level, displaying
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .159, 164
Water, filling with
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .219
Water tank see also water system
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .219
Weatherproof guarantee
Conditions
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7
Webasto diesel heater
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .179
Summer operation
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .180
Winter operation
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .181
Weight details for special equipment
. . . . . . . . . . . . .285
Wheel chocks
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61
Wheel rim size
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .266
Wheel rim type
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .263
Wheels
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .263
Window winders, electrical
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54
Window, conversion door
Closing
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71
Insect screen, closing
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71
Opening
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71
Roller insect screen, opening
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71
Roman shade, closing
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71
Roman shade, opening
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71
Windows
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75
Blind
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82
Cleaning
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .238
Gathered blind
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 85
Insect screen
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82
Roman shade
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 83, 84
Wind-up skylight
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88
Closing
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88
Insect screen
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88
Opening
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88
Roman shade
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88
Troubleshooting
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .283
Winter care
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .244
Winter operation
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .245
Writing and reading rest
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56
318 Motorcaravan - 14-09 - EN
Index
307

Brauchen Sie Hilfe? Stellen Sie Ihre Frage.

Forenregeln

Missbrauch melden von Frage und/oder Antwort

Libble nimmt den Missbrauch seiner Dienste sehr ernst. Wir setzen uns dafür ein, derartige Missbrauchsfälle gemäß den Gesetzen Ihres Heimatlandes zu behandeln. Wenn Sie eine Meldung übermitteln, überprüfen wir Ihre Informationen und ergreifen entsprechende Maßnahmen. Wir melden uns nur dann wieder bei Ihnen, wenn wir weitere Einzelheiten wissen müssen oder weitere Informationen für Sie haben.

Art des Missbrauchs:

Zum Beispiel antisemitische Inhalte, rassistische Inhalte oder Material, das zu einer Gewalttat führen könnte.

Beispielsweise eine Kreditkartennummer, persönliche Identifikationsnummer oder unveröffentlichte Privatadresse. Beachten Sie, dass E-Mail-Adressen und der vollständige Name nicht als private Informationen angesehen werden.

Forenregeln

Um zu sinnvolle Fragen zu kommen halten Sie sich bitte an folgende Spielregeln:

Neu registrieren

Registrieren auf E - Mails für Dethleffs 2015 Motorhome wenn:


Sie erhalten eine E-Mail, um sich für eine oder beide Optionen anzumelden.


Andere Handbücher von Dethleffs 2015 Motorhome

Dethleffs 2015 Motorhome Bedienungsanleitung - Deutsch - 322 seiten

Dethleffs 2015 Motorhome Bedienungsanleitung - Holländisch - 328 seiten

Dethleffs 2015 Motorhome Bedienungsanleitung - Französisch - 228 seiten


Das Handbuch wird per E-Mail gesendet. Überprüfen Sie ihre E-Mail.

Wenn Sie innerhalb von 15 Minuten keine E-Mail mit dem Handbuch erhalten haben, kann es sein, dass Sie eine falsche E-Mail-Adresse eingegeben haben oder dass Ihr ISP eine maximale Größe eingestellt hat, um E-Mails zu erhalten, die kleiner als die Größe des Handbuchs sind.

Ihre Frage wurde zu diesem Forum hinzugefügt

Möchten Sie eine E-Mail erhalten, wenn neue Antworten und Fragen veröffentlicht werden? Geben Sie bitte Ihre Email-Adresse ein.



Info